EVAL-ADV7180-32EBZ [ADI]
10-Bit, 4Ã Oversampling SDTV Video Decoder; 10位, 4A ?过采样SDTV视频解码器型号: | EVAL-ADV7180-32EBZ |
厂家: | ADI |
描述: | 10-Bit, 4Ã Oversampling SDTV Video Decoder |
文件: | 总120页 (文件大小:2118K) |
中文: | 中文翻译 | 下载: | 下载PDF数据表文档文件 |
10-Bit, 4× Oversampling
SDTV Video Decoder
ADV7180
Data Sheet
FEATURES
APPLICATIONS
Qualified for automotive applications
Digital camcorders and PDAs
Worldwide NTSC/PAL/SECAM color demodulation support
One 10-bit ADC, 4× oversampling for CVBS, 2× oversampling
for Y/C mode, and 2× oversampling for YPrPb (per channel)
3 video input channels with on-chip antialiasing filter
CVBS (composite), Y/C (S-Video), and YPrPb (component)
video input support
Low cost SDTV PIP decoders for digital TVs
Multichannel DVRs for video security
AV receivers and video transcoding
PCI-/USB-based video capture and TV tuner cards
Personal media players and recorders
Smartphone/multimedia handsets
5-line adaptive comb filters and CTI/DNR video
enhancement
In-car/automotive infotainment units
Rearview camera/vehicle safety systems
Mini-TBC functionality provided by adaptive digital line
length tracking (ADLLT), signal processing, and enhanced
FIFO management
FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM
CLOCK PROCESSING BLOCK
XTAL1
LLC
Integrated AGC with adaptive peak white mode
Macrovision copy protection detection
NTSC/PAL/SECAM autodetection
8-bit ITU-R BT.656 YCrCb 4:2:2 output and HS, VS, and FIELD1
1.0 V analog input signal range
Full-featured VBI data slicer with teletext support (WST)
Power-down mode and ultralow sleep mode current
2-wire serial MPU interface (I2C compatible)
Single 1.8 V supply possible
PLL
ADLLT PROCESSING
XTAL
2
ANALOG
VIDEO
INPUTS
8-BIT/16-BIT
PIXEL DATA
DIGITAL
PROCESSING
BLOCK
10-BIT, 86MHz
ADC
P15 TO P0
A
A
A
1
2
IN
IN
IN
AA
FILTER
2D COMB
VS
HS
3
1
AA
FILTER
SHA
A/D
VBI SLICER
A
4
5
6
IN
IN
IN
3
FIELD
1
1
A
A
AA
FILTER
5
COLOR
DEMOD
GPO
SFL
INTRQ
2
REFERENCE
I C/CONTROL
ADV7180
1.8 V analog, 1.8 V PLL, 1.8 V digital, 1.8 V to 3.3 V I/O supply
−10°C to +70°C commercial temperature grade
−40°C to +85°C industrial/automotive qualified temperature
grade
4
SCLK SDATA ALSB RESET PWRDWN
1
2
3
4
5
ONLY AVAILABLE ON 64-LEAD PACKAGE AND 48-LEAD PACKAGES.
16-BIT ONLY AVAILABLE ON 64-LEAD PACKAGE.
48-LEAD, 40-LEAD, AND 32-LEAD PACKAGE USES ONE LEAD FOR VS/FIELD.
NOT AVAILABLE ON 32-LEAD PACKAGE.
ONLY AVAILABLE ON 48-LEAD AND 64-LEAD PACKAGES.
Figure 1.
−40°C to +125°C temperature grade for automotive qualified
4 package types
64-lead, 10 mm × 10 mm, RoHS-compliant LQFP
48-Lead, 7 mm × 7 mm, RoHS-compliant LQFP
40-lead, 6 mm × 6 mm, RoHS-compliant LFCSP
32-lead, 5 mm × 5 mm, RoHS-compliant LFCSP
video performance for consumer applications with true 8-bit
data resolution. Three analog video input channels accept standard
composite, S-Video, or component video signals, supporting a
wide range of consumer video sources. AGC and clamp-restore
circuitry allow an input video signal peak-to-peak range to 1.0 V.
Alternatively, these can be bypassed for manual settings.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The line-locked clock output allows the output data rate, timing
signals, and output clock signals to be synchronous, asynchronous, or
line locked even with 5% line length variation. Output control
signals allow glueless interface connections in many applications.
The ADV7180 is programmed via a 2-wire, serial bidirectional port
(I2C® compatible) and is fabricated in a 1.8 V CMOS process. Its
monolithic CMOS construction ensures greater functionality with
lower power dissipation. LFCSP package options make the decoder
ideal for space-constrained portable applications. The 64-lead
LQFP package is pin compatible with the ADV7181C.
The ADV7180 automatically detects and converts standard
analog baseband television signals compatible with worldwide
NTSC, PAL, and SECAM standards into 4:2:2 component video
data compatible with the 8-bit ITU-R BT.656 interface standard.
The simple digital output interface connects gluelessly to a wide
range of MPEG encoders, codecs, mobile video processors, and
Analog Devices, Inc., digital video encoders, such as the ADV7391.
External HS, VS, and FIELD signals provide timing references
for LCD controllers and other video ASICs, if required. Accurate
10-bit analog-to-digital conversion provides professional quality
1 The 48-Lead LQFP, 40-lead LFCSP, and 32-lead LFCSP use one pin to output
VS or FIELD.
Rev. G
Information furnished by Analog Devices is believed to be accurate and reliable. However, no
responsibility is assumed by Analog Devices for its use, nor for any infringements of patents or other
rightsof third parties that may result fromits use. Specifications subject to change without notice. No
license is granted by implication or otherwise under any patent or patent rights of Analog Devices.
Trademarks andregisteredtrademarks are the property of their respective owners.
One Technology Way, P.O. Box 9106, Norwood, MA 02062-9106, U.S.A.
Tel: 781.329.4700
www.analog.com
Fax: 781.461.3113 ©2006-2012 Analog Devices, Inc. All rights reserved.
ADV7180
Data Sheet
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Features .............................................................................................. 1
Sync Processing .......................................................................... 26
VBI Data Recovery..................................................................... 26
General Setup.............................................................................. 26
Color Controls ............................................................................ 28
Clamp Operation........................................................................ 30
Luma Filter.................................................................................. 31
Chroma Filter.............................................................................. 34
Gain Operation........................................................................... 35
Chroma Transient Improvement (CTI) .................................. 39
Digital Noise Reduction (DNR) and Luma Peaking Filter... 40
Comb Filters................................................................................ 41
IF Filter Compensation ............................................................. 43
AV Code Insertion and Controls ............................................. 44
Synchronization Output Signals............................................... 46
Sync Processing .......................................................................... 53
VBI Data Decode ....................................................................... 53
I2C Readback Registers.............................................................. 62
Pixel Port Configuration ............................................................... 75
GPO Control ................................................................................... 76
MPU Port Description................................................................... 77
Register Access............................................................................ 78
Register Programming............................................................... 78
I2C Sequencer.............................................................................. 78
I2C Register Maps ........................................................................... 79
I2C Programming Examples........................................................ 106
64-Lead LQFP........................................................................... 106
48-Lead LQFP........................................................................... 107
40-Lead LFCSP......................................................................... 108
32-Lead LFCSP......................................................................... 109
PCB Layout Recommendations.................................................. 110
Analog Interface Inputs........................................................... 110
Power Supply Decoupling ....................................................... 110
PLL ............................................................................................. 110
VREFN and VREFP................................................................. 110
Digital Outputs (Both Data and Clocks) .............................. 110
Digital Inputs ............................................................................ 110
Typical Circuit Connection......................................................... 111
Outline Dimensions ..................................................................... 115
Ordering Guide ........................................................................ 117
Automotive Products............................................................... 117
General Description ......................................................................... 1
Applications....................................................................................... 1
Functional Block Diagram .............................................................. 1
Revision History ............................................................................... 3
Introduction ...................................................................................... 5
Analog Front End......................................................................... 5
Standard Definition Processor.................................................... 5
Functional Block Diagrams............................................................. 6
Specifications..................................................................................... 8
Electrical Characteristics............................................................. 8
Video Specifications..................................................................... 9
Timing Specifications ................................................................ 10
Analog Specifications................................................................. 11
Thermal Specifications .............................................................. 11
Absolute Maximum Ratings.......................................................... 12
ESD Caution................................................................................ 12
Pin Configurations and Function Descriptions ......................... 13
32-Lead LFCSP ........................................................................... 13
40-Lead LFCSP ........................................................................... 14
64-Lead LQFP............................................................................. 15
48-Lead LQFP............................................................................. 17
Analog Front End ........................................................................... 18
Input Configuration................................................................... 19
RESET
Power-On
...................................................................... 20
Analog Input Muxing ................................................................ 20
Antialiasing Filters ..................................................................... 21
Global Control Registers ............................................................... 22
Power-Saving Modes.................................................................. 22
Reset Control .............................................................................. 22
Global Pin Control ..................................................................... 22
Global Status Register .................................................................... 24
Identification............................................................................... 24
Status 1 ......................................................................................... 24
Autodetection Result.................................................................. 24
Status 2 ......................................................................................... 24
Status 3 ......................................................................................... 24
Video Processor .............................................................................. 25
SD Luma Path ............................................................................. 25
SD Chroma Path......................................................................... 25
Rev. G | Page 2 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
REVISION HISTORY
3/12—Rev. F to Rev. G
Changes to Power-On Reset Section, Analog Input Muxing
Changed ADV7179 to ADV7391 Throughout .............................1
Changes to Figure 12 ......................................................................18
Changes to Table 14 ........................................................................19
Section, and Table 14......................................................................17
Changes to PDBP Section and TOD Section ..............................19
Changes to Identification Section.................................................21
Changes to VS and FIELD Configuration Section and SQPE
Section ..............................................................................................44
Changes to Table 99 and Table 100...............................................72
Changes to GPO Control Section.................................................73
Changes to Table 104......................................................................76
Changes to Table 106......................................................................80
Added Figure 56............................................................................108
Added Figure 59............................................................................110
Changes to Ordering Guide.........................................................110
RESET
Changes to Power-On
Section and MAN_MUX_EN,
Manual Input Muxing Enable, Address 0xC4[7] Section..........20
Changed NTSM to NTSC Throughout........................................24
Deleted ADV7190, ADV7191, and ADV7192 Throughout......27
Change to DEF_C[7:0], Default Value C, Address 0x0D[7:0]
Section ..............................................................................................29
Changes to Luma Filter Section ....................................................31
Changes to Table 39 and LAGT[1:0], Luma Automatic Gain
Timing, Address 0x2F[7:6] Section ..............................................36
Changed Calculation of the Luma Calibration Factor Section
Heading to Calculation of the Chroma Calibration Factor
Section ..............................................................................................38
Changes to Range, Range Selection, Address 0x04[0]
Section ..............................................................................................45
Changes to PHS, Polarity HS, Address 0x37[7] Section............46
Changes to 0x0D, 0x1D, 0x2C, 0x37, and 0x41, Table 107........85
Changes to Power Supply Decoupling Section .........................110
Deleted Figure 55; Renumbered Sequentially ...........................110
Changes to Figure 55 ....................................................................111
Changes to Figure 56 ....................................................................112
Changes to Figure 57 ....................................................................113
Changes to Figure 58 ....................................................................114
Changes to Ordering Guide.........................................................117
6/09—Rev. C to Rev. D
Change to General Description.......................................................1
Deleted Comparison with the ADV7181B Section......................5
Deleted Figure 2; Renumbered Sequentially.................................5
Changes to Power Requirements Parameter, Table 2...................6
Changes to Table 29 ........................................................................25
Changes to Figure 33 ......................................................................44
Changes to Subaddress 0x0A Notes, Table 104...........................81
Changes to Ordering Guide.........................................................110
4/09—Rev. B to Rev. C
Changes to Features Section............................................................1
Changes to Absolute Maximum Ratings, Table 7.......................11
Changes to Figure 7 and Table 8, EPAD Addition......................12
RESET
Added Power-On
Section.................................................17
7/10—Rev. E to Rev. F
Added 48-Lead LQFP .................................................. Throughout
Changes to Features Section ............................................................1
Changes to Table 2 ............................................................................4
Added Figure 5; Renumbered Sequentially ...................................6
Added Input Current (SDA, SCLK) Parameter and Input
Changes to MAN_MUX_EN, Manual Input Muxing Enable,
Address 0xC4[7] Section and Table 12.........................................17
Changes to Identification Section.................................................21
Added Table 16; Renumbered Sequentially.................................21
Changes to Table 21 ........................................................................23
Changes to CIL[2:0], Count Into Lock, Address 0x51[2:0]
Section and COL[2:0], Count Out of Lock, Address 0x51[5:3]
Section ..............................................................................................25
Changes to Table 32 and Table 33.................................................30
Changes to Table 34 ........................................................................32
Changes to Table 42 ........................................................................35
Changes to Table 52 ........................................................................38
Changes to Table 53 and Table 56.................................................39
Changes to Table 61 and Figure 32...............................................43
Added SQPE, Square Pixel Mode, Address 0x01[2] Section.....44
Changes to NEWAVMODE, New AV Mode, Address 0x31[4]
Section ..............................................................................................44
Changes to Figure 34 ......................................................................45
Changes to NFTOG[4:0], NTSC Field Toggle,
PWRDWN
Current (
) Parameter, Table 3 ......................................7
Added Figure 11 and Table 12; Renumbered Sequentially........16
Changes to MAN_MUX_EN, Manual Input Muxing Enable,
Address 0xC4[7] Section................................................................19
Added GDE_SEL_OLD_ADF Bit Description, Table 107 ........92
Moved 32-Lead LFCSP Section...................................................108
Added Figure 58 ............................................................................112
Updated Outline Dimensions......................................................115
Changes to Ordering Guide.........................................................116
2/10—Rev. D to Rev. E
Added 32-Lead LFCSP ................................................ Throughout
Changes to Features ..........................................................................1
Changes to Figure 1...........................................................................1
Changes to Introduction ..................................................................4
Added Figure 4, Renumbered Sequentially ...................................8
Added Figure 9 and Table 11 .........................................................14
Changes to Figure 11 ......................................................................15
Changes to Table 12 and Table 13.................................................16
Address 0xE7[4:0] Section.............................................................47
Changes to PFTOG, PAL Field Toggle, Address 0xEA[4:0]
Section ..............................................................................................49
Changes to VDP Manuel Configuration Section .......................50
Changes to Table 66 ........................................................................51
Rev. G | Page 3 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Changes to Table 71........................................................................ 54
Changes to Table 72........................................................................ 55
Changes to VPS Section and PDC/UTC Section....................... 63
Changes to Gemstar_2x Format, Half-Byte Output Mode
11/06—Rev. 0 to Rev. A
Changes to Table 10 and Table 11 ................................................ 16
Changes to Table 30 ....................................................................... 28
Changes to Gain Operation Section ............................................ 33
Changes to Table 43 ....................................................................... 35
Changes to Table 97 ....................................................................... 72
Changes to Table 99 ....................................................................... 73
Changes to Table 103 ..................................................................... 80
Changes to Figure 54.................................................................... 110
Section.............................................................................................. 66
Changes to NTSC CCAP Data Section and PAL CCAP Data
Section.............................................................................................. 69
Changes to Figure 48...................................................................... 74
Changes to I2C Sequencer Section ............................................... 75
Changes to Table 102...................................................................... 76
Changes to Table 104...................................................................... 80
Changes to Table 105...................................................................... 97
Changes to Figure 53.................................................................... 108
Changes to Figure 54.................................................................... 109
Added Exposed Paddle Notation to Outline Dimensions ...... 110
Changes to Ordering Guide ........................................................ 111
1/06—Revision 0: Initial Version
2/07—Rev. A to Rev. B
Changes to SFL_INV, Subcarrier Frequency Lock Inversion
Section.............................................................................................. 24
Changes to Table 103, Register 0x41............................................ 90
Updated Outline Dimensions..................................................... 111
Rev. G | Page 4 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
INTRODUCTION
The ADV7180 is a versatile one-chip multiformat video decoder
that automatically detects and converts PAL, NTSC, and SECAM
standards in the form of composite, S-Video, and component
video into a digital ITU-R BT.656 format.
STANDARD DEFINITION PROCESSOR
The ADV7180 is capable of decoding a large selection of baseband
video signals in composite, S-Video, and component formats.
The video standards supported by the video processor include
PAL B/D/I/G/H, PAL 60, PAL M, PAL N, PAL Nc, NTSC M/J,
NTSC 4.43, and SECAM B/D/G/K/L. The ADV7180 can
The simple digital output interface connects gluelessly to a wide
range of MPEG encoders, codecs, mobile video processors, and
Analog Devices digital video encoders, such as the ADV7391.
External HS, VS, and FIELD signals provide timing references
for LCD controllers and other video ASICs that do not support the
ITU-R BT.656 interface standard. The different package options
available for the ADV7180 are shown in Table 2.
automatically detect the video standard and process it accordingly.
The ADV7180 has a five-line, superadaptive, 2D comb filter
that gives superior chrominance and luminance separation
when decoding a composite video signal. This highly adaptive filter
automatically adjusts its processing mode according to the video
standard and signal quality without requiring user intervention.
Video user controls such as brightness, contrast, saturation, and
hue are also available with the ADV7180.
ANALOG FRONT END
The ADV7180 analog front end comprises a single high speed,
10-bit analog-to-digital converter (ADC) that digitizes the
analog video signal before applying it to the standard definition
processor. The analog front end employs differential channels to
the ADC to ensure high performance in mixed-signal applications.
The ADV7180 implements a patented ADLLT™ algorithm to
track varying video line lengths from sources such as a VCR.
ADLLT enables the ADV7180 to track and decode poor quality
video sources such as VCRs and noisy sources from tuner outputs,
VCD players, and camcorders. The ADV7180 contains a chroma
transient improvement (CTI) processor that sharpens the edge
rate of chroma transitions, resulting in sharper vertical transitions.
The front end also includes a 3-channel input mux that enables
multiple composite video signals to be applied to the ADV7180.
Current clamps are positioned in front of the ADC to ensure
that the video signal remains within the range of the converter.
A resistor divider network is required before each analog input
channel to ensure that the input signal is kept within the range
of the ADC (see Figure 27). Fine clamping of the video signal
is performed downstream by digital fine clamping within the
ADV7180.
The video processor can process a variety of VBI data services,
such as closed captioning (CCAP), wide screen signaling (WSS),
copy generation management system (CGMS), EDTV, Gemstar®
1×/2×, and extended data service (XDS). Teletext data slicing
for world standard teletext (WST), along with program delivery
control (PDC) and video programming service (VPS), are
provided. Data is transmitted via the 8-bit video output port as
ancillary data packets (ANC). The ADV7180 is fully Macrovision®
certified; detection circuitry enables Type I, Type II, and Type III
protection levels to be identified and reported to the user. The
decoder is also fully robust to all Macrovision signal inputs.
Table 1 shows the three ADC clocking rates that are determined by
the video input format to be processed—that is, INSEL[3:0].
These clock rates ensure 4× oversampling per channel for CVBS
mode and 2× oversampling per channel for Y/C and YPrPb modes.
Table 1. ADC Clock Rates
Oversampling
Rate per Channel
Input Format
CVBS
ADC Clock Rate (MHz)1
57.27
86
86
4×
2×
2×
Y/C (S-Video)2
YPrPb
1 Based on a 28.6363 MHz crystal between the XTAL and XTAL1 pins.
2 See INSEL[3:0] in Table 107 for the mandatory write for Y/C (S-Video) mode.
Table 2. ADV7180 Selection Guide
Part Number
Package Type
32-lead LFCSP
32-lead LFCSP
40-lead LFCSP
40-lead LFCSP
64-lead LQFP
64-lead LQFP
48-lead LQFP
Analog Inputs
Digital Outputs
8-bit
8-bit
8-bit
8-bit
8-bit/16-bit
8-bit/16-bit
8-bit
Temperature Grade
−10°C to +70°C
−40°C to +85°C
−40°C to +85°C
−40°C to +125°C
−40°C to +85°C
−40°C to +125°C
−40°C to +85°C
ADV7180KCP32Z
ADV7180WBCP32Z (Automotive)1
ADV7180BCPZ
ADV7180WBCPZ (Automotive)1
ADV7180BSTZ
ADV7180WBSTZ (Automotive)1
ADV7180WBST48Z (Automotive)1
3
3
3
3
6
6
6
1 Automotive qualification completed.
Rev. G | Page 5 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAMS
CLOCK PROCESSING BLOCK
XTAL1
XTAL
LLC
PLL
ADLLT PROCESSING
8-BIT
PIXEL DATA
DIGITAL
PROCESSING
BLOCK
10-BIT, 86MHz
ADC
P7 TO P0
AA
FILTER
A
A
A
1
2
3
IN
IN
IN
2D COMB
ANALOG
VIDEO
INPUTS
HS
AA
FILTER
SHA
A/D
VBI SLICER
VS/FIELD
SFL
AA
FILTER
COLOR
DEMOD
INTRQ
2
REFERENCE
I C/CONTROL
SCLK SDATA ALSB RESET
Figure 2. 32-Lead LFCSP Functional Diagram
CLOCK PROCESSING BLOCK
XTAL1
XTAL
LLC
PLL
ADLLT PROCESSING
8-BIT
PIXEL DATA
DIGITAL
PROCESSING
BLOCK
10-BIT, 86MHz
ADC
P7 TO P0
AA
FILTER
A
A
A
1
2
3
IN
IN
IN
2D COMB
ANALOG
VIDEO
INPUTS
HS
AA
FILTER
SHA
A/D
VBI SLICER
VS/FIELD
SFL
AA
FILTER
COLOR
DEMOD
INTRQ
2
REFERENCE
I C/CONTROL
SCLK SDATA ALSB RESET PWRDWN
Figure 3. 40-Lead LFCSP Functional Block Diagram
CLOCK PROCESSING BLOCK
XTAL1
XTAL
LLC
PLL
ADLLT PROCESSING
16-BIT
PIXEL DATA
DIGITAL
PROCESSING
BLOCK
10-BIT, 86MHz
ADC
P15 TO P0
A
A
A
A
A
A
1
2
3
4
5
6
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
AA
FILTER
2D COMB
HS
ANALOG
VIDEO
INPUTS
AA
FILTER
SHA
A/D
VS
VBI SLICER
FIELD
AA
FILTER
COLOR
DEMOD
GPO0 TO GPO3
SFL
INTRQ
2
REFERENCE
I C/CONTROL
SCLK SDATA ALSB RESET PWRDWN
Figure 4. 64-Lead LQFP Functional Block Diagram
Rev. G | Page 6 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
CLOCK PROCESSING BLOCK
XTAL1
XTAL
LLC
PLL
ADLLT PROCESSING
8-BIT
PIXEL DATA
DIGITAL
PROCESSING
BLOCK
10-BIT, 86MHz
ADC
P7 TO P0
A
A
A
A
A
A
1
2
3
4
5
6
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
AA
FILTER
2D COMB
ANALOG
VIDEO
INPUTS
AA
FILTER
HS
SHA
A/D
VBI SLICER
VS/FIELD
GPO0 TO GPO3
SFL
AA
FILTER
COLOR
DEMOD
INTRQ
2
REFERENCE
I C/CONTROL
SCLK SDATA ALSB RESET PWRDWN
Figure 5. 48-Lead LQFP Functional Block Diagram
Rev. G | Page 7 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
SPECIFICATIONS
ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
AVDD = 1.71 V to 1.89 V, DVDD = 1.65 V to 2.0 V, DVDDIO = 1.62 V to 3.6 V, PVDD = 1.65 V to 2.0 V, specified at operating temperature range,
unless otherwise noted.
Table 3.
Parameter
Symbol
Test Conditions/Comments
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
STATIC PERFORMANCE
Resolution (Each ADC)
Integral Nonlinearity
Differential Nonlinearity
DIGITAL INPUTS
N
INL
DNL
10
Bits
LSB
LSB
BSL in CVBS mode
CVBS mode
2
−0.6/+0.6
Input High Voltage (DVDDIO = 3.3 V)
Input High Voltage (DVDDIO = 1.8 V)
Input Low Voltage (DVDDIO = 3.3 V)
Input Low Voltage (DVDDIO = 1.8 V)
Crystal Inputs
VIH
VIH
VIL
VIL
VIH
VIL
IIN
2
1.2
V
V
V
V
V
V
µA
µA
µA
pF
0.8
0.4
1.2
0.4
Input Current
−10
−10
−10
+10
+15
+40
10
Input Current (SDA, SCLK)1
Input Current (PWRDWN)2
Input Capacitance
IIN
IIN
CIN
DIGITAL OUTPUTS
Output High Voltage (DVDDIO = 3.3 V)
Output High Voltage (DVDDIO = 1.8 V)
Output Low Voltage (DVDDIO = 3.3 V)
Output Low Voltage (DVDDIO = 1.8 V)
High Impedance Leakage Current
Output Capacitance
VOH
VOH
VOL
VOL
ILEAK
COUT
ISOURCE = 0.4 mA
ISOURCE = 0.4 mA
ISINK = 3.2 mA
ISINK = 1.6 mA
2.4
1.4
V
V
V
V
µA
pF
0.4
0.2
10
20
POWER REQUIREMENTS3, 4, 5
Digital Power Supply
Digital I/O Power Supply
PLL Power Supply
Analog Power Supply
Digital Supply Current
Digital I/O Supply Current6
DVDD
DVDDIO
PVDD
AVDD
IDVDD
IDVDDIO
IPVDD
1.65
1.62
1.65
1.71
1.8
3.3
1.8
1.8
77
3
12
33
59
77
6
0.1
1
1
15
20
2
V
V
V
V
3.6
2.0
1.89
85
5
15
43
75
94
10
1
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
µA
µA
µA
µA
µW
ms
PLL Supply Current
Analog Supply Current
IAVDD
CVBS input
Y/C input
YPrPb input
Power-Down Current
IDVDD
IDVDDIO
IPVDD
5
5
44
IAVDD
Total Power Dissipation in Power-Down Mode7
Power-Up Time
tPWRUP
1 ADV7180KCP32Z, ADV7180WBCP32Z, and ADV7180WBST48Z only.
2 ADV7180WBST48Z only.
3 Guaranteed by characterization.
4 Typical current consumption values are recorded with nominal voltage supply levels and a SMPTEBAR pattern.
5 Maximum current consumption values are recorded with maximum rated voltage supply levels and a multiburst pattern.
6 Typical (Typ) number is measured with DVDDIO = 3.3 V and maximum (Max) number is measured with DVDDIO = 3.6 V.
7 ADV7180 clocked.
Rev. G | Page 8 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
VIDEO SPECIFICATIONS
Guaranteed by characterization. AVDD = 1.71 V to 1.89 V, DVDD = 1.65 V to 2.0 V, DVDDIO = 1.62 V to 3.6 V, PVDD = 1.65 V to 2.0 V, specified
at operating temperature range, unless otherwise noted.
Table 4.
Parameter
Symbol
Test Conditions/Comments
Min Typ
Max
Unit
NONLINEAR SPECIFICATIONS
Differential Phase
Differential Gain
Luma Nonlinearity
NOISE SPECIFICATIONS
SNR Unweighted
DP
DG
LNL
CVBS input, modulate five-step [NTSC]
CVBS input, modulate five-step [NTSC]
CVBS input, five-step [NTSC]
0.6
0.5
2.0
Degrees
%
%
Luma ramp
57.1
58
60
dB
dB
dB
Luma flat field
Analog Front-End Crosstalk
LOCK TIME SPECIFICATIONS
Horizontal Lock Range
Vertical Lock Range
fSC Subcarrier Lock Range
Color Lock-In Time
−5
40
1.3
60
20
5
+5
70
%
Hz
kHz
Lines
%
Sync Depth Range
Color Burst Range
200
200
%
Vertical Lock Time
Autodetection Switch Speed
Chroma Luma Gain Delay
2
Fields
Lines
ns
ns
ns
100
2.9
5.6
−3.0
CVBS
Y/C
YPrPb
LUMA SPECIFICATIONS
Luma Brightness Accuracy
Luma Contrast Accuracy
CVBS, 1 V input
CVBS, 1 V input
1
1
%
%
Rev. G | Page 9 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
TIMING SPECIFICATIONS
Guaranteed by characterization. AVDD = 1.71 V to 1.89 V, DVDD = 1.65 V to 2.0 V, DVDDIO = 1.62 V to 3.6 V, PVDD = 1.65 V to 2.0 V, specified
at operating temperature range, unless otherwise noted.
Table 5.
Parameter
Symbol Test Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
SYSTEM CLOCK AND CRYSTAL
Nominal Frequency
Frequency Stability
28.6363
MHz
ppm
50
I2C PORT
SCLK Frequency
400
kHz
µs
µs
µs
µs
ns
ns
ns
µs
SCLK Minimum Pulse Width High
SCLK Minimum Pulse Width Low
Hold Time (Start Condition)
Setup Time (Start Condition)
SDA Setup Time
SCLK and SDA Rise Times
SCLK and SDA Fall Times
Setup Time for Stop Condition
RESET FEATURE
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
t7
t8
0.6
1.3
0.6
0.6
100
300
300
0.6
Reset Pulse Width
5
ms
CLOCK OUTPUTS
LLC Mark Space Ratio
DATA AND CONTROL OUTPUTS
Data Output Transitional Time
t9:t10
45:55
55:45 % duty cycle
t11
t12
Negative clock edge to start of valid data
(tACCESS = t10 − t11)
End of valid data to negative clock edge
(tHOLD = t9 + t12)
3.6
2.4
ns
ns
Data Output Transitional Time
Timing Diagrams
t5
t3
t3
SDATA
SCLK
t1
t6
t4
t7
t8
t2
Figure 6. I2C Timing
t9
t10
OUTPUT LLC
t11
t12
OUTPUTS P0 TO P15, VS,
HS, FIELD,
SFL
Figure 7. Pixel Port and Control Output Timing
Rev. G | Page 10 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
ANALOG SPECIFICATIONS
Guaranteed by characterization. AVDD = 1.71 V to 1.89 V, DVDD = 1.65 V to 2.0 V, DVDDIO = 1.62 V to 3.6 V, PVDD = 1.65 V to 2.0 V, specified
at operating temperature range, unless otherwise noted.
Table 6.
Parameter
Test Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
CLAMP CIRCUITRY
External Clamp Capacitor
Input Impedance
Large-Clamp Source Current
Large-Clamp Sink Current
Fine Clamp Source Current
Fine Clamp Sink Current
0.1
10
0.4
0.4
10
µF
Clamps switched off
MΩ
mA
mA
µA
10
µA
THERMAL SPECIFICATIONS
Table 7.
Parameter
Symbol Test Conditions
Min Typ Max Unit
THERMAL CHARACTERISTICS
Junction-to-Ambient Thermal
Resistance (Still Air)
θJA
4-layer PCB with solid ground plane, 32-lead LFCSP
32.5
°C/W
Junction-to-Case Thermal Resistance
Junction-to-Ambient Thermal
Resistance (Still Air)
θJC
θJA
4-layer PCB with solid ground plane, 32-lead LFCSP
4-layer PCB with solid ground plane, 40-lead LFCSP
2.3
30
°C/W
°C/W
Junction-to-Case Thermal Resistance
Junction-to-Ambient Thermal
Resistance (Still Air)
θJC
θJA
4-layer PCB with solid ground plane, 40-lead LFCSP
4-layer PCB with solid ground plane, 64-lead LQFP
3
47
°C/W
°C/W
Junction-to-Case Thermal Resistance
Junction-to-Ambient Thermal
Resistance (Still Air)
θJC
θJA
4-layer PCB with solid ground plane, 64-lead LQFP
4-layer PCB with solid ground plane, 48-lead LQFP
11.1
50
°C/W
°C/W
Junction-to-Case Thermal Resistance
θJC
4-layer PCB with solid ground plane, 48-lead LQFP
20
°C/W
Rev. G | Page 11 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS
This device is a high performance integrated circuit with an
ESD rating of <2 kV, and it is ESD sensitive. Proper precautions
should be taken for handling and assembly.
Table 8.
Parameter
AVDD to AGND
Rating
2.2 V
DVDD to DGND
PVDD to AGND
2.2 V
2.2 V
ESD CAUTION
DVDDIO to DGND
DVDDIO to AVDD
PVDD to DVDD
DVDDIO to PVDD
DVDDIO to DVDD
4 V
−0.3 V to +4 V
−0.3 V to +0.9 V
–0.3 V to +4 V
−0.3 V to +4 V
−0.3 V to +0.3 V
−0.3 V to +0.9 V
DGND − 0.3 V to DVDDIO + 0.3 V
DGND − 0.3 V to DVDDIO + 0.3 V
AGND − 0.3 V to AVDD + 0.3 V
140°C
AVDD to PVDD
AVDD to DVDD
Digital Inputs Voltage
Digital Outputs Voltage
Analog Inputs to AGND
Maximum Junction Temperature
(TJ max)
Storage Temperature Range
−65°C to +150°C
Infrared Reflow Soldering (20 sec) 260°C
Stresses above those listed under Absolute Maximum Ratings
may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress
rating only; functional operation of the device at these or any
other conditions above those indicated in the operational
section of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute
maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect
device reliability.
Rev. G | Page 12 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
PIN CONFIGURATIONS AND FUNCTION DESCRIPTIONS
32-LEAD LFCSP
PIN1
HS 1
DGND 2
DVDDIO 3
SFL 4
INDICATOR
24 A
23 A
3
2
IN
IN
22 AVDD
21 VREFN
20 VREFP
ADV7180
LFCSP
P7 5
P6 6
P5 7
TOP VIEW
(Not to Scale)
19 A
1
IN
18 PVDD
17 ELPF
P4 8
NOTES
1. THE EXPOSEDPAD MUST BE CONNECTEDTO GND.
Figure 8. 32-Lead LFCSP Pin Configuration
Table 9. 32-Lead LFCSP Pin Function Descriptions
Pin No.
Mnemonic
Type
Description
1
2, 29
3
4
HS
O
G
P
O
Horizontal Synchronization Output Signal.
Ground for Digital Supply.
Digital I/O Supply Voltage (1.8 V to 3.3 V).
Subcarrier Frequency Lock. This pin contains a serial output stream that can be used to lock the
subcarrier frequency when this decoder is connected to any Analog Devices digital video encoder.
DGND
DVDDIO
SFL
5 to 10, 15, 16
11
P7 to P2, P1, P0
LLC
O
O
Video Pixel Output Port.
Line-Locked Output Clock for the Output Pixel Data. Nominally 27 MHz but varies up or
down according to video line length.
12
13
XTAL1
XTAL
O
I
This pin should be connected to the 28.6363 MHz crystal or not connected if an external
1.8 V,28.6363 MHz clock oscillator source is used to clock the ADV7180. In crystal mode, the
crystal must be a fundamental crystal.
Input Pin for the 28.6363 MHz Crystal. This pin can be overdriven by an external 1.8 V,
28.6363 MHz clock oscillator source. In crystal mode, the crystal must be a fundamental crystal.
14, 30
17
18
19, 23, 24
20
21
DVDD
ELPF
PVDD
AIN1 to AIN3
VREFP
VREFN
AVDD
P
I
P
I
O
O
P
I
Digital Supply Voltage (1.8 V).
The recommended external loop filter must be connected to this ELPF pin, as shown in Figure 58.
PLL Supply Voltage (1.8 V).
Analog Video Input Channels.
Internal Voltage Reference Output. See Figure 58 for recommended output circuitry.
Internal Voltage Reference Output. See Figure 58 for recommended output circuitry.
Analog Supply Voltage (1.8 V).
System Reset Input. Active low. A minimum low reset pulse width of 5 ms is required to
reset the ADV7180 circuitry.
22
25
RESET
26
ALSB
I
This pin selects the I2C address for the ADV7180. For ALSB set to Logic 0, the address selected
for a write is 0x40; for ALSB set to Logic 1, the address selected is 0x42.
27
28
31
32
SDATA
SCLK
VS/FIELD
INTRQ
I/O
I
O
O
I2C Port Serial Data Input/Output Pin.
I2C Port Serial Clock Input. The maximum clock rate is 400 kHz.
Vertical Synchronization Output Signal/Field Synchronization Output Signal.
Interrupt Request Output. Interrupt occurs when certain signals are detected on the input video
(see Table 108).
EPAD (EP)
The exposed pad must be connected to GND.
Rev. G | Page 13 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
40-LEAD LFCSP
PIN 1
DVDDIO
SFL
DGND
DVDDIO
P7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
30
29
A
A
3
2
IN
IN
INDICATOR
28 AGND
27 AVDD
26 VREFN
25 VREFP
24 AGND
23 A 1
22 TEST_0
21 AGND
ADV7180
LFCSP
P6
P5
P4
P3
TOP VIEW
(Not to Scale)
IN
P2 10
NOTES
1. THE EXPOSED PAD MUST BE CONNECTED TO GND.
Figure 9. 40-Lead LFCSP Pin Configuration
Table 10. 40-Lead LFCSP Pin Function Descriptions
Pin No.
Mnemonic
DVDDIO
SFL
Type
Description
1, 4
2
P
O
Digital I/O Supply Voltage (1.8 V to 3.3 V).
Subcarrier Frequency Lock. This pin contains a serial output stream that can be used to lock the
subcarrier frequency when this decoder is connected to any Analog Devices digital video encoder.
3, 15, 35, 40
5 to 10, 16, 17
11
DGND
P7 to P2, P1, P0
LLC
G
O
O
Ground for Digital Supply.
Video Pixel Output Port.
Line-Locked Output Clock for the Output Pixel Data. Nominally 27 MHz but varies up or
down according to video line length.
12
13
XTAL1
XTAL
O
I
This pin should be connected to the 28.6363 MHz crystal or not connected if an external 1.8 V,
28.6363 MHz clock oscillator source is used to clock the ADV7180. In crystal mode, the crystal
must be a fundamental crystal.
Input Pin for the 28.6363 MHz Crystal. This pin can be overdriven by an external 1.8 V,
28.6363 MHz clock oscillator source. In crystal mode, the crystal must be a fundamental crystal.
14, 36
18
DVDD
PWRDWN
ELPF
PVDD
AGND
TEST_0
AIN1 to AIN3
VREFP
VREFN
AVDD
P
I
Digital Supply Voltage (1.8 V).
A logic low on this pin places the ADV7180 into power-down mode.
The recommended external loop filter must be connected to this ELPF pin, as shown in Figure 55.
PLL Supply Voltage (1.8 V).
Ground for Analog Supply.
This pin must be tied to DGND.
19
20
21, 24, 28
22
I
P
G
I
23, 29, 30
I
Analog Video Input Channels.
25
26
27
31
O
O
P
I
Internal Voltage Reference Output. See Figure 55 for recommended output circuitry.
Internal Voltage Reference Output. See Figure 55 for recommended output circuitry.
Analog Supply Voltage (1.8 V).
System Reset Input. Active low. A minimum low reset pulse width of 5 ms is required to
reset the ADV7180 circuitry.
RESET
32
ALSB
I
This pin selects the I2C address for the ADV7180. For ALSB set to Logic 0, the address selected
for a write is 0x40; for ALSB set to Logic 1, the address selected is 0x42.
33
34
37
38
SDATA
SCLK
VS/FIELD
INTRQ
I/O
I
O
O
I2C Port Serial Data Input/Output Pin.
I2C Port Serial Clock Input. The maximum clock rate is 400 kHz.
Vertical Synchronization Output Signal/Field Synchronization Output Signal.
Interrupt Request Output. Interrupt occurs when certain signals are detected on the input video
(see Table 108).
39
HS
EPAD (EP)
O
Horizontal Synchronization Output Signal.
The exposed pad must be connected to GND.
Rev. G | Page 14 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
64-LEAD LQFP
64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49
1
2
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
INTRQ
HS
A
A
A
5
4
3
IN
IN
IN
PIN 1
3
DGND
DVDDIO
P11
4
NC
NC
5
6
P10
AGND
NC
ADV7180
7
P9
LQFP
TOP VIEW
(Not to Scale)
8
P8
NC
9
SFL
AVDD
VREFN
VREFP
AGND
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
DGND
DVDDIO
GPO1
GPO0
P7
A
A
2
1
IN
IN
P6
TEST_0
NC
P5
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
NC = NO CONNECT
Figure 10. 64-Lead LQFP Pin Configuration
Table 11. 64-Lead LQFP Pin Function Description
Pin No.
Mnemonic
Type Description
1
INTRQ
O
Interrupt Request Output. Interrupt occurs when certain signals are detected on the input
video (see Table 108).
2
HS
DGND
DVDDIO
O
G
P
Horizontal Synchronization Output Signal.
Digital Ground.
Digital I/O Supply Voltage (1.8 V to 3.3 V).
3, 10, 24, 57
4, 11
5 to 8, 14 to 19,
25, 26, 59 to 62
P11 to P8,
P7 to P2, P1,
P0, P15 to P12
O
Video Pixel Output Port. See Table 100 for output configuration for 8-bit and 16-bit modes.
9
SFL
O
Subcarrier Frequency Lock. This pin contains a serial output stream that can be used to lock
the subcarrier frequency when this decoder is connected to any Analog Devices digital
video encoder.
12, 13, 55, 56
20
GPO0 to GPO3
LLC
O
O
General-Purpose Outputs. These pins can be configured via I2C to allow control of external devices.
This is a line-locked output clock for the pixel data output by the ADV7180. It is nominally
27 MHz but varies up or down according to video line length.
21
XTAL1
XTAL
O
I
This pin should be connected to the 28.6363 MHz crystal or left as a no connect if an external
1.8 V, 28.6363 MHz clock oscillator source is used to clock the ADV7180. In crystal mode,
the crystal must be a fundamental crystal.
This is the input pin for the 28.6363 MHz crystal, or this pin can be overdriven by an external
1.8 V, 28.6363 MHz clock oscillator source. In crystal mode, the crystal must be a fundamental
crystal.
22
23, 58
DVDD
P
Digital Supply Voltage (1.8 V).
27, 28, 33, 41, 42, NC
44, 45, 50
No Connect. These pins are not connected internally.
29
PWRDWN
I
A logic low on this pin places the ADV7180 in power-down mode.
The recommended external loop filter must be connected to the ELPF pin, as shown in Figure 56.
PLL Supply Voltage (1.8 V).
Analog Ground.
This pin must be tied to DGND.
30
31
ELPF
PVDD
AGND
TEST_0
AIN1 to AIN6
I
P
G
I
32, 37, 43
34
35, 36, 46 to 49
I
Analog Video Input Channels.
Rev. G | Page 15 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Pin No.
38
39
40
51
Mnemonic
VREFP
VREFN
AVDD
Type Description
O
O
P
I
Internal Voltage Reference Output. See Figure 56 for recommended output circuitry.
Internal Voltage Reference Output. See Figure 56 for recommended output circuitry.
Analog Supply Voltage (1.8 V).
System Reset Input. Active low. A minimum low reset pulse width of 5 ms is required to reset
the ADV7180 circuitry.
RESET
52
ALSB
I
This pin selects the I2C address for the ADV7180. For ALSB set to Logic 0, the address selected
for a write is 0x40; for ALSB set to Logic 1, the address selected is 0x42.
53
54
63
64
SDATA
SCLK
FIELD
VS
I/O
I
O
O
I2C Port Serial Data Input/Output Pin.
I2C Port Serial Clock Input. The maximum clock rate is 400 kHz.
Field Synchronization Output Signal.
Vertical Synchronization Output Signal.
Rev. G | Page 16 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
48-LEAD LQFP
48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37
1
2
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
DGND
DVDDIO
SFL
A
A
A
A
6
5
4
3
IN
IN
IN
IN
PIN 1
3
4
DVDDIO
GPO1
GPO0
P7
5
AGND
AVDD
ADV7180
6
LQFP
TOP VIEW
(Not to Scale)
7
VFEFN
VREFP
AGND
8
P6
9
P5
10
11
12
P4
A
A
2
1
IN
IN
P3
P2
PVDD
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
NC = NO CONNECT
Figure 11. 48-Lead LQFP Pin Configuration
Table 12. 48-Lead LQFP Pin Function Descriptions
Pin No.
Mnemonic
Type Description
1, 13, 19, 43
2, 4
3
DGND
DVDDIO
SFL
G
P
O
Digital Ground.
Digital I/O Supply Voltage (1.8V to 3.3 V).
Subcarrier Frequency Lock. This pin contains a serial output stream that can be used to lock the
subcarrier frequency when this decoder is connected to any Analog Devices digital video encoder.
General-Purpose Outputs. These pins can be configured via I2C to allow control of external devices.
Video Pixel Output Port. See Table 100 for output configuration for 8-bit and 16-bit modes.
This is a line-locked output clock for the pixel data output by the ADV7180. It is nominally
27 MHz but varies up or down according to video line length.
5, 6, 41, 42
7 to 12, 20, 22
14
GPO0 to GPO3
P7 to P2, P1, P0
LLC
O
O
O
15, 48
16
NC
XTAL1
No Connect Pins. These pins are not connected internally.
O
I
This pin should be connected to the 28.6363 MHz crystal or left as a no connect if an external 1.8 V,
28.6363 MHz clock oscillator source is used to clock the ADV7180. In crystal mode, the crystal
must be a fundamental crystal.
This is the input pin for the 28.6363 MHz crystal, or this pin can be overdriven by an external 1.8 V,
28.6363 MHz clock oscillator source. In crystal mode, the crystal must be a fundamental crystal.
17
XTAL
18, 44
21
DVDD
PWRDWN
AGND
P
I
Digital Supply Voltage (1.8 V).
A logic low on this pin places the ADV7180 in power-down mode.
Analog Ground.
23, 28, 32
G
24
25
ELPF
PVDD
AIN1 to AIN6
VREFP
VREFN
AVDD
I
P
I
O
O
P
I
The recommended external loop filter must be connected to the ELPF pin, as shown in Figure 57.
PLL Supply Voltage (1.8 V).
Analog Video Input Channels.
Internal Voltage Reference Output. See Figure 57 for recommended output circuitry.
Internal Voltage Reference Output. See Figure 57 for recommended output circuitry.
Analog Supply Voltage (1.8 V).
System Reset Input. Active low. A minimum low reset pulse width of 5 ms is required to reset
the ADV7180 circuitry.
26, 27, 33 to 36
29
30
31
37
RESET
38
ALSB
I
This pin selects the I2C address for the ADV7180. For ALSB set to Logic 0, the address selected
for a write is 0x40; for ALSB set to Logic 1, the address selected is 0x42.
39
40
45
46
SDATA
SCLK
VS/FIELD
INTRQ
I/O
I
O
O
I2C Port Serial Data Input/Output Pin.
I2C Port Serial Clock Input. The maximum clock rate is 400 kHz.
Vertical Synchronization Output Signal/Field Synchronization Output Signal.
Interrupt Request Output. Interrupt occurs when certain signals are detected on the input video
(see Table 108).
47
HS
O
Horizontal Synchronization Output Signal.
Rev. G | Page 17 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
ANALOG FRONT END
MAN_MUX_EN
A
A
A
A
A
A
2
IN
1
MUX_0[2:0]
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
4
3
6
5
A
A
A
A
4
3
6
5
IN
IN
IN
IN
MUX_1[2:0]
MUX_2[2:0]
ADC
A
A
A
2
6
5
IN
IN
IN
Figure 12. 64-Lead and 48-Lead LQFP Internal Pin Connections
MAN_MUX_EN
A
A
A
1
2
3
MUX_0[2:0]
IN
IN
IN
A
A
2
3
IN
IN
MUX_1[2:0]
MUX_2[2:0]
ADC
A
3
IN
Figure 13. 40-Lead and 32-Lead LFCSP Internal Pin Connections
Rev. G | Page 18 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
INPUT CONFIGURATION
Table 13. 64-Lead and 48-Lead LQFP INSEL[3:0]
The following are the two key steps for configuring the
ADV7180 to correctly decode the input video:
INSEL[3:0]
Video Format
Composite
Composite
Composite
Composite
Composite
Composite
Y/C (S-Video)
Analog Input
0000
0001
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110
CVBS input on AIN1
CVBS input on AIN2
CVBS input on AIN3
CVBS input on AIN4
CVBS input on AIN5
CVBS input on AIN6
Y input on AIN1
C input on AIN4
Y input on AIN2
C input on AIN5
Y input on AIN3
C input on AIN6
Y input on AIN1
Pb input on AIN4
Pr input on AIN5
Y input on AIN2
Pr input on AIN6
Pb input on AIN3
Reserved
1. Use INSEL[3:0] to configure the routing and format decoding
(CVBS, Y/C, or YPrPb). For the 64-lead and 48-lead L QF P,
see Table 13. For the 40-lead and 32-lead LFCSP, see Table 14.
2. If the input requirements are not met using the INSEL[3:0]
options, the analog input muxing section must be configured
manually to correctly route the video from the analog
input pins to the ADC. The standard definition processor
block, which decodes the digital data, should be configured
to process the CVBS, Y/C, or YPrPb format. This is performed
by INSEL[3:0] selection.
0111
1000
1001
Y/C (S-Video)
Y/C (S-Video)
YPrPb
CONNECT ANALOG VIDEO
SIGNALS TO ADV7180.
SET INSEL[3:0] TO CONFIGURE
VIDEO FORMAT. USE PREDEFINED
FORMAT/ROUTING.
1010
YPrPb
NO
1011 to 1111
Reserved
YES
LQFP-64
LQFP-48
LFCSP-40
LFCSP-32
Table 14. 40-Lead and 32-Lead LFCSP INSEL[3:0]
CONFIGURE ADC INPUTS USING
MANUAL MUXING CONTROL BITS:
MUX_0[2:0], MUX_1[2:0], MUX_2[2:0].
SEE TABLE 15.
INSEL[3:0]
Video Format
Composite
Reserved
Composite
Composite
Reserved
Analog Input
CVBS input on AIN1
Reserved
CVBS input on AIN2
CVBS input on AIN3
Reserved
REFER TO
TABLE 13
REFER TO
TABLE 14
0000
0001 to 0010
0011
0100
0101
Figure 14. Signal Routing Options
INSEL[3:0], Input Selection, Address 0x00[3:0]
The INSEL bits allow the user to select the input format. They
also configure the standard definition processor core to process
composite (CVBS), S-Video (Y/C), or component (YPrPb) format.
0110
Y/C (S-Video)
Y input on AIN1
C input on AIN2
Reserved
Y input on AIN1
Pr input on AIN3
Pb input on AIN2
Reserved
0111 to 1000
1001
Reserved
YPrPb
INSEL[3:0] has predefined analog input routing schemes that
do not require manual mux programming (see Table 13 and
Table 14). This allows the user to route the various video signal
types to the decoder and select them using INSEL[3:0] only.
The added benefit is that if, for example, the CVBS input is
selected, the remaining channels are powered down.
1010 to 1111
Reserved
Rev. G | Page 19 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
MAN_MUX_EN, Manual Input Muxing Enable,
Address 0xC4[7]
POWER-ON RESET
After power-up, it is necessary to execute a reset operation. For
To configure the ADV7180 analog muxing section, the user
must select the analog input (AIN1 to AIN6 for the 64-lead LQFP
and 48-lead devices or AIN1 to AIN3 for the 40-lead and 32-lead
LFCSP devices) that is to be processed by the ADC. MAN_MUX_
EN must be set to 1 to enable the following muxing blocks:
RESET
correct operation,
5 ms after power supplies are stable and within specification
PWRDWN
should remain asserted/pulled low for
and
pulled high.
(not available in 32-lead LFCSP) is deasserted/
ANALOG INPUT MUXING
•
•
•
MUX0[2:0], ADC Mux Configuration, Address 0xC3[2:0]
MUX1[2:0], ADC Mux Configuration, Address 0xC3[6:4]
MUX2[2:0], ADC Mux Configuration, Address 0xC4[2:0]
The ADV7180 has an integrated analog muxing section that
allows more than one source of video signal to be connected to
the decoder. Figure 12 and Figure 13 outline the overall structure of
the input muxing provided in the ADV7180.
The three mux sections are controlled by the signal buses MUX0/
MUX1/MUX2[2:0]. Table 15 explains the control words used.
A maximum of six CVBS inputs can be connected to and
decoded by the 64-lead and 48-lead devices, and a maximum of
three CVBS inputs can be connected to and decoded by the 40-lead
and 32-lead LFCSP devices. As shown in the Pin Configurations
and Function Description section, these analog input pins lie in
close proximity to one another, which requires careful design of
the printed circuit board (PCB) layout. For example, ground
shielding between all signals should be routed through tracks that are
physically close together. It is strongly recommended to connect
any unused analog input pins to AGND to act as a shield.
The input signal that contains the timing information (HS and VS)
must be processed by MUX0. For example, in a Y/C input
configuration, MUX0 should be connected to the Y channel
and MUX1 to the C channel. When one or more muxes are not
used to process video, such as the CVBS input, the idle mux and
associated channel clamps and buffers should be powered down
(see the description of Register 0x3A in Table 107).
Table 15. Manual Mux Settings for the ADC (MAN_MUX_EN Must be Set to 1)
ADC Connected To ADC Connected To
LQFP-64 or LFCSP-40 or LQFP-64 or LFCSP-40 or
ADC Connected To
LQFP-64 or LFCSP-40 or
MUX0[2:0]
LQFP-48
No connect
AIN1
AIN2
AIN3
LFCSP-32
No connect
AIN1
No connect
No connect
AIN2
MUX1[2:0]
LQFP-48
No connect
No connect
No connect
AIN3
LFCSP-32
No connect
No connect
No connect
No connect
AIN2
MUX2[2:0]
000
001
010
011
LQFP-48
No connect
No connect
AIN2
LFCSP-32
No connect
No connect
No connect
No connect
No connect
AIN3
000
001
010
011
000
001
010
011
No connect
No connect
AIN5
100
AIN4
100
AIN4
100
101
101
AIN5
AIN3
101
AIN5
AIN3
110
111
AIN6
No connect
No connect
No connect
110
111
AIN6
No connect
No connect
No connect
110
111
AIN6
No connect
No connect
No connect
Note the following:
•
•
•
CVBS can only be processed by MUX0.
Y/C can only be processed by MUX0 and MUX1.
YPrPb can only be processed by MUX0, MUX1, and MUX2.
Rev. G | Page 20 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
AA_FILT_EN, Address 0xF3[1]
ANTIALIASING FILTERS
When AA_FILT_EN[1] is 0, AA Filter 2 is bypassed.
When AA_FILT_EN[1] is 1, AA Filter 2 is enabled.
AA_FILT_EN, Address 0xF3[2]
The ADV7180 has optional on-chip antialiasing (AA) filters on
each of the three channels that are multiplexed to the ADC (see
Figure 15). The filters are designed for standard definition video
up to 10 MHz bandwidth. Figure 16 and Figure 17 show the
filter magnitude and phase characteristics.
When AA_FILT_EN[2] is 0, AA Filter 3 is bypassed.
When AA_FILT_EN[2] is 1, AA Filter 3 is enabled.
The antialiasing filters are enabled by default and the selection
of INSEL[3:0] determines which filters are powered up at any
given time. For example, if CVBS mode is selected, the filter
circuits for the remaining input channels are powered down to
conserve power. However, the antialiasing filters can be disabled
or bypassed using the AA_FILT_MAN_OVR control.
0
–4
–8
–12
–16
–20
–24
–28
–32
–36
10-BIT, 86MHz
ADC
A
A
A
1
2
IN
IN
IN
AA
FILTER 1
3
1
AA
FILTER 2
SHA
A/D
A
4
5
6
IN
IN
IN
1
1
A
A
AA
FILTER 3
1k
10k
100k
1M
10M
100M
FREQUENCY (Hz)
Figure 16. Antialiasing Filter Magnitude Response
1
ONLY AVAILABLE IN 64-LEAD AND 48-LEAD PACKAGES.
0
Figure 15. Antialias Filter Configuration
–10
–20
AA_FILT_MAN_OVR, Antialiasing Filter Override,
Address 0xF3[3]
–30
–40
This feature allows the user to override the antialiasing filters
on/off settings, which are automatically selected by INSEL[3:0].
–50
–60
–70
AA_FILT_EN, Antialiasing Filter Enable, Address 0xF3[2:0]
–80
–90
These bits allow the user to enable or disable the antialiasing
filters on each of the three input channels multiplexed to the
ADC. When disabled, the analog signal bypasses the AA filter
and is routed directly to the ADC.
–100
–110
–120
–130
–140
–150
AA_FILT_EN, Address 0xF3[0]
1k
10k
100k
1M
10M
100M
When AA_FILT_EN[0] is 0, AA Filter 1 is bypassed.
When AA_FILT_EN[0] is 1, AA Filter 1 is enabled.
FREQUENCY (Hz)
Figure 17. Antialiasing Filter Phase Response
Rev. G | Page 21 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
GLOBAL CONTROL REGISTERS
Register control bits listed in this section affect the whole chip.
RESET
pin),
After setting the reset bit (or initiating a reset via the
the part returns to the default for its primary mode of operation.
All I2C bits are loaded with their default values, making this bit
self-clearing.
POWER-SAVING MODES
Power-Down
PDBP, Address 0x0F[2]
Executing a software reset takes approximately 2 ms. However,
it is recommended to wait 5 ms before any further I2C writes are
performed.
The I2C master controller receives a no acknowledge condition
on the ninth clock cycle when chip reset is implemented (see
the MPU Port Description section).
The digital supply of the ADV7180 can be shut down by using
2
1
PWRDWN
the
pin or via I C (see the PWRDWN, Address
0x0F[5] section). PDBP controls whether the I2C control or the
pin has the higher priority. The default is to give the pin
2
PWRDWN
(
) priority . This allows the user to have the
ADV7180 powered down by default at power-up without the
need for an I2C write.
When the reset bit is 0 (default), operation is normal.
When the reset bit is 1, the reset sequence starts.
When PDBP is 0 (default), the digital supply power is controlled by
2
PWRDWN
the
pin (the PWRDWN bit, 0x0F[5], is disregarded).
GLOBAL PIN CONTROL
Three-State Output Drivers
TOD, Address 0x03[6]
When PDBP is 1, the PWRDWN bit has priority (the pin is
disregarded).
PWRDWN, Address 0x0F[5]
This bit allows the user to three-state the output drivers of the
ADV7180.
When PDBP is set to 1, setting the PWRDWN bit switches the
ADV7180 to a chip-wide power-down mode. The power-down
stops the clock from entering the digital section of the chip,
thereby freezing its operation. No I2C bits are lost during power-
down. The PWRDWN bit also affects the analog blocks and
switches them into low current modes. The I2C interface is
unaffected and remains operational in power-down mode.
Upon setting the TOD bit, the P15 to P0 (P7 to P0 for the 48-lead,
40-lead, and 32-lead devices), HS, VS, FIELD (VS/FIELD pin for
the 48-lead, 40-lead, and 32-lead LFCSP), and SFL pins are
three-stated.
The timing pins (HS, VS, FIELD) can be forced active via the
TIM_OE bit. For more information on three-state control, see
the Three-State LLC Driver and the Timing Signals Output
Enable sections.
The ADV7180 leaves the power-down state if the PWRDWN bit is
2
RESET
set to 0 (via I C) or if the ADV7180 is reset using the
pin.
PDBP must be set to 1 for the PWRDWN bit to power down
the ADV7180.
Individual drive strength controls are provided via the
DR_STR_x bits.
When PWRDWN is 0 (default), the chip is operational. When
PWRDWN is 1, the ADV7180 is in a chip-wide power-down mode.
When TOD is 0 (default), the output drivers are enabled.
When TOD is 1, the output drivers are three-stated.
Three-State LLC Driver
RESET CONTROL
Reset, Chip Reset, Address 0x0F[7]
TRI_LLC, Address 0x1D[7]
RESET
Setting this bit, which is equivalent to controlling the
pin
This bit allows the output drivers for the LLC pin of the
ADV7180 to be three-stated. For more information on three-
state control, refer to the Three-State Output Drivers and the
Timing Signals Output Enable sections.
on the ADV7180, issues a full chip reset. All I2C registers are reset
to their default/power-up values. Note that some register bits do
not have a reset value specified. They keep their last written value.
Those bits are marked as having a reset value of x in the register
tables (see Table 107 and Table 108). After the reset sequence,
the part immediately starts to acquire the incoming video signal.
Individual drive strength controls are provided via the
DR_STR_x bits.
When TRI_LLC is 0 (default), the LLC pin drivers work
according to the DR_STR_C[1:0] setting (pin enabled).
1 For 32-lead, I2C is the only power-down option.
2 For 64-lead, 48-lead, and 40-lead only.
When TRI_LLC is 1, the LLC pin drivers are three-stated.
Rev. G | Page 22 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Timing Signals Output Enable
Table 17. DR_STR_C Function
TIM_OE, Address 0x04[3]
DR_STR_C[1:0]
Description
00
Low drive strength (1×)
The TIM_OE bit should be regarded as an addition to the TOD bit.
Setting it high forces the output drivers for HS, VS, and FIELD into
the active state (that is, driving state) even if the TOD bit is set.
If TIM_OE is set to low, the HS, VS, and FIELD pins are three-
stated depending on the TOD bit. This functionality is beneficial if
the decoder is only used as a timing generator. This may be the
case if only the timing signals are extracted from an incoming
signal or if the part is in free-run mode, where a separate chip
can output a company logo, for example.
01 (default)
10
11
Medium low drive strength (2×)
Medium high drive strength (3×)
High drive strength (4×)
Drive Strength Selection (Sync)
DR_STR_S[1:0], Address 0xF4[1:0]
The DR_STR_S[1:0] bits allow the user to select the strength of
the synchronization signals with which HS, VS, and FIELD are
driven. For more information, see the Drive Strength Selection
(Data) section.
For more information on three-state control, see the Three-
State Output Drivers section and the Three-State LLC Driver
section.
Table 18. DR_STR_S Function
Individual drive strength controls are provided via the
DR_STR_x bits.
DR_STR_S[1:0]
Description
00
Low drive strength (1×)
Medium low drive strength (2×)
Medium high drive strength (3×)
High drive strength (4×)
01 (default)
10
11
When TIM_OE is 0 (default), HS, VS, and FIELD are three-
stated according to the TOD bit.
When TIM_OE is 1, HS, VS, and FIELD are forced active all
the time.
Enable Subcarrier Frequency Lock Pin
EN_SFL_PIN, Address 0x04[1]
Drive Strength Selection (Data)
DR_STR[1:0], Address 0xF4[5:4]
The EN_SFL_PIN bit enables the output of subcarrier lock
information (also known as genlock) from the ADV7180 core
to an encoder in a decoder/encoder back-to-back arrangement.
For EMC and crosstalk reasons, it may be desirable to strengthen or
weaken the drive strength of the output drivers. The DR_STR[1:0]
bits affect the P[15:0] for the 64-lead device or P[7:0] for the
48-lead, 40-lead, and 32-lead devices output drivers.
When EN_SFL_PIN is 0 (default), the subcarrier frequency lock
output is disabled.
When EN_SFL_PIN is 1, the subcarrier frequency lock information
is presented on the SFL pin.
For more information on three-state control, see the Drive
Strength Selection (Clock) and the Drive Strength Selection
(Sync) sections.
Polarity LLC Pin
PCLK, Address 0x37[0]
Table 16. DR_STR Function
DR_STR[1:0]
Description
The polarity of the clock that leaves the ADV7180 via the LLC
pin can be inverted using the PCLK bit.
00
Low drive strength (1×)
Medium low drive strength (2×)
Medium high drive strength (3×)
High drive strength (4×)
01 (default)
10
11
Changing the polarity of the LLC clock output may be necessary to
meet the setup-and-hold time expectations of follow-on chips.
When PCLK is 0, the LLC output polarity is inverted.
Drive Strength Selection (Clock)
When PCLK is 1 (default), the LLC output polarity is normal
(see the Timing Specifications section).
DR_STR_C[1:0], Address 0xF4[3:2]
The DR_STR_C[1:0] bits can be used to select the strength of
the clock signal output driver (LLC pin). For more information,
see the Drive Strength Selection (Sync) and the Drive Strength
Selection (Data) sections.
Rev. G | Page 23 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
GLOBAL STATUS REGISTER
Four registers provide summary information about the video
decoder. The IDENT register allows the user to identify the
revision code of the ADV7180. The other three registers (0x10,
0x12, and 0x13) contain status bits from the ADV7180.
Table 21. Status 1 Function
Status 1[7:0]
Bit Name
Description
0
1
IN_LOCK
LOST_LOCK
In lock (now)
Lost lock (since last read of
this register)
fSC locked (now)
AGC follows peak white
algorithm
Result of autodetection
Result of autodetection
Result of autodetection
Color kill active
IDENTIFICATION
IDENT[7:0], Address 0x11[7:0]
2
3
FSC_LOCK
FOLLOW_PW
This is the register identification of the ADV7180’s revision.
Table 19 describes the various versions of the ADV7180.
4
5
6
7
AD_RESULT[0]
AD_RESULT[1]
AD_RESULT[2]
COL_KILL
Table 19. IDENT CODE
IDENT[7:0]
0x1B1
0x1C1
Description
Initial release silicon
Improved ESD and PDC fix
STATUS 2
Status 2[7:0], Address 0x12[7:0]
0x1E
48-lead and 32-lead devices only
1 64-lead and 40-lead models only.
Table 22. Status 2 Function
STATUS 1
Status 1[7:0], Address 0x10[7:0]
Status 2[7:0]
Bit Name
Description
0
MVCS DET
Detected Macrovision color
striping
Macrovision color striping
protection; conforms to Type 3
if high, Type 2 if low
Detected Macrovision pseudo-
sync pulses
Detected Macrovision AGC
pulses
This read-only register provides information about the internal
status of the ADV7180.
1
MVCS T3
See the CIL[2:0], Count Into Lock, Address 0x51[2:0] section
and the COL[2:0], Count Out of Lock, Address 0x51[5:3]
section for details on timing.
2
3
MV PS DET
MV AGC DET
Depending on the setting of the FSCLE bit, the Status Register 0
and Status Register 1 are based solely on horizontal timing
information or on the horizontal timing and lock status of
the color subcarrier. See the FSCLE, fSC Lock Enable, Address
0x51[7] section.
4
5
6
7
LL NSTD
Line length is nonstandard
fSC frequency is nonstandard
FSC NSTD
Reserved
Reserved
AUTODETECTION RESULT
AD_RESULT[2:0], Address 0x10[6:4]
STATUS 3
Status 3[7:0], Address 0x13[7:0]
The AD_RESULT[2:0] bits report back on the findings from the
ADV7180 autodetection block. See the General Setup section for
more information on enabling the autodetection block and the
Autodetection of SD Modes section for more information on
how to configure it.
Table 23. Status 3 Function
Status 3[7:0]
Bit Name
Description
0
INST_HLOCK
Horizontal lock indicator
(instantaneous)
1
2
GEMD
SD_OP_50Hz
Gemstar detect
Flags whether 50 Hz or 60 Hz is
present at output
Table 20. AD_RESULT Function
AD_RESULT[2:0]
Description
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
NTSC M/J
NTSC 4.43
PAL M
PAL 60
PAL B/G/H/I/D
SECAM
3
4
Reserved
Reserved for future use
FREE_RUN_ACT ADV7180 outputs a blue
screen (see the DEF_VAL_EN,
Default Value Enable,
Address 0x0C[0] section)
5
STD FLD LEN
Field length is correct for
currently selected video
standard
Interlaced video detected
(field sequence found)
PAL Combination N
SECAM 525
6
7
Interlaced
PAL_SW_LOCK
Reliable sequence of
swinging bursts detected
Rev. G | Page 24 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
VIDEO PROCESSOR
STANDARD DEFINITION PROCESSOR
MACROVISION
DETECTION
STANDARD
AUTODETECTION
SLLC
CONTROL
VBI DATA
RECOVERY
DIGITIZED CVBS
DIGITIZED Y (YC)
LUMA
DIGITAL
FINE
LUMA
GAIN
CONTROL
LUMA
FILTER
LUMA
RESAMPLE
LUMA
2D COMB
CLAMP
LINE
AV
SYNC
EXTRACT
RESAMPLE
CONTROL
VIDEO DATA
OUTPUT
LENGTH
CODE
PREDICTOR
INSERTION
DIGITIZED CVBS
DIGITIZED C (YC)
CHROMA
DIGITAL
FINE
CHROMA
GAIN
CONTROL
MEASUREMENT
BLOCK (≥ I C)
CHROMA
DEMOD
CHROMA
FILTER
CHROMA
RESAMPLE
CHROMA
2D COMB
2
CLAMP
VIDEO DATA
PROCESSING
BLOCK
f
SC
RECOVERY
Figure 18. Block Diagram of the Video Processor
Figure 18 shows a block diagram of the ADV7180 video processor.
The ADV7180 can handle standard definition video in CVBS,
Y/C, and YPrPb formats. It can be divided into a luminance and
chrominance path. If the input video is of a composite type
(CVBS), both processing paths are fed with the CVBS input.
SD CHROMA PATH
The input signal is processed by the following blocks:
•
Chroma digital fine clamp. This block uses a high precision
algorithm to clamp the video signal.
•
Chroma demodulation. This block employs a color
subcarrier (fSC) recovery unit to regenerate the color
subcarrier for any modulated chroma scheme. The
demodulation block then performs an AM demodulation
for PAL and NTSC, and an FM demodulation for SECAM.
Chroma filter. This block contains a chroma decimation
filter (CAA) with a fixed response and some shaping filters
(CSH) that have selectable responses.
Chroma gain control. AGC can operate on several different
modes, including gain based on the color subcarrier
amplitude, gain based on the depth of the horizontal sync
pulse on the luma channel, or fixed manual gain.
Chroma resample. The chroma data is digitally resampled
to keep it perfectly aligned with the luma data. The
resampling is done to correct for static and dynamic line
length errors of the incoming video signal.
SD LUMA PATH
The input signal is processed by the following blocks:
•
Luma digital fine clamp. This block uses a high precision
algorithm to clamp the video signal.
•
•
•
Luma filter. This block contains a luma decimation filter
(YAA) with a fixed response and some shaping filters
(YSH) that have selectable responses.
•
•
Luma gain control. The automatic gain control (AGC) can
operate on a variety of different modes, including gain based
on the depth of the horizontal sync pulse, peak white mode,
and fixed manual gain.
Luma resample. To correct for line length errors as well as
dynamic line length changes, the data is digitally resampled.
Luma 2D comb. The 2D comb filter provides Y/C separation.
AV code insertion. At this point, the decoded luma (Y) signal
is merged with the retrieved chroma values. AV codes can
be inserted (as per ITU-R BT.656).
•
•
•
•
•
Chroma 2D comb. The 2D, five line, superadaptive comb
filter provides high quality Y/C separation in case the input
signal is CVBS.
AV code insertion. At this point, the demodulated chroma
(Cr and Cb) signal is merged with the retrieved luma values.
AV codes can be inserted (as per ITU-R BT.656).
Rev. G | Page 25 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
SYNC PROCESSING
GENERAL SETUP
Video Standard Selection
The ADV7180 extracts syncs embedded in the analog input
video signal. There is currently no support for external HS/VS
inputs. The sync extraction is optimized to support imperfect
video sources, such as VCRs with head switches. The actual
algorithm used employs a coarse detection based on a threshold
crossing, followed by a more detailed detection using an adaptive
interpolation algorithm. The raw sync information is sent to a
line length measurement and prediction block. The output of
this is then used to drive the digital resampling section to
ensure that the ADV7180 outputs 720 active pixels per line.
The VID_SEL[3:0] bits (Address 0x00[7:4]) allow the user to
force the digital core into a specific video standard. Under
normal circumstances, this is not necessary. The VID_SEL[3:0]
bits default to an autodetection mode that supports PAL, NTSC,
SECAM, and variants thereof.
Autodetection of SD Modes
To guide the autodetect system of the ADV7180, individual
enable bits are provided for each of the supported video standards.
Setting the relevant bit to 0 inhibits the standard from being
detected automatically. Instead, the system chooses the closest of
the remaining enabled standards. The results of the autodetection
block can be read back via the status registers (see the Global
Status Register section for more information).
The sync processing on the ADV7180 also includes the following
specialized postprocessing blocks that filter and condition the
raw sync information retrieved from the digitized analog video:
•
VSYNC processor. This block provides extra filtering of the
detected VSYNCs to improve vertical lock.
VID_SEL[3:0], Address 0x00[7:4]
•
HSYNC processor. The HSYNC processor is designed to
filter incoming HSYNCs that have been corrupted by
noise, providing much improved performance for video
signals with a stable time base but poor SNR.
Table 24. VID_SEL Function
VID_SEL[3:0]
Description
0000 (default)
Autodetect (PAL B/G/H/I/D), NTSC J
(no pedestal), SECAM
VBI DATA RECOVERY
0001
0010
0011
Autodetect (PAL B/G/H/I/D), NTSC M
(pedestal), SECAM
Autodetect (PAL N) (pedestal), NTSC J
(no pedestal), SECAM
Autodetect (PAL N) (pedestal), NTSC M
(pedestal), SECAM
The ADV7180 can retrieve the following information from the
input video:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wide screen signaling (WSS)
Copy generation management system (CGMS)
Closed captioning (CCAP)
Macrovision protection presence
EDTV data
Gemstar-compatible data slicing
Teletext
VITC/VPS
0100
0101
0110
0111
1000
1001
1010
1011
1100
1101
1110
1111
NTSC J
NTSC M
PAL 60
NTSC 4.43
PAL B/G/H/I/D
PAL N = PAL B/G/H/I/D (with pedestal)
PAL M (without pedestal)
PAL M
PAL Combination N
PAL Combination N (with pedestal)
SECAM
The ADV7180 is also capable of automatically detecting the
incoming video standard with respect to
•
•
•
Color subcarrier frequency
Field rate
Line rate
SECAM (with pedestal)
AD_SEC525_EN, Enable Autodetection of SECAM 525
Line Video, Address 0x07[7]
The ADV7180 can configure itself to support PAL B/D/I/G/H,
PAL M, PAL N, PAL Combination N, NTSC M, NTSC J,
SECAM 50 Hz/60 Hz, NTSC 4.43, and PAL 60.
Setting AD_SEC525_EN to 0 (default) disables the autodetection
of a 525-line system with a SECAM style, FM-modulated color
component.
Setting AD_SEC525_EN to 1 enables the detection of a SECAM
style, FM-modulated color component.
Rev. G | Page 26 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
AD_SECAM_EN, Enable Autodetection of SECAM,
Address 0x07[6]
AD_PAL_EN, Enable Autodetection of PAL B/D/I/G/H,
Address 0x07[0]
Setting AD_SECAM_EN to 0 (default) disables the autodetection
of SECAM.
Setting AD_PAL_EN to 0 (default) disables the detection of
standard PAL.
Setting AD_SECAM_EN to 1 enables the detection of SECAM.
Setting AD_PAL_EN to 1 enables the detection of standard PAL.
SFL_INV, Subcarrier Frequency Lock Inversion
AD_N443_EN, Enable Autodetection of NTSC 4.43,
Address 0x07[5]
This bit controls the behavior of the PAL switch bit in the SFL
(genlock telegram) data stream. It was implemented to solve
some compatibility issues with video encoders. It solves two
problems.
Setting AD_N443_EN to 0 disables the autodetection of NTSC
style systems with a 4.43 MHz color subcarrier.
Setting AD_N443_EN to 1 (default) enables the detection of
NTSC style systems with a 4.43 MHz color subcarrier.
First, the PAL switch bit is only meaningful in PAL. Some
encoders (including Analog Devices encoders) also look at the
state of this bit in NTSC.
AD_P60_EN, Enable Autodetection of PAL 60,
Address 0x07[4]
Second, there was a design change in Analog Devices encoders
from ADV717x to ADV719x. The older versions used the SFL
(genlock telegram) bit directly, whereas the newer ones invert
the bit prior to using it. The reason for this is that the inversion
compensated for the one line delay of an SFL (genlock telegram)
transmission.
Setting AD_P60_EN to 0 disables the autodetection of PAL
systems with a 60 Hz field rate.
Setting AD_P60_EN to 1 (default) enables the detection of PAL
systems with a 60 Hz field rate.
AD_PALN_EN, Enable Autodetection of PAL N,
Address 0x07[3]
As a result, for the ADV717x and ADV73xx encoders, the PAL
switch bit in the SFL (genlock telegram) must be 0 for NTSC to
work. For the ADV7194 video encoder, the PAL switch bit in the
SFL must be 1 to work in NTSC. If the state of the PAL switch bit
is wrong, a 180° phase shift occurs.
Setting AD_PALN_EN to 0 (default) disables the detection of
the PAL N standard.
Setting AD_PALN_EN to 1 enables the detection of the PAL N
standard.
In a decoder/encoder back-to-back system in which SFL is used,
this bit must be set up properly for the specific encoder used.
AD_PALM_EN, Enable Autodetection of PAL M,
Address 0x07[2]
SFL_INV, Subcarrier Frequency Lock Inversion,
Address 0x41[6]
Setting AD_PALM_EN to 0 (default) disables the autodetection
of PAL M.
Setting SFL_INV to 0 (default) makes the part SFL compatible
with the ADV717x and ADV73xx video encoders.
Setting AD_PALM_EN to 1 enables the detection of PAL M.
AD_NTSC_EN, Enable Autodetection of NTSC,
Address 0x07[1]
Setting SFL_INV to 1 makes the part SFL compatible with the
ADV7194 video encoder.
Setting AD_NTSC_EN to 0 (default) disables the detection of
standard NTSC.
Lock Related Controls
Lock information is presented to the user through Bits[1:0] of
the Status 1 register (see the Status 1[7:0], Address 0x10[7:0]
section). Figure 19 outlines the signal flow and the controls
available to influence the way the lock status information is
generated.
Setting AD_NTSC_EN to 1 enables the detection of standard NTSC.
SELECT THE RAW LOCK SIGNAL
SRLS
FILTER THE RAW LOCK SIGNAL
CIL[2:0], COL[2:0]
TIME_WIN
FREE_RUN
1
0
0
1
COUNTER INTO LOCK
COUNTER OUT OF LOCK
STATUS 1[0]
STATUS 1[1]
f
LOCK
SC
MEMORY
TAKE f LOCK INTO ACCOUNT
SC
FSCLE
Figure 19. Lock Related Signal Path
Rev. G | Page 27 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
SRLS, Select Raw Lock Signal, Address 0x51[6]
COL[2:0], Count Out of Lock, Address 0x51[5:3]
Using the SRLS bit, the user can choose between two sources for
determining the lock status (per Bits[1:0] in the Status 1 register).
See Figure 19.
COL[2:0] determines the number of consecutive lines for which
the out-of-lock condition must be true before the system switches
into the unlocked state and reports this via Status 1[1:0]. It counts
the value in lines of video.
•
The TIME_WIN signal is based on a line-to-line evaluation
of the horizontal synchronization pulse of the incoming
video. It reacts quite quickly.
Table 26. COL Function
COL[2:0]
Number of Video Lines
•
The FREE_RUN signal evaluates the properties of the
incoming video over several fields, taking vertical
synchronization information into account.
000
1
001
2
010
5
Setting SRLS to 0 (default) selects the FREE_RUN signal.
Setting SRLS to 1 selects the TIME_WIN signal.
FSCLE, fSC Lock Enable, Address 0x51[7]
011
100 (default)
101
110
111
10
100
500
1000
100,000
The FSCLE bit allows the user to choose whether the status of
the color subcarrier loop is taken into account when the overall
lock status is determined and presented via Bits[1:0] in the
Status 1 register. This bit must be set to 0 when operating the
ADV7180 in YPrPb component mode to generate a reliable
HLOCK status bit.
COLOR CONTROLS
These registers allow the user to control picture appearance,
including control of the active data in the event of video being
lost. These controls are independent of any other controls. For
instance, brightness control is independent of picture clamping,
although both controls affect the dc level of the signal.
When FSCLE is set to 0 (default), only the overall lock status is
dependent on horizontal sync lock.
CON[7:0], Contrast Adjust, Address 0x08[7:0]
When FSCLE is set to 1, the overall lock status is dependent on
horizontal sync lock and fSC lock.
This register allows the user to control contrast adjustment of
the picture.
CIL[2:0], Count Into Lock, Address 0x51[2:0]
Table 27. CON Function
CIL[2:0] determines the number of consecutive lines for which
the lock condition must be true before the system switches into
the locked state and reports this via Status 1[1:0]. The bit counts
the value in lines of video.
CON[7:0]
0x80 (default)
0x00
Description
Gain on luma channel = 1
Gain on luma channel = 0
Gain on luma channel = 2
0xFF
Table 25. CIL Function
SD_SAT_Cb[7:0], SD Saturation Cb Channel,
Address 0xE3[7:0]
CIL[2:0]
Number of Video Lines
000
1
001
010
011
2
5
10
This register allows the user to control the gain of the Cb channel
only, which in turn adjusts the saturation of the picture.
Table 28. SD_SAT_Cb Function
SD_SAT_Cb[7:0] Description
100 (default)
101
110
100
500
1000
100,000
0x80 (default)
0x00
0xFF
Gain on Cb channel = 0 dB
Gain on Cb channel = −42 dB
Gain on Cb channel = +6 dB
111
SD_SAT_Cr[7:0], SD Saturation Cr Channel,
Address 0xE4[7:0]
This register allows the user to control the gain of the Cr channel
only, which in turn adjusts the saturation of the picture.
Table 29. SD_SAT_Cr Function
SD_SAT_Cr[7:0] Description
0x80 (default)
0x00
0xFF
Gain on Cr channel = 0 dB
Gain on Cr channel = −42 dB
Gain on Cr channel = +6 dB
Rev. G | Page 28 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
SD_OFF_Cb[7:0], SD Offset Cb Channel, Address 0xE1[7:0]
DEF_Y[5:0], Default Value Y, Address 0x0C[7:2]
This register allows the user to select an offset for the Cb channel
only and to adjust the hue of the picture. There is a functional
overlap with the HUE[7:0] register.
When the ADV7180 loses lock on the incoming video signal or
when there is no input signal, the DEF_Y[5:0] register allows
the user to specify a default luma value to be output. This value
is used under the following conditions:
Table 30. SD_OFF_Cb Function
SD_OFF_Cb[7:0] Description
•
If the DEF_VAL_AUTO_EN bit is set to high and the
ADV7180 has lost lock to the input video signal. This is
the intended mode of operation (automatic mode).
The DEF_VAL_EN bit is set, regardless of the lock status of
the video decoder. This is a forced mode that may be useful
during configuration.
0x80 (default)
0x00
0xFF
0 mV offset applied to the Cb channel
−312 mV offset applied to the Cb channel
+312 mV offset applied to the Cb channel
•
SD_OFF_Cr[7:0], SD Offset Cr Channel, Address 0xE2[7:0]
This register allows the user to select an offset for the Cr channel
only and to adjust the hue of the picture. There is a functional
overlap with the HUE[7:0] register.
The DEF_Y[5:0] values define the six MSBs of the output video.
The remaining LSBs are padded with 0s. For example, in 8-bit
mode, the output is Y[7:0] = {DEF_Y[5:0], 0, 0}.
For DEF_Y[5:0], 0x0D (blue) is the default value for Y.
Register 0x0C has a default value of 0x36.
Table 31. SD_OFF_Cr Function
SD_OFF_Cr[7:0]
0x80 (default)
0x00
Description
0 mV offset applied to the Cr channel
−312 mV offset applied to the Cr channel
+312 mV offset applied to the Cr channel
DEF_C[7:0], Default Value C, Address 0x0D[7:0]
The DEF_C[7:0] register complements the DEF_Y[5:0] value. It
defines the four MSBs of Cr and Cb values to be output if
0xFF
BRI[7:0], Brightness Adjust, Address 0x0A[7:0]
•
The DEF_VAL_AUTO_EN bit is set to high and the
ADV7180 cannot lock to the input video (automatic mode).
DEF_VAL_EN bit is set to high (forced output).
This register controls the brightness of the video signal. It allows
the user to adjust the brightness of the picture.
•
Table 32. BRI Function
The data that is finally output from the ADV7180 for the
chroma side is Cr[3:0] = {DEF_C[7:4], 0, 0, 0, 0}, and
Cb[3:0] = {DEF_C[3:0], 0, 0, 0, 0}.
BRI[7:0]
0x00 (default)
0x7F
Description
Offset of the luma channel = 0 IRE
Offset of the luma channel = +30 IRE
Offset of the luma channel = −30 IRE
For DEF_C[7:0], 0x7C (blue) is the default value for Cr and Cb.
0x80
DEF_VAL_EN, Default Value Enable, Address 0x0C[0]
HUE[7:0], Hue Adjust, Address 0x0B[7:0]
This bit forces the use of the default values for Y, Cr, and Cb. See
the descriptions in the DEF_Y[5:0], Default Value Y, Address
0x0C[7:2] and DEF_C[7:0], Default Value C, Address 0x0D[7:0]
sections for additional information. In this mode, the decoder
also outputs a stable 27 MHz clock, HS, and VS.
This register contains the value for the color hue adjustment. It
allows the user to adjust the hue of the picture.
HUE[7:0] has a range of 90°, with 0x00 equivalent to an
adjustment of 0°. The resolution of HUE[7:0] is 1 bit = 0.7°.
Setting DEF_VAL_EN to 0 (default) outputs a colored screen
determined by user-programmable Y, Cr, and Cb values when
the decoder free-runs. Free-run mode is turned on and off by
the DEF_VAL_AUTO_EN bit.
The hue adjustment value is fed into the AM color demodulation
block. Therefore, it applies only to video signals that contain
chroma information in the form of an AM-modulated carrier
(CVBS or Y/C in PAL or NTSC). It does not affect SECAM
and does not work on component video inputs (YPrPb).
Setting DEF_VAL_EN to 1 forces a colored screen output
determined by user-programmable Y, Cr, and Cb values.
This overrides picture data even if the decoder is locked.
Table 33. HUE Function
HUE[7:0]
0x00 (default)
0x7F
Description (Adjust Hue of the Picture)
Phase of the chroma signal = 0°
Phase of the chroma signal = −90°
Phase of the chroma signal = +90°
0x80
Rev. G | Page 29 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
After digitization, the digital fine clamp block corrects for any
remaining variations in dc level. Because the dc level of an input
video signal refers directly to the brightness of the picture
transmitted, it is important to perform a fine clamp with high
accuracy; otherwise, brightness variations may occur. Further-
more, dynamic changes in the dc level almost certainly lead to
visually objectionable artifacts and must, therefore, be prohibited.
DEF_VAL_AUTO_EN, Default Value Automatic Enable,
Address 0x0C[1]
This bit enables the automatic use of the default values for Y, Cr,
and Cb when the ADV7180 cannot lock to the video signal.
Setting DEF_VAL_AUTO_EN to 0 disables free-run mode. If
the decoder is unlocked, it outputs noise.
Setting DEF_VAL_EN to 1 (default) enables free-run mode, and
a colored screen set by user-programmable Y, Cr, and Cb values
is displayed when the decoder loses lock.
The clamping scheme has to complete two tasks. It must acquire
a newly connected video signal with a completely unknown dc
level, and it must maintain the dc level during normal operation.
CLAMP OPERATION
To acquire an unknown video signal quickly, the large current
clamps should be activated. It is assumed that the amplitude of
the video signal at this point is of a nominal value. Control of
the coarse and fine current clamp parameters is performed
automatically by the decoder.
The input video is ac-coupled into the ADV7180. Therefore, its dc
value needs to be restored. This process is referred to as clamping
the video. This section explains the general process of clamping
on the ADV7180 and shows the different ways in which a user
can configure its behavior.
Standard definition video signals may have excessive noise on
them. In particular, CVBS signals transmitted by terrestrial
broadcast and demodulated using a tuner usually show very
large levels of noise (>100 mV). A voltage clamp is unsuitable
for this type of video signal. Instead, the ADV7180 employs a
set of four current sources that can cause coarse (>0.5 mA) and
fine (<0.1 mA) currents to flow into and away from the high
impedance node that carries the video signal (see Figure 20).
The ADV7180 uses a combination of current sources and a
digital processing block for clamping, as shown in Figure 20.
The analog processing channel shown is replicated three times
inside the IC. While only one single channel is needed for a
CVBS signal, two independent channels are needed for Y/C
(SVHS) type signals, and three independent channels are
needed to allow component signals (YPrPb) to be processed.
The following sections describe the I2C signals that can be used
to influence the behavior of the clamping block.
The clamping can be divided into two sections:
Clamping before the ADC (analog domain): current
sources.
CCLEN, Current Clamp Enable, Address 0x14[4]
Clamping after the ADC (digital domain): digital
processing block.
The current clamp enable bit allows the user to switch off the
current sources in the analog front end altogether. This may be
useful if the incoming analog video signal is clamped externally.
The ADC can digitize an input signal only if it resides within
the ADC 1.0 V input voltage range. An input signal with a dc
level that is too large or too small is clipped at the top or bottom
of the ADC range.
When CCLEN is 0, the current sources are switched off.
When CCLEN is 1 (default), the current sources are enabled.
The primary task of the analog clamping circuits is to ensure that
the video signal stays within the valid ADC input window so that
the analog-to-digital conversion can take place. It is not necessary
to clamp the input signal with a very high accuracy in the analog
domain as long as the video signal fits within the ADC range.
FINE CURRENT SOURCES
COARSE CURRENT SOURCES
DATA
ANALOG
VIDEO
INPUT
VIDEO PROCESSOR
PRE-
ADC
WITH DIGITAL
PROCESSOR
FINE CLAMP
(DPP)
CLAMP CONTROL
Figure 20. Clamping Overview
Rev. G | Page 30 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
DCT[1:0], Digital Clamp Timing, Address 0x15[6:5]
•
Luma shaping filters (YSH). The shaping filter block is a
programmable low-pass filter with a wide variety of responses.
It can be used to selectively reduce the luma video signal
bandwidth (needed prior to scaling, for example). For
some video sources that contain high frequency noise,
reducing the bandwidth of the luma signal improves visual
picture quality. A follow-on video compression stage may
work more efficiently if the video is low-pass filtered.
The clamp timing register determines the time constant of the
digital fine clamp circuitry. It is important to note that the digital
fine clamp reacts quickly because it immediately corrects any
residual dc level error for the active line. The time constant from
the digital fine clamp must be much quicker than the one from
the analog blocks.
By default, the time constant of the digital fine clamp is adjusted
dynamically to suit the currently connected input signal.
The ADV7180 has two responses for the shaping filter: one
that is used for good quality composite, component, and SVHS
type sources, and a second for nonstandard CVBS signals.
Table 34. DCT Function
DCT[1:0]
Description
The YSH filter responses also include a set of notches for
PAL and NTSC. However, using the comb filters for Y/C
separation is recommended.
Digital resampling filter. This block allows dynamic
resampling of the video signal to alter parameters such as
the time base of a line of video. Fundamentally, the resampler
is a set of low-pass filters. The actual response is chosen by the
system with no requirement for user intervention.
00 (default)
Slow (TC = 1 sec)
Medium (TC = 0.5 sec)
Fast (TC = 0.1 sec)
Determined by ADV7180, depending on the
input video parameters
01
10
11
•
DCFE, Digital Clamp Freeze Enable, Address 0x15[4]
This register bit allows the user to freeze the digital clamp loop
at any time. It is intended for users who would like to do their
own clamping. Users should disable the current sources for
analog clamping via the appropriate register bits, wait until the
digital clamp loop settles, and then freeze it via the DCFE bit.
Figure 22 through Figure 25 show the overall response of all filters
together. Unless otherwise noted, the filters are set into a typical
wideband mode.
Y Shaping Filter
When DCFE is 0 (default), the digital clamp is operational.
When DCFE is 1, the digital clamp loop is frozen.
LUMA FILTER
For input signals in CVBS format, the luma shaping filters play
an essential role in removing the chroma component from a
composite signal. Y/C separation must aim for best possible
crosstalk reduction while still retaining as much bandwidth
(especially on the luma component) as possible. High quality
Y/C separation can be achieved by using the internal comb
filters of the ADV7180. Comb filtering, however, relies on the
frequency relationship of the luma component (multiples of the
video line rate) and the color subcarrier (fSC). For good quality
CVBS signals, this relationship is known; the comb filter algorithms
can be used to separate luma and chroma with high accuracy.
Data from the digital fine clamp block is processed by the three
sets of filters that follow. Note that the data format at this point
is CVBS for CVBS input or luma only for Y/C and YPrPb input
formats.
•
Luma antialias filter (YAA). The ADV7180 receives video
at a rate of 28.6363 MHz. (In the case of 4× oversampled
video, the ADC samples at 57.27 MHz, and the first
decimation is performed inside the DPP filters. Therefore,
the data rate into the ADV7180 is always 28.6363 MHz.)
The ITU-R BT.601 recommends a sampling frequency of
13.5 MHz. The luma antialias filter decimates the
In the case of nonstandard video signals, the frequency relationship
may be disturbed, and the comb filters may not be able to remove
all crosstalk artifacts in the best fashion without the assistance
of the shaping filter block.
oversampled video using a high quality linear phase, low-
pass filter that preserves the luma signal while at the same
time attenuating out-of-band components. The luma
antialias filter (YAA) has a fixed response.
Rev. G | Page 31 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
An automatic mode is provided that allows the ADV7180 to
evaluate the quality of the incoming video signal and select the
filter responses in accordance with the signal quality and video
standard. YFSM, WYSFMOVR, and WYSFM allow the user to
manually override the automatic decisions in part or in full.
YSFM[4:0], Y Shaping Filter Mode, Address 0x17[4:0]
The Y shaping filter mode bits allow the user to select from a
wide range of low-pass and notch filters. When switched in
automatic mode, the filter selection is based on other register
selections, such as detected video standard, as well as properties
extracted from the incoming video itself, such as quality and
time base stability. The automatic selection always selects the
widest possible bandwidth for the video input encountered.
The luma shaping filter has three control registers.
•
YSFM[4:0] allows the user to manually select a shaping
filter mode (applied to all video signals) or to enable an
automatic selection (depending on video quality and video
standard).
The Y-shaping filter mode operates as follows:
•
•
If the YSFM settings specify a filter (that is, YSFM is set to
values other than 00000 or 00001), the chosen filter is
applied to all video, regardless of its quality.
In automatic selection mode, the notch filters are only used
for bad quality video signals. For all other video signals,
wideband filters are used.
•
•
WYSFMOVR allows the user to manually override the
WYSFM decision.
WYSFM[4:0] allows the user to select a different shaping
filter mode for good quality composite (CVBS), component
(YPrPb), and SVHS (Y/C) input signals.
In automatic mode, the system preserves the maximum possible
bandwidth for good CVBS sources (because they can be successfully
combed) as well as for luma components of YPrPb and Y/C
sources (because they need not be combed). For poor quality
signals, the system selects from a set of proprietary shaping
filter responses that complements comb filter operation to
reduce visual artifacts.
WYSFMOVR, Wideband Y Shaping Filter Override,
Address 0x18[7]
Setting the WYSFMOVR bit enables the use of the WYSFM[4:0]
settings for good quality video signals. For more information on
luma shaping filters, see the Y Shaping Filter section and the
flowchart shown in Figure 21.
When WYSFMOVR is 0, the shaping filter for good quality
video signals is selected automatically.
The decisions of the control logic are shown in Figure 21.
Setting WYSFMOVR to 1 (default) enables manual override via
WYSFM[4:0].
SET YSFM
YSFM IN AUTO MODE?
00000 OR 00001
YES
NO
VIDEO
QUALITY
BAD
GOOD
USE YSFM SELECTED
FILTER REGARDLESS OF
VIDEO QUALITY
AUTO SELECT LUMA
SHAPING FILTER TO
COMPLEMENT COMB
WYSFMOVR
1
0
SELECT WIDEBAND
FILTER AS PER
WYSFM[4:0]
SELECT AUTOMATIC
WIDEBAND FILTER
Figure 21. YSFM and WYSFM Control Flowchart
Rev. G | Page 32 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Table 35. YSFM Function
Table 36. WYSFM Function
WYSFM[4:0]
00000
YSFM[4:0]
Description
Description
Do not use
Do not use
SVHS 1
SVHS 2
SVHS 3
SVHS 4
SVHS 5
SVHS 6
SVHS 7
00000
Automatic selection including a wide notch
response (PAL/NTSC/SECAM)
00001
00001 (default) Automatic selection including a narrow notch
response (PAL/NTSC/SECAM)
00010
00011
00100
00101
00110
00111
01000
01001
01010
01011
01100
01101
01110
01111
10000
10001
00010
00011
00100
00101
00110
00111
01000
01001
01010
01011
01100
01101
01110
01111
10000
10001
10010
10011
10100
10101
10110
10111
11000
11001
11010
11011
11100
11101
11110
11111
SVHS 1
SVHS 2
SVHS 3
SVHS 4
SVHS 5
SVHS 6
SVHS 7
SVHS 8
SVHS 8
SVHS 9
SVHS 10
SVHS 11
SVHS 12
SVHS 13
SVHS 14
SVHS 15
SVHS 16
SVHS 17
SVHS 18 (CCIR 601)
Do not use
SVHS 9
SVHS 10
SVHS 11
SVHS 12
SVHS 13
SVHS 14
SVHS 15
SVHS 16
SVHS 17
SVHS 18 (CCIR 601)
PAL NN1
PAL NN2
PAL NN3
PAL WN1
PAL WN2
NTSC NN1
NTSC NN2
NTSC NN3
NTSC WN1
NTSC WN2
NTSC WN3
Reserved
10010
10011 (default)
10100 to 11111
The filter plots in Figure 22 show the SVHS 1 (narrowest) to
SVHS 18 (widest) shaping filter settings. Figure 24 shows the
PAL notch filter responses. The NTSC-compatible notches are
shown in Figure 25.
COMBINED Y ANTIALIAS, SVHS LOW-PASS FILTERS,
Y RESAMPLE
0
–10
–20
–30
–40
–50
–60
–70
WYSFM[4:0], Wideband Y Shaping Filter Mode,
Address 0x18[4:0]
The WYSFM[4:0] bits allow the user to manually select a shaping
filter for good quality video signals, for example, CVBS with
stable time base, luma component of YPrPb, and luma component
of Y/C. The WYSFM bits are active only if the WYSFMOVR bit
is set to 1. See the general discussion of the shaping filter settings in
the Y Shaping Filter section.
0
2
4
6
8
10
12
FREQUENCY (MHz)
Figure 22. Y SVHS Combined Responses
Rev. G | Page 33 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
•
•
Chroma shaping filters (CSH). The shaping filter block
CHROMA FILTER
(CSH) can be programmed to perform a variety of low-pass
responses. It can be used to selectively reduce the bandwidth
of the chroma signal for scaling or compression.
Digital resampling filter. This block allows dynamic
resampling of the video signal to alter parameters such as
the time base of a line of video. Fundamentally, the resampler
is a set of low-pass filters. The actual response is chosen by
the system without user intervention.
Data from the digital fine clamp block is processed by the three
sets of filters that follow. Note that the data format at this point is
CVBS for CVBS inputs, chroma only for Y/C, or U/V interleaved
for YPrPb input formats.
•
Chroma antialias filter (CAA). The ADV7180 oversamples the
CVBS by a factor of 4 and the chroma/YPrPb by a factor of 2.
A decimating filter (CAA) is used to preserve the active video
band and to remove any out-of-band components. The
CAA filter has a fixed response.
Figure 26 shows the overall response of all filters together.
COMBINED Y ANTIALIAS, NTSC NOTCH FILTERS,
Y RESAMPLE
COMBINED Y ANTIALIAS, CCIR MODE SHAPING FILTER,
Y RESAMPLE
0
–20
0
–10
–20
–30
–40
–50
–60
–70
–40
–60
–80
–100
–120
0
2
4
6
8
10
12
0
2
4
6
8
10
12
FREQUENCY (MHz)
FREQUENCY (MHz)
Figure 25. Combined Y Antialias Filter, NTSC Notch Filters
Figure 23. Combined Y Antialias, CCIR Mode Shaping Filter
COMBINED C ANTIALIAS, C SHAPING FILTER,
C RESAMPLER
COMBINED Y ANTIALIAS, PAL NOTCH FILTERS,
Y RESAMPLE
0
0
–10
–20
–30
–40
–50
–60
–70
–10
–20
–30
–40
–50
–60
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
2
4
6
8
10
12
FREQUENCY (MHz)
FREQUENCY (MHz)
Figure 26. Chroma Shaping Filter Responses
Figure 24. Combined Y Antialias, PAL Notch Filters
Rev. G | Page 34 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Figure 27 shows a typical voltage divider network that is required
to keep the input video signal within the allowed range of the ADC,
0 V to 1 V. This circuit should be placed before all analog inputs
to the ADV7180.
CSFM[2:0], C Shaping Filter Mode, Address 0x17[7:5]
The C shaping filter mode bits allow the user to select from a
range of low-pass filters for the chrominance signal. When
switched in automatic mode, the widest filter is selected based
on the video standard/format and user choice (see Setting 000
and Setting 001 in Table 37).
ANALOG VIDEO
INPUT
100nF
AIN_OF_ADV7180
36Ω
39Ω
Table 37. CSFM Function
CSFM[2:0]
000 (default)
001
010
011
Description
Figure 27. Input Voltage Divider Network
Autoselection 1.5 MHz bandwidth
Autoselection 2.17 MHz bandwidth
SH1
SH2
The minimum supported amplitude of the input video is
determined by the ability of the ADV7180 to retrieve horizontal
and vertical timing and to lock to the color burst, if present.
There are separate gain control units for luma and chroma data.
Both can operate independently of each other. The chroma unit,
however, can also take its gain value from the luma path.
100
101
110
SH3
SH4
SH5
111
Wideband mode
The possible AGC modes are shown in Table 38.
Figure 26 shows the responses of SH1 (narrowest) to SH5
(widest) in addition to the wideband mode (shown in red).
Table 38. AGC Modes
Input
Video Type Luma Gain
Chroma Gain
GAIN OPERATION
Any
Manual gain luma
Manual gain chroma
The gain control within the ADV7180 is done on a purely
digital basis. The input ADC supports a 10-bit range mapped
into a 1.0 V analog voltage range. Gain correction takes place
after the digitization in the form of a digital multiplier.
CVBS
Dependent on
Dependent on color-burst
amplitude taken from
luma path
Dependent on color-burst
amplitude taken from
luma path
horizontal sync depth
Peak white
Advantages of this architecture over the commonly used
programmable gain amplifier (PGA) before the ADC include
the fact that the gain is now completely independent of supply,
temperature, and process variations.
Y/C
Dependent on
Dependent on color-burst
amplitude taken from
luma path
horizontal sync depth
Peak white
Dependent on color-burst
amplitude
As shown in Figure 28, the ADV7180 can decode a video signal
as long as it fits into the ADC window. The components for this
are the amplitude of the input signal and the dc level it resides on.
The dc level is set by the clamping circuitry (see the Clamp
Operation section).
YPrPb
Dependent on
horizontal sync depth
Taken from luma path
It is possible to freeze the automatic gain control loops. This
causes the loops to stop updating and the AGC determined gain
at the time of the freeze to stay active until the loop is either
unfrozen or the gain mode of operation is changed.
If the amplitude of the analog video signal is too high, clipping
may occur, resulting in visual artifacts. The analog input range
of the ADC, together with the clamp level, determines the
maximum supported amplitude of the video signal.
The currently active gain from any of the modes can be read
back. Refer to the description of the dual-function manual gain
registers, LG[11:0] luma gain and CG[11:0] chroma gain, in the
Luma Gain and Chroma Gain sections.
ANALOG VOLTAGE
RANGE SUPPORTED BY ADC (1V RANGE FOR ADV7180)
MAXIMUM
VOLTAGE
VIDEO PROCESSOR
(GAIN SELECTION ONLY)
DATA PRE-
PROCESSOR
(DPP)
ADC
GAIN
CONTROL
MINIMUM
VOLTAGE
CLAMP
LEVEL
Figure 28. Gain Control Overview
Rev. G | Page 35 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Luma Gain
LG[11:0], Luma Gain, Address 0x2F[3:0], Address
0x30[7:0]
LAGC[2:0], Luma Automatic Gain Control,
Address 0x2C[6:4]
LMG[11:0], Luma Manual Gain, Address 0x2F[3:0],
Address 0x30[7:0]
The luma automatic gain control mode bits select the operating
mode for the gain control in the luma path.
Luma gain[11:0] is a dual-function register. If all of these registers
are written to, a desired manual luma gain can be programmed.
This gain becomes active if the LAGC[2:0] mode is switched to
manual fixed gain. Equation 1 shows how to calculate a desired gain.
There are internal parameters (Analog Devices proprietary
algorithms) to customize the peak white gain control. Contact
local Analog Devices field applications engineers or local
Analog Devices distributor for more information.
If read back, this register returns the current gain value.
Depending on the setting in the LAGC[2:0] bits, the value is
one of the following:
Table 39. LAGC Function
LAGC[2:0]
Description
000
001
Manual fixed gain (use LMG[11:0])
AGC (blank level to sync tip), peak white algorithm off
•
Luma manual gain value (LAGC[2:0] set to luma manual
gain mode)
010 (default) AGC (blank level to sync tip), peak white algorithm on
•
Luma automatic gain value (LAGC[2:0] set to any of the
automatic modes)
011
100
101
110
111
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Freeze gain
Table 41. LG/LMG Function
LG[11:0]/LMG[11:0] Read/Write Description
LMG[11:0] = x
LG[11:0] = x
Write
Read
Manual gain for luma path
Actual used gain
LAGT[1:0], Luma Automatic Gain Timing,
Address 0x2F[7:6]
LMG[11: 0]
LumaCalibrationFactor
Luma Gain =
(1)
The luma automatic gain timing register allows the user to
influence the tracking speed of the luminance automatic gain
control. This register only has an effect if the LAGC[2:0] register is
set to 001 or 010 (automatic gain control modes).
where LMG[11:0] is a decimal value between 1024 and 4095.
Calculation of the Luma Calibration Factor
1. Using a video source, set content to a grey field and apply
as a standard CVBS signal to the CVBS input of the board.
2. Using an oscilloscope, measure the signal at CVBS input to
ensure that its sync depth, colour burst, and luma are at the
standard levels.
If peak white AGC is enabled and active (see the Status 1[7:0],
Address 0x10[7:0] section), the actual gain update speed is
dictated by the peak white AGC loop and, as a result, the LAGT
settings have no effect. As soon as the part leaves peak white
AGC, LAGT becomes relevant again.
3. Connect the output parallel pixel bus of the ADV7180 to a
backend system that has unity gain and monitor output
voltage.
4. Measure the luma level correctly from the black level. Turn
off the Luma AGC and manually change the value of the
luma gain control register, LMG[11:0], until the output
luma level matches the input measured in Step 2.
The update speed for the peak white algorithm can be
customized by the use of internal parameters. Contact Analog
Devices local field engineers for more information.
Table 40. LAGT Function
LAGT[1:0]
Description
00
01
10
Slow (TC = 2 sec)
Medium (TC = 1 sec)
Fast (TC = 0.2 sec)
Adaptive
This value, in decimal, is the luma calibration factor.
11 (default)
Rev. G | Page 36 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
BETACAM, Enable Betacam Levels, Address 0x01[5]
PW_UPD, Peak White Update, Address 0x2B[0]
If YPrPb data is routed through the ADV7180, the automatic
gain control modes can target different video input levels, as
outlined in Table 44. The BETACAM bit is valid only if the
input mode is YPrPb (component). The BETACAM bit sets the
target value for AGC operation.
The peak white and average video algorithms determine the
gain based on measurements taken from the active video. The
PW_UPD bit determines the rate of gain change. LAGC[2:0] must
be set to the appropriate mode to enable the peak white or average
video mode in the first place. For more information, see the
LAGC[2:0], Luma Automatic Gain Control, Address 0x2C[6:4]
section.
A review of the following sections is useful:
•
•
The MAN_MUX_EN, Manual Input Muxing Enable,
Address 0xC4[7] section for how component video
(YPrPb) can be routed through the ADV7180.
The Video Standard Selection section to select the various
standards, for example, with and without pedestal.
Setting PW_UPD to 0 updates the gain once per video line.
Setting PW_UPD to 1 (default) updates the gain once per field.
Chroma Gain
CAGC[1:0], Chroma Automatic Gain Control,
Address 0x2C[1:0]
The AGC algorithms adjust the levels based on the setting of
the BETACAM bit (see Table 42).
The two bits of color automatic gain control mode select the
basic mode of operation for automatic gain control in the
chroma path.
Table 42. BETACAM Function
BETACAM
Description
0 (default)
Assuming YPrPb is selected as input format:
Selecting PAL with pedestal selects MII.
Selecting PAL without pedestal selects SMPTE.
Selecting NTSC with pedestal selects MII.
Selecting NTSC without pedestal selects SMPTE.
Assuming YPrPb is selected as input format:
Selecting PAL with pedestal selects BETACAM.
Selecting PAL without pedestal selects BETACAM variant.
Selecting NTSC with pedestal selects BETACAM.
1
Selecting NTSC without pedestal selects BETACAM variant.
Table 43. CAGC Function
CAGC[1:0]
Description
00
01
Manual fixed gain (use CMG[11:0])
Luma gain used for chroma
Automatic gain (based on color burst)
Freeze chroma gain
10 (default)
11
Table 44. BETACAM Levels
Name
BETACAM (mV)
0 to +714 (including 7.5% pedestal)
−467 to +467
BETACAM Variant (mV)
0 to +714
−505 to +505
+286
SMPTE (mV)
0 to +700
−350 to +350
+300
MII (mV)
Y
0 to +700 (including 7.5% pedestal)
−324 to +324
+300
Pb and Pr
Sync Depth
+286
Rev. G | Page 37 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
4. Turn off the Chroma AGC and manually change the
CAGT[1:0], Chroma Automatic Gain Timing,
Address 0x2D[7:6]
Chroma Gain Control Register CMG[11:0] until the
chroma level matches that measured directly from the
source.
The chroma automatic gain timing register allows the user to
influence the tracking speed of the chroma automatic gain
control. This register has an effect only if the CAGC[1:0]
register is set to 10 (automatic gain).
This value, in decimal, is the chroma calibration factor.
CKE, Color Kill Enable, Address 0x2B[6]
Table 45. CAGT Function
The color kill enable bit allows the optional color kill function
to be switched on or off.
CAGT[1:0]
Description
Slow (TC = 2 sec)
Medium (TC = 1 sec)
Reserved
00
01
10
For QAM-based video standards (PAL and NTSC) as well as
FM-based systems (SECAM), the threshold for the color kill
decision is selectable via the CKILLTHR[2:0] bits.
11 (default)
Adaptive
If color kill is enabled and the color carrier of the incoming
video signal is less than the threshold for 128 consecutive video
lines, color processing is switched off (black and white output).
To switch the color processing back on, another 128 consecutive
lines with a color burst greater than the threshold are required.
CG[11:0], Chroma Gain, Address 0x2D[3:0],
Address 0x2E[7:0]; CMG[11:0], Chroma Manual Gain,
Address 0x2D[3:0], Address 0x2E[7:0]
Chroma gain[11:0] is a dual-function register. If written to, a
desired manual chroma gain can be programmed. This gain
becomes active if the CAGC[1:0] function is switched to
manual fixed gain. See Equation 2 for calculating a desired gain.
The color kill option works only for input signals with a modulated
chroma part. For component input (YPrPb), there is no color kill.
Setting CKE to 0 disables color kill.
If read back, this register returns the current gain value.
Depending on the setting in the CAGC[1:0] bits, this is either:
Setting CKE to 1 (default) enables color kill.
CKILLTHR[2:0], Color Kill Threshold, Address 0x3D[6:4]
•
The chroma manual gain value (CAGC[1:0] set to chroma
manual gain mode).
The CKILLTHR[2:0] bits allow the user to select a threshold for
the color kill function. The threshold applies only to QAM-based
(NTSC and PAL) or FM-modulated (SECAM) video standards.
•
The chroma automatic gain value (CAGC[1:0] set to any of
the automatic modes).
To enable the color kill function, the CKE bit must be set. For
Setting 000, Setting 001, Setting 010, and Setting 011, chroma
demodulation inside the ADV7180 may not work satisfactorily
for poor input video signals.
Table 46. CG/CMG Function
CG[11:0]/CMG[11:0] Read/Write Description
CMG[11:0]
Write
Manual gain for chroma
path
CG[11:0]
Read
Currently active gain
Table 47. CKILLTHR Function
Description
CMG[11: 0]decimal
ChromaCalibrationFactor
Chroma_Gain
≅
(2)
CKILLTHR[2:0] SECAM
NTSC, PAL
Kill at <0.5%
Kill at <1.5%
Kill at <2.5%
Kill at <4%
Kill at <8.5%
Kill at <16%
Kill at <32%
000
No color kill
where ChromaCalibrationFactor is a decimal value between 0
001
010
011 (default)
100
101
Kill at <5%
Kill at <7%
Kill at <8%
Kill at <9.5%
Kill at <15%
Kill at <32%
and 4095.
Calculation of the Chroma Calibration Factor
1. Apply a CVBS signal with the color bars/SMPTE bars test
pattern content directly to the measurement equipment.
2. Ensure correct termination of 75 Ω on the measurement
equipment. Measure chroma output levels.
3. Reconnect the source to the CVBS input of the ADV7180
system that has a backend gain of 1. Repeat the
110
111
Reserved for Analog Devices internal use only;
do not select
measurement of chroma levels.
Rev. G | Page 38 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
CHROMA TRANSIENT IMPROVEMENT (CTI)
The signal bandwidth allocated for chroma is typically much
smaller than that for luminance. In the past, this was a valid way
to fit a color video signal into a given overall bandwidth because
the human eye is less sensitive to chrominance than to luminance.
CTI_AB_EN, Chroma Transient Improvement
Alpha Blend Enable, Address 0x4D[1]
The CTI_AB_EN bit enables an alpha blend function within
the CTI block. If set to 1, the alpha blender mixes the transient
improved chroma with the original signal. The sharpness of the
alpha blending can be configured via the CTI_AB[1:0] bits.
The uneven bandwidth, however, may lead to visual artifacts in
sharp color transitions. At the border of two bars of color, both
components (luma and chroma) change at the same time (see
Figure 29). Due to the higher bandwidth, the signal transition
of the luma component is usually much sharper than that of the
chroma component. The color edge is not sharp and can be
blurred, in the worst case, over several pixels.
For the alpha blender to be active, the CTI block must be
enabled via the CTI_EN bit.
Setting CTI_AB_EN to 0 disables the CTI alpha blender.
Setting CTI_AB_EN to 1 (default) enables the CTI alpha-blend
mixing function.
CTI_AB[1:0], Chroma Transient Improvement Alpha
Blend, Address 0x4D[3:2]
LUMA SIGNAL WITH A
TRANSITION, ACCOMPANIED
LUMA SIGNAL
BY A CHROMA TRANSITION
The CTI_AB[1:0] controls the behavior of alpha blend circuitry
that mixes the sharpened chroma signal with the original one. It
thereby controls the visual impact of CTI on the output data.
ORIGINAL, SLOW CHROMA
TRANSITION PRIOR TO CTI
DEMODULATED
CHROMA SIGNAL
For CTI_AB[1:0] to become active, the CTI block must be
enabled via the CTI_EN bit, and the alpha blender must be
switched on via CTI_AB_EN.
SHARPENED CHROMA
TRANSITION AT THE
OUTPUT OF CTI
Figure 29. CTI Luma/Chroma Transition
Sharp blending maximizes the effect of CTI on the picture but
may also increase the visual impact of small amplitude, high
frequency chroma noise.
The chroma transient improvement block examines the input video
data. It detects transitions of chroma and can be programmed to
create steeper chroma edges in an attempt to artificially restore
lost color bandwidth. The CTI block, however, operates only
on edges above a certain threshold to ensure that noise is not
emphasized. Care has also been taken to ensure that edge
ringing and undesirable saturation or hue distortion are avoided.
Table 48. CTI_AB Function
CTI_AB[1:0]
Description
00
Sharpest mixing between sharpened and
original chroma signal
01
Sharp mixing
Chroma transient improvements are needed primarily for
signals that have severe chroma bandwidth limitations. For
those types of signals, it is strongly recommended to enable
the CTI block via CTI_EN.
10
Smooth mixing
11 (default)
Smoothest alpha blend function
CTI_C_TH[7:0], CTI Chroma Threshold, Address 0x4E[7:0]
CTI_EN, Chroma Transient Improvement Enable,
Address 0x4D[0]
The CTI_C_TH[7:0] value is an unsigned, 8-bit number specifying
how big the amplitude step in a chroma transition must be to be
steepened by the CTI block. Programming a small value into this
register causes even smaller edges to be steepened by the CTI
block. Making CTI_C_TH[7:0] a large value causes the block to
improve large transitions only.
Setting CTI_EN to 0 disables the CTI block.
Setting CTI_EN to 1 (default) enables the CTI block.
The default value for CTI_C_TH[7:0] is 0x08, indicating the
threshold for the chroma edges prior to CTI.
Rev. G | Page 39 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
PEAKING_GAIN[7:0], Luma Peaking Gain,
Address 0xFB[7:0]
DIGITAL NOISE REDUCTION (DNR) AND LUMA
PEAKING FILTER
Digital noise reduction is based on the assumption that high
frequency signals with low amplitude are probably noise and
that their removal, therefore, improves picture quality. The
following are the two DNR blocks in the ADV7180: the DNR1
block before the luma peaking filter and the DNR2 block after
the luma peaking filter, as shown in Figure 30.
This filter can be manually enabled. The user can select to boost
or to attenuate the mid region of the Y spectrum around 3 MHz.
The peaking filter can visually improve the picture by showing
more definition on the picture details that contain frequency
components around 3 MHz. The default value on this register
passes through the luma data unaltered. A lower value attenuates
the signal, and a higher value gains the luma signal. A plot of
the filter’s responses is shown in Figure 31.
Table 51. PEAKING_GAIN[7:0] Function
LUMA
SIGNAL
LUMA
OUTPUT
LUMA PEAKING
FILTER
DNR2
DNR1
Setting
Description
0x40 (Default)
0 dB response
PEAKING GAIN USING BP FILTER
15
10
5
Figure 30. DNR and Peaking Block Diagram
DNR_EN, Digital Noise Reduction Enable, Address 0x4D[5]
The DNR_EN bit enables the DNR block or bypasses it.
Table 49. DNR_EN Function
0
Setting
Description
0
Bypasses DNR (disable)
Enables digital noise reduction on the luma data
–5
–10
–15
1 (default)
DNR_TH[7:0], DNR Noise Threshold, Address 0x50[7:0]
The DNR1 block is positioned before the luma peaking block.
The DNR_TH[7:0] value is an unsigned, 8-bit number used to
determine the maximum edge that is interpreted as noise and,
therefore, blanked from the luma data. Programming a large
value into DNR_TH[7:0] causes the DNR block to interpret
even large transients as noise and remove them. As a result, the
effect on the video data is more visible. Programming a small
value causes only small transients to be seen as noise and to be
removed.
–20
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
FREQUENCY (MHz)
Figure 31. Peaking Filter Responses
DNR_TH2[7:0], DNR Noise Threshold 2,
Address 0xFC[7:0]
The DNR2 block is positioned after the luma peaking block
and, therefore, affects the gained luma signal. It operates in the
same way as the DNR1 block, but there is an independent
threshold control, DNR_TH2[7:0], for this block. This value is
an unsigned, 8-bit number used to determine the maximum
edge that is interpreted as noise and, therefore, blanked from
the luma data. Programming a large value into DNR_TH2[7:0]
causes the DNR block to interpret even large transients as noise
and remove them. As a result, the effect on the video data is more
visible. Programming a small value causes only small transients
to be seen as noise and to be removed.
Table 50. DNR_TH[7:0] Function
Setting
Description
0x08 (default)
Threshold for maximum luma edges to be
interpreted as noise
Table 52. DNR_TH2[7:0] Function
Setting
Description
0x04 (default)
Threshold for maximum luma edges to be
interpreted as noise
Rev. G | Page 40 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
NTSC Comb Filter Settings
COMB FILTERS
These settings are used for NTSC M/J CVBS inputs.
The comb filters of the ADV7180 have been greatly improved to
automatically handle video of all types, standards, and levels of
quality. The NTSC and PAL configuration registers allow the
user to customize the comb filter operation depending on which
video standard is detected (by autodetection) or selected (by
manual programming). In addition to the bits listed in this
section, there are some other internal controls (based on
Analog Devices proprietary algorithms); contact local Analog
Devices field engineers for more information.
NSFSEL[1:0], Split Filter Selection NTSC, Address 0x19[3:2]
The NSFSEL[1:0] control selects how much of the overall signal
bandwidth is fed to the combs. A narrow split filter selection
results in better performance on diagonal lines but more dot
crawl in the final output image. The opposite is true for selecting
a wide bandwidth split filter.
Table 53. NSFSEL Function
NSFSEL[1:0]
Description
Narrow
00 (default)
01
10
11
Medium
Medium
Wide
CTAPSN[1:0], Chroma Comb Taps, NTSC, Address 0x38[7:6]
Table 54. CTAPSN Function
CTAPSN[1:0]
Description
00
Do not use
01
NTSC chroma comb adapts three lines (three taps) to two lines (two taps)
NTSC chroma comb adapts five lines (five taps) to three lines (three taps)
NTSC chroma comb adapts five lines (five taps) to four lines (four taps)
10 (default)
11
CCMN[2:0], Chroma Comb Mode, NTSC, Address 0x38[5:3]
Table 55. CCMN Function
CCMN[2:0]
Description
Configuration
000 (default)
Adaptive comb mode
Adaptive three-line chroma comb for CTAPSN = 01
Adaptive four-line chroma comb for CTAPSN = 10
Adaptive five-line chroma comb for CTAPSN = 11
100
101
Disable chroma comb
Fixed chroma comb (top lines of line memory)
Fixed two-line chroma comb for CTAPSN = 01
Fixed three-line chroma comb for CTAPSN = 10
Fixed four-line chroma comb for CTAPSN = 11
Fixed three-line chroma comb for CTAPSN = 01
Fixed four-line chroma comb for CTAPSN = 10
Fixed five-line chroma comb for CTAPSN = 11
Fixed two-line chroma comb for CTAPSN = 01
Fixed three-line chroma comb for CTAPSN = 10
Fixed four-line chroma comb for CTAPSN = 11
110
111
Fixed chroma comb (all lines of line memory)
Fixed chroma comb (bottom lines of line memory)
Rev. G | Page 41 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
CCMP[2:0], Chroma Comb Mode PAL, Address 0x39[5:3]
YCMN[2:0], Luma Comb Mode NTSC, Address 0x38[2:0]
Table 59. CCMP Function
Table 56. YCMN Function
CCMP[2:0]
Description
Configuration
YCMN[2:0]
Description
Configuration
000 (default)
Adaptive comb mode
Adaptive three-line
chroma comb for
CTAPSN = 01
Adaptive four-line
chroma comb for
CTAPSN = 10
Adaptive five-line
chroma comb for
CTAPSN = 11
000 (default) Adaptive comb mode Adaptive three-line
(three taps) luma comb
100
Disable luma comb
Use low-pass/notch
filter; see the Y Shaping
Filter section
101
110
111
Fixed luma comb (top Fixed two-line (two
lines of line memory)
taps) luma comb
Fixed luma comb (all
lines of line memory)
Fixed three-line (three
taps) luma comb
100
101
Disable chroma comb
Fixed luma comb
(bottom lines of line
memory)
Fixed two-line (two
taps) luma comb
Fixed chroma comb
(top lines of line
memory)
Fixed two-line chroma
comb for CTAPSN = 01
Fixed three-line chroma
comb for CTAPSN = 10
Fixed four-line chroma
comb for CTAPSN = 11
PAL Comb Filter Settings
These settings are used for PAL B/G/H/I/D, PAL M, PAL
Combinational N, PAL 60, and NTSC 4.43 CVBS inputs.
110
111
Fixed chroma comb (all Fixed three-line chroma
lines of line memory)
comb for CTAPSN = 01
Fixed four-line chroma
comb for CTAPSN = 10
Fixed five-line chroma
comb for CTAPSN = 11
Fixed two-line chroma
comb for CTAPSN = 01
Fixed three-line chroma
comb for CTAPSN = 10
Fixed four-line chroma
comb for CTAPSN = 11
PSFSEL[1:0], Split Filter Selection, PAL, Address 0x19[1:0]
The PSFSEL[1:0] control selects how much of the overall signal
bandwidth is fed to the combs. A wide split filter selection
eliminates dot crawl but shows imperfections on diagonal lines.
The opposite is true for selecting a narrow bandwidth split filter.
Fixed chroma comb
(bottom lines of line
memory)
Table 57. PSFSEL Function
PSFSEL[1:0] Description
00
Narrow
Medium
Wide
01 (default)
10
11
YCMP[2:0], Luma Comb Mode PAL, Address 0x39[2:0]
Table 60. YCMP Function
Widest
CTAPSP[1:0], Chroma Comb Taps PAL, Address 0x39[7:6]
YCMP[2:0]
Description
Configuration
000 (default) Adaptive comb mode
Adaptive five lines (three
taps) luma comb
Use low-pass/notch filter;
see the Y Shaping Filter
section
Fixed three lines (two
taps) luma comb
Fixed five lines (three taps)
luma comb
Table 58. CTAPSP Function
CTAPSP[1:0] Description
100
Disable luma comb
00
01
Do not use.
PAL chroma comb adapts five lines (three taps)
to three lines (two taps); cancels cross luma only
101
110
111
Fixed luma comb (top
lines of line memory)
Fixed luma comb (all
lines of line memory)
Fixed luma comb
(bottom lines of line
memory)
10
PAL chroma comb adapts five lines (five taps) to
three lines (three taps); cancels cross luma and
hue error less well
11 (default)
PAL chroma comb adapts five lines (five taps) to
four lines (four taps); cancels cross luma and hue
error well
Fixed three lines (two
taps) luma comb
Rev. G | Page 42 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
IF COMP FILTERS NTSC ZOOMED AROUND FSC
IF FILTER COMPENSATION
IFFILTSEL[2:0], IF Filter Select, Address 0xF8[2:0]
6
4
The IFFILTSEL[2:0] register allows the user to compensate for
SAW filter characteristics on a composite input, as would be
observed on tuner outputs. Figure 32 and Figure 33 show IF
filter compensation for NTSC and PAL, respectively.
2
0
–2
–4
–6
–8
–10
–12
The options for this feature are as follows:
•
•
•
Bypass mode
NTSC, consists of three filter characteristics
PAL, consists of three filter characteristics
See Table 107 for programming details.
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
FREQUENCY (MHz)
Figure 32. NTSC IF Filter Compensation
IF COMP FILTERS PAL ZOOMED AROUND FSC
6
4
2
0
–2
–4
–6
–8
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
FREQUENCY (MHz)
Figure 33. PAL IF Filter Compensation
Rev. G | Page 43 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
In this output interface mode, the following assignment takes
place: Cb = FF, Y = 00, Cr = 00, and Y = AV.
AV CODE INSERTION AND CONTROLS
This section describes the I2C-based controls that affect the
following:
In a 16-bit output interface (64-lead LQFP only), where Y and
Cr/Cb are delivered via separate data buses, the AV code is
spread over the whole 16 bits. The SD_DUP_AV bit allows the
user to replicate the AV codes on both buses; therefore, the full
AV sequence can be found on the Y bus as well as on the Cr/Cb
bus (see Figure 34).
•
•
•
•
Insertion of AV codes into the data stream
Data blanking during the vertical blank interval (VBI)
The range of data values permitted in the output data stream
The relative delay of luma vs. chroma signals
Some of the decoded VBI data is inserted during the horizontal
blanking interval. See the Gemstar Data Recovery section for
more information.
When SD_DUP_AV is 0 (default), the AV codes are in single
fashion (to suit 8-bit interleaved data output).
When SD_DUP_AV is 1, the AV codes are duplicated (for
16-bit interfaces).
BT.656-4, ITU-R BT.656-4 Enable, Address 0x04[7]
Between Revision 3 and Revision 4 of the ITU-R BT.656 standards,
the ITU has changed the toggling position for the V bit within
the SAV EAV codes for NTSC. The ITU-R BT.656-4 standard
bit allows the user to select an output mode that is compliant
with either the previous or new standard. For further information,
visit the International Telecommunication Union website.
VBI_EN, Vertical Blanking Interval Data Enable,
Address 0x03[7]
The VBI enable bit allows data such as intercast and closed
caption data to be passed through the luma channel of the decoder
with a minimal amount of filtering. All data for Line 1 to Line 21 is
passed through and available at the output port. The ADV7180
does not blank the luma data and automatically switches all filters
along the luma data path into their widest bandwidth. For active
video, the filter settings for YSH and YPK are restored.
Note that the standard change only affects NTSC and has no
bearing on PAL.
When ITU-R BT.656-4 is 0 (default), the ITU-R BT.656-3
specification is used. The V bit goes low at EAV of Line 10
and Line 273.
See the BL_C_VBI, Blank Chroma During VBI, Address
0x04[2] section for information on the chroma path.
When ITU-R BT.656-4 is 1, the ITU-R BT.656-4 specification is
used. The V bit goes low at EAV of Line 20 and Line 283.
When VBI_EN is 0 (default), all video lines are filtered/scaled.
When VBI_EN is 1, only the active video region is filtered/scaled.
SD_DUP_AV, Duplicate AV Codes, Address 0x03[0]
Depending on the output interface width, it may be necessary to
duplicate the AV codes from the luma path into the chroma path.
In an 8-bit wide output interface (Cb/Y/Cr/Y interleaved data),
the AV codes are defined as FF/00/00/AV, with AV being the
transmitted word that contains information about H/V/F.
SD_DUP_AV = 1
SD_DUP_AV = 0
16-BIT INTERFACE
16-BIT INTERFACE
8-BIT INTERFACE
Y DATA BUS
FF
FF
00
00
AV
AV
Y
00
AV
Y
Cb/Y/Cr/Y
INTERLEAVED
FF
00
00 AV Cb
Cr/Cb DATA BUS
00
00
Cb
FF
00
Cb
AV CODE SECTION
AV CODE SECTION
AV CODE SECTION
Figure 34. AV Code Duplication Control (64-Lead LQFP Only)
Rev. G | Page 44 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
When AUTO_PDC_EN is 1 (default), the ADV7180 automatically
determines the LTA and CTA values to have luma and chroma
aligned at the output.
BL_C_VBI, Blank Chroma During VBI, Address 0x04[2]
Setting BL_C_VBI high blanks the Cr and Cb values of all VBI
lines. This is done so any data that may arrive during VBI is not
decoded as color and is output through Cr and Cb. As a result,
it is possible to send VBI lines into the decoder and then output
them through an encoder again, undistorted. Without this
blanking, any color that is incorrectly decoded would be encoded
by the video encoder, thus distorting the VBI lines.
LTA[1:0], Luma Timing Adjust, Address 0x27[1:0]
The luma timing adjust register allows the user to specify a
timing difference between chroma and luma samples.
There is a functionality overlap with the CTA[2:0] register. For
manual programming, use the following defaults:
Setting BL_C_VBI to 0 decodes and outputs color during VBI.
•
•
•
CVBS input LTA[1:0] = 00
Y/C input LTA[1:0] = 01
YPrPb input LTA[1:0] = 01
Setting BL_C_VBI to 1 (default) blanks Cr and Cb values
during VBI.
Range, Range Selection, Address 0x04[0]
Table 62. LTA Function
AV codes (as per ITU-R BT.656, formerly known as CCIR-656)
consist of a fixed header made up of 0xFF and 0x00 values.
These two values are reserved and, therefore, are not to be used
for active video. Additionally, the ITU specifies that the nominal
range for video should be restricted to values between 16 and
235 for luma and 16 and 240 for chroma.
LTA[1:0]
Description
00 (default)
No delay
01
10
11
Luma 1 clock (37 ns) late
Luma 2 clock (74 ns) early
Luma 1 clock (37 ns) early
CTA[2:0], Chroma Timing Adjust, Address 0x27[5:3]
The range bit allows the user to limit the range of values output
by the ADV7180 to the recommended value range. The
ADV7180 does not scale the data to fit within the smaller range.
Any value outside of the range is ignored. In any case, it ensures
that the reserved values of 255d (0xFF) and 00d (0x00) are not
presented on the output pins unless they are part of an AV code
header.
The chroma timing adjust register allows the user to specify a
timing difference between chroma and luma samples. This can
be used to compensate for external filter group delay differences
in the luma vs. chroma path and to allow a different number of
pipeline delays while processing the video downstream. Review
this functionality together with the LTA[1:0] register.
The chroma can be delayed or advanced only in chroma pixel
steps. One chroma pixel step is equal to two luma pixels. The
programmable delay occurs after demodulation, where delay
cannot be made by luma pixel steps.
Table 61. RANGE Function
Range
Description
0
16 ≤ Y ≤ 235, 16 ≤ C/P ≤ 240
1 ≤ Y ≤ 254, 1 ≤ C/P ≤ 254
1 (default)
For manual programming, use the following defaults:
AUTO_PDC_EN, Automatic Programmed Delay Control,
Address 0x27[6]
•
•
•
CVBS input CTA[2:0] = 011
Y/C input CTA[2:0] = 101
YPrPb input CTA[2:0] = 110
Enabling AUTO_PDC_EN activates a function within the
ADV7180 that automatically programs the LTA[1:0] and CTA[2:0]
registers to have the chroma and luma data match delays for all
modes of operation. If AUTO_PDC__EN is set, the LTA[1:0]
and CTA[2:0] manual registers are not used. If the automatic
mode is disabled (by setting the AUTO_PDC_EN bit to 0), the
values programmed into the LTA[1:0] and CTA[2:0] registers
become active.
Table 63. CTA Function
CTA[2:0]
Description
000
Not a valid setting
001
010
011 (default)
100
101
Chroma + two pixels (early)
Chroma + one pixel (early)
No delay
Chroma − one pixel (late)
Chroma − two pixels (late)
Chroma − three pixels (late)
Not a valid setting
When AUTO_PDC_EN is 0, the ADV7180 uses the LTA[1:0] and
CTA[2:0] values for delaying luma and chroma samples. See the
LTA[1:0], Luma Timing Adjust, Address 0x27[1:0] section and
the CTA[2:0], Chroma Timing Adjust, Address 0x27[5:3]
section.
110
111
Rev. G | Page 45 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
HSE[10:0], HS End, Address 0x34[2:0], Address 0x36[7:0]
SYNCHRONIZATION OUTPUT SIGNALS
The position of this edge is controlled by placing a binary
number into HSE[10:0]. The number applied offsets the edge
with respect to an internal counter that is reset to 0 immediately
after EAV Code FF, 00, 00, XY (see Figure 35). HSE is set to
00000000000b, which is 0 LLC clock cycles from count [0].
HS Configuration
The following controls allow the user to configure the behavior
of the HS output pin only:
Beginning of HS signal via HSB[10:0]
End of HS signal via HSE[10:0]
Polarity of HS using PHS
The default value of HSE[10:0] is 00, indicating that the HS
pulse ends 0 pixels after the falling edge of HS.
The HS begin (HSB) and HS end (HSE) registers allow the user
to freely position the HS output (pin) within the video line. The
values in HSB[10:0] and HSE[10:0] are measured in pixel units
from the falling edge of HS. Using both values, the user can
program both the position and length of the HS output signal.
For example,
To shift the HS toward active video by 20 LLCs, add
20 LLCs to both HSB and HSE, that is,
HSB[10:0] = [00000010110], HSE[10:0] = [00000010100].
To shift the HS away from active video by 20 LLCs, add
1696 LLCs to both HSB and HSE (for NTSC), that is,
HSB[10:0] = [11010100010], HSE[10:0] = [11010100000].
Therefore, 1696 is derived from the NTSC total number of
pixels, 1716.
HSB[10:0], HS Begin, Address 0x34[6:4], Address 0x35[7:0]
The position of this edge is controlled by placing a binary
number into HSB[10:0]. The number applied offsets the edge
with respect to an internal counter that is reset to 0 immediately
after EAV Code FF, 00, 00, XY (see Figure 35). HSB is set to
00000000010b, which is two LLC clock cycles from count [0].
To move 20 LLCs away from active video, subtract 20 from
1716 and add the result in binary to both HSB[10:0] and
HSE[10:0].
The default value of HSB[10:0] is 0x02, indicating that the HS
pulse starts two pixels after the falling edge of HS.
PHS, Polarity HS, Address 0x37[7]
The polarity of the HS pin can be inverted using the PHS bit.
When PHS is 0 (default), HS is active low.
When PHS is 1, HS is active high.
Table 64. HS Timing Parameters (See Figure 35)
Characteristic
HS to Active Video
LLC Clock Cycles, C
in Figure 35 (Default)
HS Begin Adjust
Standard HSB[10:0] (Default)
HS End Adjust
HSE[10:0] (Default)
Active Video Samples/
Line, D in Figure 35
Total LLC Clock
Cycles, E in Figure 35
NTSC
PAL
00000000010b
00000000010b
00000000000b
00000000000b
272
284
720Y + 720C = 1440
720Y + 720C = 1440
1716
1728
LLC
PIXEL
BUS
Cr
Y
FF
00
EAV
00
XY 80
10
80
10
80
10
FF
00
00
SAV
XY Cb
Y
Cr
Y
Cb
Y
Cr
ACTIVE
VIDEO
H BLANK
ACTIVE VIDEO
HS
HSE[10:0]
4 LLC
HSB[10:0]
C
D
D
E
E
Figure 35. HS Timing
Rev. G | Page 46 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
VS and FIELD Configuration
HVSTIM, Horizontal VS Timing, Address 0x31[3]
The following controls allow the user to configure the behavior
of the VS and FIELD output pins, as well as the generation of
embedded AV codes.
The HVSTIM bit allows the user to select where the VS signal is
asserted within a line of video. Some interface circuitry may require
VS to go low while HS is low.
The 64-lead LQFP has separate VS and FIELD pins. The 48-lead
LQFP, 40-lead LFCSP, and 32-lead LFCSP do not have separate
VS and FIELD pins but can output either VS or FIELD on Pin 45
(48-lead LQFP), Pin 37 (40-lead LFCSP), or Pin 31 (32-lead
LFCSP), which is the VS/FIELD pin.
When HVSTIM is 0 (default), the start of the line is relative to HSE.
When HVSTIM is 1, the start of the line is relative to HSB.
VSBHO, VS Begin Horizontal Position Odd, Address 0x32[7]
The VSBHO and VSBHE bits select the position within a line at
which the VS pin (not the bit in the AV code) becomes active.
Some follow-on chips require the VS pin to change state only
when HS is high or low.
SQPE, Square Pixel Mode, Address 0x01[2]
The SQPE bit allows the user to select the square pixel mode.
This mode is not suitable for poor time-based video sources.
This mode is recommended for professional applications only
and should not be used with VCR or tuner sources.
When VSBHO is 0 (default), the VS pin goes high in the middle
of a line of video (odd field).
When VSBHO is 1, the VS pin changes state at the start of a line
(odd field).
Setting SQPE to 1 enables square pixel mode. The LLC for
NTSC is 24.5454 MHz and 29.5 MHz for PAL. The crystal
frequency does not change.
VSBHE, VS Begin Horizontal Position Even, Address 0x32[6]
VS/FIELD, Address 0x58[0]
The VSBHO and VSBHE bits select the position within a line at
which the VS pin (not the bit in the AV code) becomes active.
Some follow-on chips require the VS pin to only change state
when HS is high or low.
This feature is used for the 48-lead LQFP, 40-lead LFCSP, and
32-lead LFCSP only. The polarity of this bit determines what
signal appears on the VS/FIELD pin.
When VSBHE is 0 (default), the VS pin goes high in the middle
of a line of video (even field).
When this bit is set to 0 (default), the FIELD signal is output.
When this bit is set to 1, the VSYNC signal is output.
The 64-lead LQFP has dedicated FIELD and VSYNC pins.
When VSBHE is 1, the VS pin changes state at the start of a line
(even field).
ADV encoder-compatible signals via the NEWAVMODE
register follow:
VSEHO, VS End Horizontal Position Odd, Address 0x33[7]
The VSEHO and VSEHE bits select the position within a line at
which the VS pin (not the bit in the AV code) becomes active.
Some follow-on chips require the VS pin to change state only
when HS is high or low.
•
•
•
•
PVS, PF
HVSTIM
VSBHO, VSBHE
VSEHO, VSEHE
When VSEHO is 0 (default), the VS pin goes low (inactive) in
the middle of a line of video (odd field).
For NTSC control,
•
•
•
NVBEGDELO, NVBEGDELE, NVBEGSIGN, NVBEG[4:0]
NVENDDELO, NVENDDELE, NVENDSIGN, NVEND[4:0]
NFTOGDELO, NFTOGDELE, NFTOGSIGN, NFTOG[4:0]
When VSEHO is 1, the VS pin changes state at the start of a line
(odd field).
VSEHE, VS End Horizontal Position Even, Address 0x33[6]
For PAL control,
The VSEHO and VSEHE bits select the position within a line at
which the VS pin (not the bit in the AV code) becomes active.
Some follow-on chips require the VS pin to change state only
when HS is high or low.
•
•
•
PVBEGDELO, PVBEGDELE, PVBEGSIGN, PVBEG[4:0]
PVENDDELO, PVENDDELE, PVENDSIGN, PVEND[4:0]
PFTOGDELO, PFTOGDELE, PFTOGSIGN, PFTOG[4:0]
NEWAVMODE, New AV Mode, Address 0x31[4]
When VSEHE is 0 (default), the VS pin goes low (inactive) in
the middle of a line of video (even field).
When NEWAVMODE is 0, EAV/SAV codes are generated to
suit Analog Devices encoders. No adjustments are possible.
When VSEHE is 1, the VS pin changes state at the start of a line
(even field).
Setting NEWAVMODE to 1 (default) enables the manual position
of the VSYNC, FIELD, and AV codes using Register 0x32 to
Register 0x33 and Register 0xE5 to Register 0xEA. Default register
settings are CCIR656 compliant; see Figure 36 for NTSC and
Figure 41 for PAL. For recommended manual user settings, see
Table 65 and Figure 37 for NTSC and Table 66 and Figure 42 for PAL.
PVS, Polarity VS, Address 0x37[5]
The polarity of the VS pin can be inverted using the PVS bit.
When PVS is 0 (default), VS is active high.
When PVS is 1, VS is active low.
Rev. G | Page 47 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
PF, Polarity FIELD, Address 0x37[3]
Table 65. User Settings for NTSC (See Figure 37)
Register
0x31
0x32
0x33
0x34
0x35
0x36
0x37
0xE5
0xE6
0xE7
Register Name
Write
0x1A
0x81
0x84
0x00
0x00
0x7D
0xA1
0x41
0x84
0x06
The polarity of the FIELD pin for the 64-lead LQFP part can be
inverted using the PF bit.
VS/FIELD Control 1
VS/FIELD Control 2
VS/FIELD Control 3
HS Position Control 1
HS Position Control 2
HS Position Control 3
Polarity
The FIELD pin can be inverted using the PF bit.
When PF is 0 (default), FIELD is active high.
When PF is 1, FIELD is active low.
NTSV V bit begin
NTSC V bit end
NTSC F bit toggle
FIELD 1
525
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
19
20
21
22
OUTPUT
VIDEO
H
V
1
NVBEG[4:0] = 0x05
NVEND[4:0] = 0x04
BT.656-4
REG 0x04, BIT 7 = 1
F
NFTOG[4:0] = 0x03
FIELD 2
262
263
264
265
266
267
268
269
270
271
272
273
274
275 276
283
284
285
OUTPUT
VIDEO
H
V
1
BT.656-4
REG 0x04, BIT 7 = 1
NVBEG[4:0] = 0x05
NVEND[4:0] = 0x04
F
NFTOG[4:0] = 0x03
APPLIES IF NEWAVMODE = 0:
1
MUST BE MANUALLY SHIFTED IF NEWAVMODE = 1.
Figure 36. NTSC Default, ITU-R BT.656 (the Polarity of H, V, and F is Embedded in the Data)
FIELD 1
525
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
21
22
OUTPUT
VIDEO
HS
OUTPUT
VS
OUTPUT
NVBEG[4:0] = 0x01
NVEND[4:0] = 0x04
FIELD
OUTPUT
NFTOG[4:0] = 0x06
FIELD 2
267
262
263
264
265
266
268
269
270
271
272
273
274
275
276 277
284
285
OUTPUT
VIDEO
HS
OUTPUT
VS
OUTPUT
NVBEG[4:0] = 0x01
NVEND[4:0] = 0x04
FIELD
OUTPUT
NFTOG[4:0] = 0x06
Figure 37. NTSC Typical VSYNC/FIELD Positions Using the Register Writes in Table 65
Rev. G | Page 48 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
For all NTSC/PAL VSYNC timing controls, both the V bit in
the AV code and the VSYNC signal on the VS pin are modified.
1
NVBEGSIGN
0
ADVANCE BEGIN OF
VSYNC BY NVBEG[4:0]
DELAY BEGIN OF
VSYNC BY NVBEG[4:0]
1
NVENDSIGN
0
ADVANCE END OF
VSYNC BY NVEND[4:0]
DELAY END OF VSYNC
BY NVEND[4:0]
NOT VALID FOR USER
PROGRAMMING
ODD FIELD?
YES
NO
NOT VALID FOR USER
PROGRAMMING
ODD FIELD?
YES
NO
NVBEGDELO
1
NVBEGDELE
1
0
0
NVENDDELO
1
NVENDDELE
1
ADDITIONAL
DELAY BY
1 LINE
ADDITIONAL
DELAY BY
1 LINE
0
0
ADDITIONAL
DELAY BY
1 LINE
ADDITIONAL
DELAY BY
1 LINE
VSBHO
1
VSBHE
1
0
0
VSEHO
1
VSEHE
1
ADVANCE BY
0.5 LINE
ADVANCE BY
0.5 LINE
0
0
ADVANCE BY
0.5 LINE
ADVANCE BY
0.5 LINE
VSYNC BEGIN
Figure 38. NTSC VSYNC Begin
VSYNC END
NVBEGDELO, NTSC VSYNC Begin Delay on Odd Field,
Address 0xE5[7]
Figure 39. NTSC VSYNC End
NVENDDELO, NTSC VSYNC End Delay on Odd Field,
Address 0xE6[7]
When NVBEGDELO is 0 (default), there is no delay.
Setting NVBEGDELO to 1 delays VSYNC going high on an odd
field by a line relative to NVBEG.
When NVENDDELO is 0 (default), there is no delay.
Setting NVENDDELO to 1 delays VSYNC from going low on
an odd field by a line relative to NVEND.
NVBEGDELE, NTSC VSYNC Begin Delay on Even Field,
Address 0xE5[6]
NVENDDELE, NTSC VSYNC End Delay on Even Field,
Address 0xE6[6]
When NVBEGDELE is 0 (default), there is no delay.
Setting NVBEGDELE to 1 delays VSYNC going high on an
even field by a line relative to NVBEG.
When NVENDDELE is set to 0 (default), there is no delay.
Setting NVENDDELE to 1 delays VSYNC from going low on an
even field by a line relative to NVEND.
NVBEGSIGN, NTSC VSYNC Begin Sign, Address 0xE5[5]
Setting NVBEGSIGN to 0 delays the start of VSYNC. Set for
user manual programming.
NVENDSIGN, NTSC VSYNC End Sign, Address 0xE6[5]
Setting NVBEGSIGN to 1 (default) advances the start of
VSYNC (not recommended for user programming).
Setting NVENDSIGN to 0 (default) delays the end of VSYNC.
Set for user manual programming.
Setting NVENDSIGN to 1 advances the end of VSYNC (not
recommended for user programming).
NVBEG[4:0], NTSC VSYNC Begin, Address 0xE5[4:0]
The default value of NVBEG is 00101, indicating the NTSC
VSYNC begin position.
Rev. G | Page 49 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
NVEND[4:0], NTSC VSYNC End, Address 0xE6[4:0]
NFTOG[4:0], NTSC Field Toggle, Address 0xE7[4:0]
The default value of NVEND is 00100, indicating the NTSC
VSYNC end position.
The default value of NFTOG is 00011, indicating the NTSC
field toggle position.
For all NTSC/PAL VSYNC timing controls, both the V bit in
the AV code and the VSYNC signal on the VS pin are modified.
For all NTSC/PAL field timing controls, both the F bit in the
AV code and the field signal on the FIELD pin are modified.
NFTOGDELO, NTSC FIELD Toggle Delay on Odd Field,
Address 0xE7[7]
1
NFTOGSIGN
0
When NFTOGDELO is 0 (default), there is no delay.
ADVANCE TOGGLE OF
FIELD BY NFTOG[4:0]
DELAY TOGGLE OF
FIELD BY NFTOG[4:0]
Setting NFTOGDELO to 1 delays the field toggle/transition on
an odd field by a line relative to NFTOG.
NOT VALID FOR USER
PROGRAMMING
NFTOGDELE, NTSC Field Toggle Delay on Even Field,
Address 0xE7[6]
ODD FIELD?
YES
NO
When NFTOGDELE is 0, there is no delay.
Setting NFTOGDELE to 1 (default) delays the field toggle/
transition on an even field by a line relative to NFTOG.
NFTOGDELO
1
NFTOGDELE
1
NFTOGSIGN, NTSC Field Toggle Sign, Address 0xE7[5]
0
0
Setting NFTOGSIGN to 0 delays the field transition. Set for
user manual programming.
ADDITIONAL
DELAY BY
1 LINE
ADDITIONAL
DELAY BY
1 LINE
Setting NFTOGSIGN to 1 (default) advances the field transition
(not recommended for user programming).
FIELD
TOGGLE
Figure 40. NTSC FIELD Toggle
FIELD 1
622
623
624
625
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
22
23
24
OUTPUT
VIDEO
H
V
PVBEG[4:0] = 0x05
PVEND[4:0] = 0x04
F
PFTOG[4:0] = 0x03
FIELD 2
314
310
311
312
313
315
316
317
318
319
320
321 322
335
336
337
OUTPUT
VIDEO
H
V
PVBEG[4:0] = 0x05
PVEND[4:0] = 0x04
F
PFTOG[4:0] = 0x03
Figure 41. PAL Default, ITU-R BT.656 (the Polarity of H, V, and F Is Embedded in the Data)
Rev. G | Page 50 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
FIELD 1
1
622
623 624
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
23
24
625
OUTPUT
VIDEO
HS
OUTPUT
VS
OUTPUT
PVBEG[4:0] = 0x01
PVEND[4:0] = 0x04
FIELD
OUTPUT
PFTOG[4:0] = 0x06
FIELD 2
314
310
311
312
315
316
317
318
319
320
321
322
323
336
337
313
OUTPUT
VIDEO
HS
OUTPUT
VS
OUTPUT
PVBEG[4:0] = 0x01
PVEND[4:0] = 0x04
FIELD
OUTPUT
PFTOG[4:0] = 0x06
Figure 42. PAL Typical VS/FIELD Positions Using the Register Writes Shown in Table 66
PVBEG[4:0], PAL VSYNC Begin, Address 0xE8[4:0]
Table 66. User Settings for PAL (See Figure 42)
The default value of PVBEG is 00101, indicating the PAL VSYNC
begin position. For all NTSC/PAL VSYNC timing controls, the
V bit in the AV code and the VSYNC signal on the VS pin are
modified.
Register
0x31
0x32
0x33
0x34
0x35
0x36
0x37
0xE8
0xE9
0xEA
Register Name
VS/FIELD Control 1
VS/FIELD Control 2
VS/FIELD Control 3
HS Position Control 1
HS Position Control 2
HS Position Control 3
Polarity
Write
0x1A
0x81
0x84
0x00
0x00
0x7D
0xA1
0x41
0x84
0x06
1
PVBEGSIGN
0
ADVANCE BEGIN OF
VSYNC BY PVBEG[4:0]
DELAY BEGIN OF
VSYNC BY PVBEG[4:0]
PAL V bit begin
NOT VALID FOR USER
PROGRAMMING
PAL V bit end
PAL F bit toggle
ODD FIELD?
YES
NO
PVBEGDELO, PAL VSYNC Begin Delay on Odd Field,
Address 0xE8[7]
PVBEGDELO
1
PVBEGDELE
1
When PVBEGDELO is 0 (default), there is no delay.
0
0
Setting PVBEGDELO to 1 delays VSYNC going high on an odd
field by a line relative to PVBEG.
ADDITIONAL
DELAY BY
1 LINE
ADDITIONAL
DELAY BY
1 LINE
PVBEGDELE, PAL VSYNC Begin Delay on Even Field,
Address 0xE8[6]
When PVBEGDELE is 0, there is no delay.
VSBHO
1
VSBHE
1
Setting PVBEGDELE to 1 (default) delays VSYNC going high
on an even field by a line relative to PVBEG.
0
0
PVBEGSIGN, PAL VSYNC Begin Sign, Address 0xE8[5]
ADVANCE BY
0.5 LINE
ADVANCE BY
0.5 LINE
Setting PVBEGSIGN to 0 delays the beginning of VSYNC. Set
for user manual programming.
Setting PVBEGSIGN to 1 (default) advances the beginning of
VSYNC (not recommended for user programming).
VSYNC BEGIN
Figure 43. PAL VSYNC Begin
Rev. G | Page 51 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
PFTOGDELO, PAL Field Toggle Delay on Odd Field,
Address 0xEA[7]
1
PVENDSIGN
0
When PFTOGDELO is 0 (default), there is no delay.
ADVANCE END OF
DELAY END OF VSYNC
BY PVEND[4:0]
VSYNC BY PVEND[4:0]
Setting PFTOGDELO to 1 delays the F toggle/transition on an
odd field by a line relative to PFTOG.
NOT VALID FOR USER
PROGRAMMING
PFTOGDELE, PAL Field Toggle Delay on Even Field,
Address 0xEA[6]
ODD FIELD?
YES
NO
When PFTOGDELE is 0, there is no delay.
Setting PFTOGDELE to 1 (default) delays the F toggle/transition
on an even field by a line relative to PFTOG.
PVENDDELO
1
PVENDDELE
1
PFTOGSIGN, PAL Field Toggle Sign, Address 0xEA[5]
0
0
Setting PFTOGSIGN to 0 delays the field transition. Set for user
manual programming.
ADDITIONAL
DELAY BY
1 LINE
ADDITIONAL
DELAY BY
1 LINE
Setting PFTOGSIGN to 1 (default) advances the field transition
(not recommended for user programming).
PFTOG, PAL Field Toggle, Address 0xEA[4:0]
VSEHO
1
VSEHE
1
The default value of PFTOG is 00011, indicating the PAL field
toggle position.
0
0
For all NTSC/PAL field timing controls, the F bit in the AV
code and the field signal on the FIELD pin are modified.
ADVANCE BY
0.5 LINE
ADVANCE BY
0.5 LINE
1
PFTOGSIGN
0
VSYNC END
ADVANCE TOGGLE OF
FIELD BY PFTOG[4:0]
DELAY TOGGLE OF
FIELD BY PFTOG[4:0]
Figure 44. PAL VSYNC End
PVENDDELO, PAL VSYNC End Delay on Odd Field,
Address 0xE9[7]
NOT VALID FOR USER
PROGRAMMING
ODD FIELD?
When PVENDDELO is 0 (default), there is no delay.
YES
NO
Setting PVENDDELO to 1 delays VSYNC going low on an odd
field by a line relative to PVEND.
PFTOGDELO
1
PFTOGDELE
1
PVENDDELE, PAL VSYNC End Delay on Even Field,
Address 0xE9[6]
0
0
When PVENDDELE is 0 (default), there is no delay.
ADDITIONAL
DELAY BY
1 LINE
ADDITIONAL
DELAY BY
1 LINE
Setting PVENDDELE to 1 delays VSYNC going low on an even
field by a line relative to PVEND.
PVENDSIGN, PAL VSYNC End Sign, Address 0xE9[5]
Setting PVENDSIGN to 0 (default) delays the end of VSYNC
(set for user manual programming).
FIELD
TOGGLE
Figure 45. PAL F Toggle
Setting PVENDSIGN to 1 advances the end of VSYNC (not
recommended for user programming).
PVEND[4:0], PAL VSYNC End, Address 0xE9[4:0]
The default value of PVEND is 10100, indicating the PAL
VSYNC end position.
For all NTSC/PAL VSYNC timing controls, both the V bit in
the AV code and the VSYNC signal on the VS pin are modified.
Rev. G | Page 52 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Table 68. NTSC
Feature
SYNC PROCESSING
Standard
The ADV7180 has two additional sync processing blocks that
postprocess the raw synchronization information extracted
from the digitized input video. If desired, the blocks can be
disabled via the following two I2C bits: ENHSPLL and
ENVSPROC.
Teletext System B and D
Teletext System C/NABTS
Vertical Interval Time Codes (VITC)
Copy Generation Management
System (CGMS)
ITU-R BT.653
ITU-R BT.653/EIA-516
Not applicable
EIA-J CPR-1204/IEC 61880
ENHSPLL, Enable HSYNC Processor, Address 0x01[6]
Gemstar
Not applicable
EIA-608
Closed Captioning (CCAP)
The HSYNC processor is designed to filter incoming HSYNCs that
have been corrupted by noise, providing improved performance
for video signals with stable time bases but poor SNR.
The VBI data standard that the VDP decodes on a particular
line of incoming video has been set by default as described in
Table 69. This can be overridden manually and any VBI data can
be decoded on any line. The details of manual programming are
described in Table 70.
Setting ENHSPLL to 0 disables the HSYNC processor.
Setting ENHSPLL to 1 (default) enables the HSYNC processor.
ENVSPROC, Enable VSYNC Processor, Address 0x01[3]
VDP Default Configuration
This block provides extra filtering of the detected VSYNCs to
improve vertical lock.
The VDP can decode different VBI data standards on a line-to-
line basis. The various standards supported by default on different
lines of VBI are explained in Table 69.
Setting ENVSPROC to 0 disables the VSYNC processor.
Setting ENVSPROC to 1 (default) enables the VSYNC processor.
VBI DATA DECODE
VDP Manual Configuration
MAN_LINE_PGM, Enable Manual Line Programming of
VBI Standards, Address 0x64[7], User Sub Map
The following are the two VBI data slicers on the ADV7180: the
VBI data processor (VDP) and the VBI System 2.
The user can configure the VDP to decode different standards on
a line-to-line basis through manual line programming. For this,
the user must set the MAN_LINE_PGM bit. The user must write
into all the line programming registers, VBI_DATA_Px_Ny and
VBI_DATA_Px (see Register 0x64 to Register 0x77 in Table 108).
The VDP can slice both low bandwidth standards and high
bandwidth standards such as teletext. VBI System 2 can slice
low data rate VBI standards only.
The VDP is capable of slicing multiple VBI data standards on
SD video. It decodes the VBI data on the incoming CVBS and
Y/C or YUV data. The decoded results are available as ancillary
data in output 656 data stream. For low data rate VBI standards
like CC/WSS/CGMS, users can read the decoded data bytes
from the I2C registers.
When MAN_LINE_PGM to 0 (default) is set, the VDP decodes
default standards on lines, as shown in Table 69.
When MAN_LINE_PGM to 1 is set, the VBI standards to be
decoded are manually programmed.
VBI_DATA_Px_Ny[3:0], VBI_DATA_Px[3:0], VBI
Standard to be Decoded on Line X for PAL, Line Y for
NTSC, Address 0x64 to Address 0x77, User Sub Map
The VBI data standards that can be decoded by the VDP are
listed in Table 67 and Table 68.
These are related 4-bit clusters in Register 0x64 to Register 0x77
of the user sub map. These 4-bit, line programming registers,
VBI_DATA_Px_Ny and VBI_DATA_Px, identify the VBI data
standard that are decoded on Line X in PAL mode or on Line Y
in NTSC mode. The different types of VBI standards decoded
by VBI_DATA_Px_Ny and VBI_DATA_Px are shown in
Table 70. Note that the X or Y value depends on whether the
ADV7180 is in PAL or NTSC mode.
Table 67. PAL
Feature
Standard
Teletext System A, C, or D
Teletext System B/WST
Video Programming System (VPS)
Vertical Interval Time Codes (VITC)
Wide Screen Signaling (WSS)
ITU-R BT.653
ITU-R BT.653
ETSI EN 300 231 V 1.3.1
Not applicable
ITU-R BT.1119-1/
ETSI EN.300294
Closed Captioning (CCAP)
Not applicable
Rev. G | Page 53 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Table 69. Default Standards on Lines for PAL and NTSC
PAL—625/50
NTSC—525/60
Default VBI
Data Decoded
Default VBI
Data Decoded
Default VBI
Default VBI
Data Decoded
Line No.
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
Line No.
318
319
320
321
322
323
324
325
326
327
328
329
332
333
334
335
Line No.
23
24
25
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22 + full
Data Decoded
Gemstar_1×
Gemstar_1×
Gemstar_1×
NABTS
NABTS
NABTS
NABTS
VITC
NABTS
VITC
NABTS
NABTS
NABTS
CGMS
CCAP
NABTS
Line No.
286
287
288
272
273
274
275
276
277
278
279
280
281
282
283
284
WST
WST
WST
WST
WST
WST
WST
WST
WST
WST
VPS
N/A
N/A
VITC
WST
WST
VPS
Gemstar_1×
Gemstar_1×
Gemstar_1×
NABTS
NABTS
NABTS
NABTS
NABTS
VITC
NABTS
VITC
NABTS
NABTS
NABTS
CGMS
WST
WST
WST
WST
WST
WST
WST
WST
WST
WST
VPS
VITC
WST
WST
CCAP
CCAP
odd field
22
23
CCAP
WSS
WST
336
WST
WST
285 + full
even field
NABTS
337 + full
even field
24 + full
odd field
Table 70. VBI Data Standards for Manual Configuration
VBI_DATA_Px_Ny
625/50—PAL
525/60—NTSC
0000
Disable VDP
Disable VDP
0001
Teletext system identified by VDP_TTXT_TYPE
Teletext system identified by VDP_TTXT_TYPE
0010
VPS-ETSI EN 300 231 V 1.3.1
Reserved
0011
VITC
VITC
0100
0101
0110
0111
WSS ITU-R BT.1119-1/ETSI.EN.300294
CGMS EIA-J CPR-1204/IEC 61880
Gemstar_1×
Gemstar_2×
CCAP EIA-608
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
CCAP
1000 to 1111
Reserved
Rev. G | Page 54 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Table 71.VBI Data Standards to be Decoded on Line Px (PAL) or Line Ny (NTSC)
Signal Name
Register Location
VDP_LINE_00F[7:4]
VDP_LINE_010[7:4]
VDP_LINE_011[7:4]
VDP_LINE_012[7:4]
VDP_LINE_013[7:4]
VDP_LINE_014[7:4]
VDP_LINE_015[7:4]
VDP_LINE_016[7:4]
VDP_LINE_017[7:4]
VDP_LINE_018[7:4]
VDP_LINE_019[7:4]
VDP_LINE_01A[7:4]
VDP_LINE_01B[7:4]
VDP_LINE_01C[7:4]
VDP_LINE_01D[7:4]
VDP_LINE_01E[7:4]
VDP_LINE_01F[7:4]
VDP_LINE_020[7:4]
VDP_LINE_021[7:4]
VDP_LINE_00E[3:0]
VDP_LINE_00F[3:0]
VDP_LINE_010[3:0]
VDP_LINE_011[3:0]
VDP_LINE_012[3:0]
VDP_LINE_013[3:0]
VDP_LINE_014[3:0]
VDP_LINE_015[3:0]
VDP_LINE_016[3:0]
VDP_LINE_017[3:0]
VDP_LINE_018[3:0]
VDP_LINE_019[3:0]
VDP_LINE_01A[3:0]
VDP_LINE_01B[3:0]
VDP_LINE_01C[3:0]
VDP_LINE_01D[3:0]
VDP_LINE_01E[3:0]
VDP_LINE_01F[3:0]
VDP_LINE_020[3:0]
VDP_LINE_021[3:0]
Dec Address
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
Hex Address
0x65
0x66
0x67
0x68
0x69
0x6A
0x6B
0x6C
0x6D
0x6E
0x6F
0x70
0x71
0x72
0x73
0x74
0x75
0x76
0x77
0x64
0x65
0x66
0x67
0x68
0x69
0x6A
0x6B
0x6C
0x6D
0x6E
0x6F
0x70
0x71
0x72
0x73
0x74
0x75
0x76
0x77
VBI_DATA_P6_N23
VBI_DATA_P7_N24
VBI_DATA_P8_N25
VBI_DATA_P9
VBI_DATA_P10
VBI_DATA_P11
VBI_DATA_P12_N10
VBI_DATA_P13_N11
VBI_DATA_P14_N12
VBI_DATA_P15_N13
VBI_DATA_P16_N14
VBI_DATA_P17_N15
VBI_DATA_P18_N16
VBI_DATA_P19_N17
VBI_DATA_P20_N18
VBI_DATA_P21_N19
VBI_DATA_P22_N20
VBI_DATA_P23_N21
VBI_DATA_P24_N22
VBI_DATA_P318
VBI_DATA_P319_N286
VBI_DATA_P320_N287
VBI_DATA_P321_N288
VBI_DATA_P322
VBI_DATA_P323
VBI_DATA_P324_N272
VBI_DATA_P325_N273
VBI_DATA_P326_N274
VBI_DATA_P327_N275
VBI_DATA_P328_N276
VBI_DATA_P329_N277
VBI_DATA_P330_N278
VBI_DATA_P331_N279
VBI_DATA_P332_N280
VBI_DATA_P333_N281
VBI_DATA_P334_N282
VBI_DATA_P335_N283
VBI_DATA_P336_N284
VBI_DATA_P337_N285
For teletext system identification, VDP assumes that if teletext
is present in a video channel, all the teletext lines comply with a
single standard system. Therefore, the line programming using
the VBI_DATA_Px_Ny and VBI_DATA_Px registers identifies
whether the data in line is teletext; the actual standard is
identified by the VDP_TTXT_TYPE_MAN bit.
Note that full field detection (lines other than VBI lines)
of any standard can also be enabled by writing into the
VBI_DATA_P24_N22[3:0] and VBI_DATA_P337_N285[3:0]
registers. So, if VBI_DATA_P24_N22[3:0] is programmed with
any teletext standard, then teletext is decoded off for the entire odd
field. The corresponding register for the even field is VBI_DATA_
P337_N285[3:0].
To program the VDP_TTXT_TYPE_MAN bit, the
VDP_TTXT_TYPE_MAN_ENABLE bit must be set to 1.
Rev. G | Page 55 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Setting ADF_ENABLE to 1 enables the insertion of VBI
decoded data into the ancillary 656 stream.
VDP_TTXT_TYPE_MAN_ENABLE, Enable Manual
Selection of Teletext Type, Address 0x60[2], User Sub Map
The user may select the data identification word (DID) and the
secondary data identification word (SDID) through programming
the ADF_DID[4:0] and ADF_SDID[5:0] bits, respectively.
Setting VDP_TTXT_TYPE_MAN_ENABLE to 0 (default), the
manual programming of the teletext type is disabled.
Setting VDP_TTXT_TYPE_MAN_ENABLE to 1, the manual
programming of the teletext type is enabled.
ADF_DID[4:0], User-Specified Data ID Word in Ancillary
Data, Address 0x62[4:0], User Sub Map
VDP_TTXT_TYPE_MAN[1:0], Specify the Teletext Type,
Address 0x60[1:0], User Sub Map
This bit selects the data ID word to be inserted into the ancillary
data stream with the data decoded by the VDP.
These bits specify the teletext type to be decoded. These bits are
functional only if VDP_TTXT_TYPE_MAN_ENABLE is set to 1.
The default value of ADF_DID[4:0] is 10101.
ADF_SDID[5:0], User-Specified Secondary Data ID Word
in Ancillary Data, Address 0x63[5:0], User Sub Map
Table 72. VDP_TTXT_TYPE_MAN Function
VDP_TTXT_
TYPE_MAN[1:0] 625/50 (PAL)
525/60 (NTSC)
Teletext-ITU-BT.653- Reserved
625/50-A
Teletext-ITU-BT.653- Teletext-ITU-BT.653-
625/50-B (WST) 525/60-B
Teletext-ITU-BT.653- Teletext-ITU-BT.653-
These bits select the secondary data ID word to be inserted in
the ancillary data stream with the data decoded by the VDP.
00 (default)
The default value of ADF_SDID[5:0] is 101010.
01
10
DUPLICATE_ADF, Enable Duplication/Spreading of
Ancillary Data over Y and C Buses, Address 0x63[7], User
Sub Map
625/50-C
525/60-C or EIA516
(NABTS)
This bit determines whether the ancillary data is duplicated
over both Y and C buses or if the data packets are spread
between the two channels.
11
Teletext-ITU-BT.653- Teletext-ITU-BT.653-
625/50-D 525/60-D
VDP Ancillary Data Output
When DUPLICATE_ADF to 0 (default) is set, the ancillary data
packet is spread across the Y and C data streams.
Reading the data back via I2C may not be feasible for VBI data
standards with high data rates (for example, teletext). An alternative
is to place the sliced data in a packet in the line blanking of the
digital output CCIR656 stream. This is available for all standards
sliced by the VDP module.
When DUPLICATE_ADF to 1 is set, the ancillary data packet is
duplicated on the Y and C data streams.
ADF_MODE[1:0], Determine the Ancillary Data Output
Mode, Address 0x62[6:5], User Sub Map
When data is sliced on a given line, the corresponding ancillary
data packet is placed immediately after the next EAV code that
occurs at the output (that is, data sliced from multiple lines are
not buffered up and then emitted in a burst). Note that, due to
the vertical delay through the comb filters, the line number on
which the packet is placed differs from the line number on
which the data was sliced.
These bits determine whether the ancillary data output mode is
in byte mode or nibble mode.
Table 73. ADF_MODE
ADF_MODE[1:0] Description
00 (default)
Nibble mode
01
10
Byte mode, no code restrictions
Byte mode, but 0x00 and 0xFF prevented
(0x00 replaced by 0x01, 0xFF replaced by 0xFE)
The user can enable or disable the insertion of VDP results that
have been decoded into the 656 ancillary streams by using the
ADF_ENABLE bit.
11
Reserved
ADF_ENABLE, Enable Ancillary Data Output Through
656 Stream, Address 0x62[7], User Sub Map
Setting ADF_ENABLE to 0 (default) disables the insertion of
VBI decoded data into the ancillary 656 stream.
Rev. G | Page 56 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
The ancillary data packet sequence is explained in Table 74 and
Table 75. The nibble output mode is the default mode of output
from the ancillary stream when ancillary stream output is
enabled. This format is in compliance with ITU-R BT.1364.
EP
•
•
—The MSB, B9, is the inverse of EP. This ensures that
restricted Code 0x00 and Code 0xFF do not occur.
LINE_NUMBER[9:0]—The line number of the line that
immediately precedes the ancillary data packet. The line
number is from the numbering system in ITU-R BT.470.
The line number runs from 1 to 625 in a 625-line system
and from 1 to 263 in a 525-line system. Note that, due to
the vertical delay through the comb filters, the line number
on which the packet is output differs from the line number
on which the VBI data was sliced.
Data count—The data count specifies the number of
UDWs in the ancillary stream for the standard. The total
number of user data-words is four times the data count.
Padding words can be introduced to make the total
number of UDWs divisible by 4.
The following abbreviations are used in Table 74 and Table 75:
•
•
EP—Even parity for Bit B8 to Bit B2. The parity bit’s EP is
set so that an even number of 1s are in Bit B8 to Bit B2,
including the parity bit, D8.
CS—Checksum word. The CS word is used to increase
confidence of the integrity of the ancillary data packet
from the DID, SDID, and DC through user data-words
(UDWs). It consists of 10 bits that include the following:
a 9-bit calculated value and B9 as the inverse of B8. The
checksum value B8 to B0 is equal to the nine LSBs of the
sum of the nine LSBs of the DID, SDID, and DC and all
UDWs in the packet. Prior to the start of the checksum
count cycle, all checksum and carry bits are preset to 0.
Any carry resulting from the checksum count cycle is
ignored.
•
Table 74. Ancillary Data in Nibble Output Format
Byte
B9
B8
B7
B6
B5
0
B4
0
B3
0
B2
0
B1
0
B0
0
Description
0
1
2
3
0
0
0
0
Ancillary data preamble
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
EP
EP
0
I2C_DID6_2[4:0]
0
0
DID (data identification
word)
4
EP
EP
I2C_SDID7_2[5:0]
0
0
SDID (secondary data
identification word)
5
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
0
0
DC[4:0]
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Data count
6
Padding[1:0]
VBI_DATA_STD[3:0]
LINE_NUMBER[9:5]
LINE_NUMBER[4:0]
ID0 (User Data-Word 1)
ID1 (User Data-Word 2)
ID2 (User Data-Word 3)
ID3 (User Data-Word 4)
ID4 (User Data-Word 5)
ID5 (User Data-Word 6)
ID6 (User Data-Word 7)
ID7 (User Data-Word 8)
ID8 (User Data-Word 9)
7
8
EVEN_FIELD
9
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
VDP_TTXT_TYPE[1:0]
VBI_WORD_1[7:4]
10
11
12
13
14
VBI_WORD_1[3:0]
VBI_WORD_2[7:4]
VBI_WORD_2[3:0]
VBI_WORD_3[7:4]
Pad 0x200; these
padding words may be
present, depending on
ancillary data type; user
data-word
n − 3
n − 2
n − 1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
B8
Checksum (CS)
CS (checksum word)
Rev. G | Page 57 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Table 75. Ancillary Data in Byte Output Format1
Byte
B9
B8
B7
B6
B5
0
B4
0
B3
0
B2
0
B1
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
B0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Description
0
0
0
0
0
Ancillary data preamble
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
3
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
0
I2C_DID6_2[4:0]
I2C_SDID7_2[5:0]
DC[4:0]
DID
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
4
SDID
5
0
Data count
6
Padding[1:0]
VBI_DATA_STD[3:0]
LINE_NUMBER[9:5]
LINE_NUMBER[4:0]
ID0 (User Data-Word 1)
ID1 (User Data-Word 2)
ID2 (User Data-Word 3)
ID3 (User Data-Word 4)
ID4 (User Data-Word 5)
ID5 (User Data-Word 6)
ID6 (User Data-Word 7)
ID7 (User Data-Word 8)
ID8 (User Data-Word 9)
7
0
8
EVEN_FIELD
0
9
0
0
0
VDP_TTXT_TYPE[1:0]
10
11
12
13
14
VBI_WORD_1[7:0]
VBI_WORD_2[7:0]
VBI_WORD_3[7:0]
VBI_WORD_4[7:0]
VBI_WORD_5[7:0]
Pad 0x200; these
padding words may be
present, depending on
ancillary data type; user
data-word
n − 3
n − 2
n − 1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
B8
Checksum
CS (checksum word)
1 This mode does not fully comply with ITU-R BT.1364.
Example
Structure of VBI Words in the Ancillary Data Stream
For teletext (B-WST), the framing code byte is 11100100 (0xE4),
with bits shown in the order of transmission. VBI_WORD_1 =
0x27, VBI_WORD_2 = 0x00, and VBI_WORD_3 = 0x00
translated into UDWs in the ancillary data stream for nibble
mode are as follows:
Each VBI data standard has been split into a clock-run-in
(CRI), a framing code (FC), and a number of data bytes (n).
The data packet in the ancillary stream includes only the FC
and data bytes. Table 76 shows the format of VBI_WORD_x in
the ancillary data stream.
UDW5[5:2] = 0010
Table 76. Structure of VBI Data-Words in the Ancillary Stream
UDW6[5:2] = 0111
Ancillary Data Byte No.
VBI_WORD_1
VBI_WORD_2
VBI_WORD_3
VBI_WORD_4
…
Byte Type
Description
UDW7[5:2] = 0000 (undefined bits set to 0)
UDW8[5:2] = 0000 (undefined bits set to 0)
UDW9[5:2] = 0000 (undefined bits set to 0)
UDW10[5:2] = 0000 (undefined bits set to 0)
For byte mode,
FC0
FC1
FC2
DB1
Framing Code[23:16]
Framing Code[15:8]
Framing Code[7:0]
First data byte
…
…
VBI_WORD_N + 3
DBn
Last (nth) data byte
UDW5[9:2] = 0010_0111
VDP Framing Code
The length of the actual framing code depends on the VBI data
standard. For uniformity, the length of the framing code reported
in the ancillary data stream is always 24 bits. For standards with
a smaller framing code length, the extra LSB bits are set to 0.
The valid length of the framing code can be decoded from the
VBI_DATA_STD bits available in ID0 (UDW 1). The framing
code is always reported in the inverse-transmission order.
UDW6[9:2] = 0000_0000 (undefined bits set to 0)
UDW7[9:2] = 0000_0000 (undefined bits set to 0)
Table 77 shows the framing code and its valid length for VBI
data standards supported by VDP.
Rev. G | Page 58 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
The data bytes in the ancillary data stream are as follows:
Data Bytes
VBI_WORD_4 = Byte 1[7:0]
VBI_WORD_5 = Byte 2[7:0]
VBI_WORD_4 to VBI_WORD_N + 3 contain the data-words
that were decoded by the VDP in the transmission order. The
position of bits in bytes is in the inverse transmission order.
The number of VBI_WORDS for each VBI data standard and
the total number of UDWs in the ancillary data stream is shown
in Table 78.
For example, closed captioning has two user data bytes, as
shown in Table 82.
Table 77. Framing Code Sequence for Different VBI Standards
Error-Free Framing Code Bits
(in Order of Transmission)
Error-Free Framing Code Reported by
VDP (in Reverse Order of Transmission)
VBI Standard
Length in Bits
TTXT_SYSTEM_A (PAL)
TTXT_SYSTEM_B (PAL)
TTXT_SYSTEM_B (NTSC)
TTXT_SYSTEM_C (PAL and NTSC)
TTXT_SYSTEM_D (PAL and NTSC)
VPS (PAL)
VITC (NTSC and PAL)
WSS (PAL)
GEMSTAR_1× (NTSC)
GEMSTAR_2× (NTSC)
CCAP (NTSC and PAL)
CGMS (NTSC)
8
8
8
8
8
16
1
24
3
11
3
11100111
11100100
11100100
11100111
11100101
10001010100011001
0
000111100011110000011111
001
1001_1011_101
001
0
11100111
00100111
00100111
11100111
10100111
1001100101010001
0
111110000011110001111000
100
101_1101_1001
100
0
1
Table 78. Total User Data-Words for Different VBI Standards1
VBI Standard
ADF Mode
Framing Code UDWs VBI Data-Words No. of Padding Words Total UDWs
TTXT_SYSTEM_A (PAL)
00 (nibble mode)
01, 10 (byte mode)
00 (nibble mode)
01, 10 (byte mode)
00 (nibble mode)
01, 10 (byte mode)
00 (nibble mode)
01, 10 (byte mode)
6
3
6
3
6
3
6
3
6
3
6
3
6
3
6
3
6
3
6
3
6
3
6
3
74
37
84
42
68
34
66
33
68
34
26
13
18
9
4
2
4
2
8
4
4
2
0
0
2
3
2
3
0
2
2
3
0
0
0
0
2
3
2
3
2
1
2
3
0
2
84
44
96
52
80
44
76
42
80
44
36
20
28
16
16
12
16
12
20
12
16
12
16
12
TTXT_SYSTEM_B (PAL)
TTXT_SYSTEM_B (NTSC)
TTXT_SYSTEM_C (PAL and NTSC)
TTXT_SYSTEM_D (PAL and NTSC) 00 (nibble mode)
01, 10 (byte mode)
VPS (PAL)
00 (nibble mode)
01, 10 (byte mode)
00 (nibble mode)
01, 10 (byte mode)
00 (nibble mode)
01, 10 (byte mode)
00 (nibble mode)
01, 10 (byte mode)
00 (nibble mode)
01, 10 (byte mode)
00 (nibble mode)
01, 10 (byte mode)
00 (nibble mode)
01, 10 (byte mode)
VITC (NTSC and PAL)
WSS (PAL)
GEMSTAR_1× (NTSC)
GEMSTAR_2× (NTSC)
CCAP (NTSC and PAL)
CGMS (NTSC)
6
3 + 3
1 The first four UDWs are always the ID.
Rev. G | Page 59 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
I2C Interface
Content-based updating also applies to lines with lost data.
Dedicated I2C readback registers are available for CCAP, CGMS,
WSS, Gemstar, VPS, PDC/UTC, and VITC. Because teletext is a
high data rate standard, data extraction is supported only through
the ancillary data packet.
Therefore, for standards like VPS, Gemstar, CGMS, and WSS, if no
data arrives in the next four lines programmed, the corresponding
available bit in the VDP_STATUS register is set high and the
content in the I2C registers for that standard is set to 0. The user
must write high to the corresponding clear bit so that when a
valid line is decoded after some time, the decoded results are
available in the I2C registers, with the available status bit set high.
User Interface for I2C Readback Registers
The VDP decodes all enabled VBI data standards in real time.
Because the I2C access speed is much lower than the decoded
rate, when the registers are accessed, they may be updated with
data from the next line. To avoid this, VDP has a self-clearing
clear bit and an available (AVL) status bit accompanying all I2C
readback registers.
The user must clear the I2C readback register by writing a high to
the clear bit. This resets the state of the available bit to low and
indicates that the data in the associated readback registers is not
valid. After the VDP decodes the next line of the corresponding
VBI data, the decoded data is placed into the I2C readback
register and the available bit is set to high to indicate that valid
data is now available.
If content-based updating is enabled, the available bit is set high
(assuming the clear bit was written) in the following cases:
•
•
The data contents have changed.
Data was being decoded and four lines with no data have
been detected.
•
No data was being decoded and new data is now being
decoded.
GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CB_CHANGE, Enable Content-
Based Updating for Gemstar/VPS/PDC/UTC,
Address 0x9C[5], User Sub Map
Setting GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CB_CHANGE to 0 disables
content-based updating.
Though the VDP decodes this VBI data in subsequent lines if
present, the decoded data is not updated to the readback registers
until the clear bit is set high again. However, this data is
available through the 656 ancillary data packets.
Setting GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CB_CHANGE to 1 (default)
enables content-based updating.
WSS_CGMS_CB_CHANGE, Enable Content-Based
Updating for WSS/CGMS, Address 0x9C[4],
User Sub Map
The clear and available bits are in the VDP_STATUS_CLEAR
(0x78, user sub map, write only) and VDP_STATUS (0x78, user
sub map, read only) registers, respectively.
Setting WSS_CGMS_CB_CHANGE to 0 disables content-based
updating.
Example I2C Readback Procedure
The following tasks must be performed to read one packet
(line) of PDC data from the decoder:
1. Write 10 to I2C_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC[1:0] (0x9C, user sub
map) to specify that PDC data must be updated to I2C
registers.
Setting WSS_CGMS_CB_CHANGE to 1 (default) enables
content-based updating.
VDP—Interrupt-Based Reading of VDP I2C Registers
Some VDP status bits are also linked to the interrupt request
controller so that the user does not have to poll the available status
bit. The user can configure the video decoder to trigger an
2. Write high to the GS_PDC_VPS_UTC_CLEAR bit (0x78,
user sub map) to enable I2C register updating.
3. Poll the GS_PDC_VPS_UTC_AVL bit (0x78, user sub
map) going high to check the availability of the PDC
packets.
INTRQ
interrupt request on the
pin in response to the valid
data available in the I2C registers. This function is available for
the following data types:
4. Read the data bytes from the PDC I2C registers. Repeat
Step 1 to Step 3 to read another line or packet of data.
•
•
CGMS or WSS. The user can select either triggering an
interrupt request each time sliced data is available or
triggering an interrupt request only when the sliced data
has changed. Selection is made via the WSS_CGMS_CB_
CHANGE bit.
Gemstar, PDC, VPS, or UTC. The user can select to trigger
an interrupt request each time sliced data is available or to
trigger an interrupt request only when the sliced data has
changed. Selection is made via the GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_
CB_CHANGE bit.
To read a packet of CCAP, CGMS, or WSS data, Step 1 to Step 3
are required only because they have dedicated registers.
VDP—Content-Based Data Update
For certain standards, such as WSS, CGMS, Gemstar, PDC, UTC,
and VPS, the information content in the signal transmitted remains
the same over numerous lines, and the user may want to be notified
only when there is a change in the information content or loss of
the information content. The user must enable content-based
updating for the required standard through the GS_VPS_PDC_
UTC_CB_CHANGE and WSS_CGMS_CB_CHANGE bits.
Therefore, the available bit shows the availability of that
standard only when its content has changed.
Rev. G | Page 60 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
The sequence for the interrupt-based reading of the VDP I2C
data registers is as follows for the CCAP standard:
VDP_VITC_MSK
to 1 enables the interrupt on the
Setting
VDP_VITC_Q signal.
Interrupt Status Register Details
1. The user unmasks the CCAP interrupt mask bit (Register 0x50,
Bit 0, user sub map = 1). CCAP data occurs on the incoming
video. VDP slices CCAP data and places it into the VDP
readback registers.
2. The VDP CCAP available bit CC_CAP goes high, and the
VDP module signals to the interrupt controller to stimulate
an interrupt request (for CCAP in this case).
3. The user reads the interrupt status bits (user sub map) and
sees that new CCAP data is available (Register 0x4E, Bit 0,
user sub map = 1).
The following read-only bits contain data detection information
from the VDP module since the status bit was last cleared or
unmasked.
VDP_CCAPD_Q, Address 0x4E[0], User Sub Map
When VDP_CCAPD_Q is 0 (default), CCAP data has not been
detected.
When VDP_CCAPD_Q is 1, CCAP data has been detected.
VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_Q, Address 0x4E[2],
User Sub Map
4. The user writes 1 to the CCAP interrupt clear bit (Register 0x4F,
Bit 0, user sub map = 1) in the interrupt I2C space (this is a
INTRQ
self-clearing bit). This clears the interrupt on the
pin but does not have an effect in the VDP I2C area.
When VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_Q is 0 (default), CGMS or
WSS data has not been detected.
5. The user reads the CCAP data from the VDP I2C area.
6. The user writes to Bit CC_CLEAR in the
VDP_STATUS_CLEAR register, (Register 0x78, Bit 0,
user sub map = 1) to signify the CCAP data has been read
(therefore the VDP CCAP can be updated at the next
occurrence of CCAP).
When VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_Q is 1, CGM or WSS data
has been detected.
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_Q, Address 0x4E[4],
User Sub Map
When VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_Q is 0 (default),
Gemstar, PDC, UTC, or VPS data has not been detected.
7. The user goes back to Step 2.
Interrupt Mask Register Details
When VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_Q is 1, Gemstar,
PDC, UTC, or VPS data has been detected.
The following bits set the interrupt mask on the signal from the
VDP VBI data slicer.
VDP_VITC_Q, Address 0x4E[6], User Sub Map,
Read Only
VDP_CCAPD_MSK
, Address 0x50[0], User Sub Map
When VDP_VITC_Q is 0 (default), VITC data has not been
detected.
VDP_CCAPD_MSK
on the VDP_CCAPD_Q signal.
Setting
to 0 (default) disables the interrupt
When VDP_VITC_Q is 1, VITC data has been detected.
VDP_CCAPD_MSK
Setting
VDP_CCAPD_Q signal.
to 1 enables the interrupt on the
Interrupt Status Clear Register Details
It is not necessary to write 0 to these write-only bits because
they automatically reset after they have been set to 1 (self-clearing).
VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_MSK
Sub Map
, Address 0x50[2], User
VDP_CCAPD_CLR, Address 0x4F[0], User Sub Map
VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_MSK
Setting
the interrupt on the VDP_CGMS_WSS_ CHNGD_Q signal.
VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_MSK
to 0 (default) disables
Setting VDP_CCAPD_CLR to 1 clears the VDP_CCAP_Q bit.
VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_CLR, Address 0x4F[2],
User Sub Map
Setting
to 1 enables the
interrupt on the VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_Q signal.
Setting VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_CLR to 1 clears the
VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_Q bit.
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_MSK
Address 0x50[4], User Sub Map
,
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_CLR,
Address 0x4F[4], User Sub Map
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_MSK
(default) disables the interrupt on the
Setting
to 0
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_Q signal.
Setting VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_CLR to 1 clears the
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_Q bit.
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_MSK
Setting
to 1 enables
the interrupt on the VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_Q signal.
VDP_VITC_CLR, Address 0x4F[6], User Sub Map
VDP_VITC_MSK
, Address 0x50[6], User Sub Map
Setting VDP_VITC_CLR to 1 clears the VDP_VITC_Q bit.
VDP_VITC_MSK
Setting
to 0 (default) disables the interrupt
on the VDP_VITC_Q signal.
Rev. G | Page 61 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
I2C READBACK REGISTERS
WST_PKT_DECODE_DISABLE, Disable Hamming
Decoding of Bytes in WST, Address 0x60[3], User Sub Map
Teletext
Setting WST_PKT_DECODE_DISABLE to 0 enables hamming
decoding of WST packets.
Because teletext is a high data rate standard, the decoded bytes
are available only as ancillary data. However, a TTXT_AVL bit
has been provided in I2C so that the user can check whether the
VDP has detected teletext. Note that the TTXT_AVL bit is a
plain status bit and does not use the protocol identified in the
I2C Interface section.
Setting WST_PKT_DECODE_DISABLE to 1 (default) disables
hamming decoding of WST packets.
For hamming-coded bytes, the dehammed nibbles are output
along with some error information from the hamming decoder
as follows:
TTXT_AVL, Teletext Detected Status, Address 0x78[7],
User Sub Map, Read Only
Input hamming coded byte: {D3, P3, D2, P2, D1, P1, D0, P0}
(bits in decoded order)
When TTXT_AVL is 0, teletext was not detected.
When TTXT_AVL is 1, teletext was detected.
WST Packet Decoding
Output dehammed byte: {E1, E0, 0, 0, D3', D2', D1', D0'}
(Di' – corrected bits, Ei error information).
Table 79. Error Bits in the Dehammed Output Byte
Output Data Bits
in Nibble
For WST only, the VDP decodes the magazine and row address
of teletext packets and further decodes the packet’s 8 × 4
hamming coded words. This feature can be disabled using the
WST_PKT_DECODE_DISABLE bit (Bit 3, Register 0x60, user
sub map). This feature is valid for WST only.
E[1:0] Error Information
00
01
10
11
No errors detected
Error in P4
Double error
Okay
Okay
Bad
Single error found and corrected
Okay
Table 80 describes the WST packets that are decoded.
Table 80. WST Packet Description
Packet
Byte
Description
Header Packet (X/00)
1st
Magazine number—Dehammed Byte 4
Row number—Dehammed Byte 5
Page number—Dehammed Byte 6
Page number—Dehammed Byte 7
Control bytes—Dehammed Byte 8 to Byte 13
Raw data bytes
2nd
3rd
4th
5th to 10th
11th to 42nd
1st
Text Packets (X/01 to X/25)
Magazine number—Dehammed Byte 4
Row number—Dehammed Byte 5
Raw data bytes
2nd
3rd to 42nd
1st
2nd
3rd
4th to 10th
11th to 23rd
24th to 42nd
1st
2nd
3rd
4th to 10th
11th to 23rd
24th to 42nd
1st
2nd
3rd
4th to 42nd
8/30 (Format 1) Packet
Design Code = 0000 or 0001
UTC
Magazine number—Dehammed Byte 4
Row number—Dehammed Byte 5
Design code—Dehammed Byte 6
Dehammed initial teletext page, Byte 7 to Byte 12
UTC bytes—Dehammed Byte 13 to Byte 25
Raw status bytes
8/30 (Format 2) Packet
Design Code = 0010 or 0011
PDC
Magazine number—Dehammed Byte 4
Row number—Dehammed Byte 5
Design code—Dehammed Byte 6
Dehammed initial teletext page, Byte 7 to Byte 12
PDC bytes—Dehammed Byte 13 to Byte 25
Raw status bytes
X/26, X/27, X/28, X/29, X/30, X/311
Magazine number—Dehammed Byte 4
Row number—Dehammed Byte 5
Design code—Dehammed Byte 6
Raw data bytes
1 For X/26, X/28, and X/29, further decoding needs 24 × 18 hamming decoding. Not supported at present.
Rev. G | Page 62 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
CGMS_WSS_AVL, CGMS/WSS Available, Address 0x78[2],
User Sub Map, Read Only
CGMS and WSS
The CGMS and WSS data packets convey the same type of
information for different video standards. WSS is for PAL and
CGMS is for NTSC; therefore, the CGMS and WSS readback
registers are shared. WSS is biphase coded; the VDP performs a
biphase decoding to produce the 14 raw WSS bits in the CGMS/
WSS readback I2C registers and to set the CGMS_WSS_AVL bit.
When CGMS_WSS_AVL is 0, CGMS/WSS was not detected.
When CGMS_WSS_AVL is 1, CGMS/WSS was detected.
VDP_CGMS_WSS_DATA_0[3:0], Address 0x7D[3:0];
VDP_CGMS_WSS_DATA_1[7:0], Address 0x7E[7:0];
VDP_CGMS_WSS_DATA_2[7:0], Address 0x7F[7:0];
User Sub Map, Read Only
CGMS_WSS_CLEAR, CGMS/WSS Clear, Address 0x78[2],
User Sub Map, Write Only, Self-Clearing
These bits hold the decoded CGMS or WSS data.
Refer to Figure 46 and Figure 47 for the I2C-to-WSS and I2C-to-
CGMS bit mapping.
Setting CGMS_WSS_CLEAR to 1 reinitializes the CGMS/WSS
readback registers.
VDP_CGMS_WSS_
VDP_CGMS_WSS_DATA_2 DATA_1[5:0]
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
RUN-IN
SEQUENCE
START
CODE
ACTIVE
VIDEO
11.0µs
38.4µs
42.5µs
Figure 46. WSS Waveform
+100 IRE
+70 IRE
VDP_CGMS_WSS_
DATA_0[3:0]
REF
VDP_CGMS_WSS_DATA_2
VDP_CGMS_WSS_DATA_1
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
0 IRE
49.1µs ± 0.5µs
–40 IRE
11.2µs
CRC SEQUENCE
2.235µs ± 20ns
Figure 47. CGMS Waveform
Table 81. CGMS Readback Registers1
Signal Name
Register Location
Address (User Sub Map)
CGMS_WSS_DATA_0[3:0]
CGMS_WSS_DATA_1[7:0]
CGMS_WSS_DATA_2[7:0]
VDP_CGMS_WSS_DATA_0[3:0]
VDP_CGMS_WSS_DATA_1[7:0]
VDP_CGMS_WSS_DATA_2[7:0]
125
126
127
0x7D
0x7E
0x7F
1 These registers are readback registers; default value does not apply.
Rev. G | Page 63 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
CCAP
CC_EVEN_FIELD, Address 0x78[1], User Sub Map,
Read Only
Two bytes of decoded closed caption data are available in the
I2C registers. The field information of the decoded CCAP data
can be obtained from the CC_EVEN_FIELD bit (Register 0x78).
Identifies the field from which the CCAP data was decoded.
When CC_EVEN_FIELD is 0, closed captioning was detected
from an odd field.
CC_CLEAR, Closed Caption Clear, Address 0x78[0],
User Sub Map, Write Only, Self-Clearing
When CC_EVEN_FIELD is 1, closed captioning was detected
from an even field.
Setting CC_CLEAR to 1 reinitializes the CCAP readback
registers.
VDP_CCAP_DATA_0, Address 0x79[7:0], User Sub Map,
Read Only
CC_AVL, Closed Caption Available, Address 0x78[0],
User Sub Map, Read Only
Decoded Byte 1 of CCAP data.
When CC_AVL is 0, closed captioning was not detected.
When CC_AVL is 1, closed captioning was detected.
VDP_CCAP_DATA_1, Address 0x7A[7:0], User Sub Map,
Read Only
Decoded Byte 2 of CCAP data.
10.5 ± 0.25µs
12.91µs
7 CYCLES
OF 0.5035MHz
(CLOCK RUN-IN)
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5
6
7
S
T
A
R
T
P
A
R
I
T
Y
P
A
R
I
T
Y
50 IRE
40 IRE
VDP_CCAP_D ATA_0 VDP_CCAP_D ATA_1
REFERENCE COLOR BURST
(9 CYCLES)
FREQUENCY = f = 3.579545MHz
SC
AMPLITUDE = 40 IRE
10.003µs
27.382µs
33.764µs
Figure 48. CCAP Waveform and Decoded Data Correlation
Table 82. CCAP Readback Registers1
Signal Name
Register Location
Address (User Sub Map)
CCAP_BYTE_1[7:0]
CCAP_BYTE_2[7:0]
VDP_CCAP_DATA_0[7:0]
VDP_CCAP_DATA_1[7:0]
121
122
0x79
0x7A
1 These registers are readback registers; default value does not apply.
Rev. G | Page 64 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
VITC
VITC_CLEAR, VITC Clear, Address 0x78[6],
User Sub Map, Write Only, Self-Clearing
VITC has a sequence of 10 syncs between each data byte. The
VDP strips these syncs from the data stream to output only the
data bytes. The VITC results are available in Register
VDP_VITC_DATA_0 to Register VDP_VITC_DATA_8
(Register 0x92 to Register 0x9A, user sub map).
Setting VITC_CLEAR to 1 reinitializes the VITC readback
registers.
VITC_AVL, VITC Available, Address 0x78[6],
User Sub Map, Read Only
The VITC has a CRC byte at the end; the syncs in between each
data byte are also used in this CRC calculation. Because the syncs
in between each data byte are not output, the CRC is calculated
internally. The calculated CRC is available for the user in the
VDP_VITC_CALC_CRC register (Resister 0x9B, user sub map).
When the VDP completes decoding the VITC line, the
VITC_DATA_x and VITC_CRC registers are updated and the
VITC_AVL bit is set.
When VITC_AVL is 0, VITC data was not detected.
When VITC_AVL is 1, VITC data was detected.
VITC Readback Registers
See Figure 49 for the I2C-to-VITC bit mapping.
TO
VITC WAVEFORM
BIT 0, BIT 1
BIT 88, BIT 89
Figure 49. VITC Waveform and Decoded Data Correlation
Table 83. VITC Readback Registers1
Signal Name
Register Location
Address (User Sub Map)
VITC_DATA_0[7:0]
VITC_DATA_1[7:0]
VITC_DATA_2[7:0]
VITC_DATA_3[7:0]
VITC_DATA_4[7:0]
VITC_DATA_5[7:0]
VITC_DATA_6[7:0]
VITC_DATA_7[7:0]
VITC_DATA_8[7:0]
VITC_CRC[7:0]
VDP_VITC_DATA_0[7:0] (VITC Bits[9:2])
VDP_VITC_DATA_1[7:0] (VITC Bits[19:12])
VDP_VITC_DATA_2[7:0] (VITC Bits[29:22])
VDP_VITC_DATA_3[7:0] (VITC Bits[39:32])
VDP_VITC_DATA_4[7:0] (VITC Bits[49:42])
VDP_VITC_DATA_5[7:0] (VITC Bits[59:52])
VDP_VITC_DATA_6[7:0] (VITC Bits[69:62])
VDP_VITC_DATA_7[7:0] (VITC Bits[79:72])
VDP_VITC_DATA_8[7:0] (VITC Bits[89:82])
VDP_VITC_CALC_CRC[7:0]
146
0x92
0x93
0x94
0x95
0x96
0x97
0x98
0x99
0x9A
0x9B
147
148
149
150
151
152
153
154
155
1 These registers are readback registers; default value does not apply.
Rev. G | Page 65 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
VPS/PDC/UTC/GEMSTAR
VDP supports autodetection of the Gemstar standard,
either Gemstar 1× or Gemstar 2×, and decodes accordingly.
For the autodetection mode to work, the user must set the
AUTO_DETECT_GS_TYPE bit (Register 0x61, user sub map)
and program the decoder to decode Gemstar 2× on the required
lines through line programming. The type of Gemstar decoded
can be determined by observing the GS_DATA_TYPE bit
(Register 0x78, user sub map).
The readback registers for VPS, PDC, and UTC are shared.
Gemstar is a high data rate standard and is available only through
the ancillary stream. However, for evaluation purposes, any one
line of Gemstar is available through the I2C registers sharing the
same register space as PDC, UTC, and VPS. Therefore, only VPS,
PDC, UTC, or Gemstar can be read through the I2C at one time.
To identify the data that should be made available in the I2C
registers, the user must program I2C_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC[1:0]
(Register Address 0x9C, user sub map).
AUTO_DETECT_GS_TYPE, Address 0x61[4], User Sub Map
Setting AUTO_DETECT_GS_TYPE to 0 (default) disables the
autodetection of the Gemstar type.
I2C_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC[1:0] (VDP), Address 0x9C[7:6],
User Sub Map
Specifies which standard result is available for I2C readback.
Setting AUTO_DETECT_GS_TYPE to 1 enables the
autodetection of the Gemstar type.
GS_DATA_TYPE, Address 0x78[5], User Sub Map, Read Only
GS_PDC_VPS_UTC_CLEAR, GS/PDC/VPS/UTC Clear,
Address 0x78[4], User Sub Map, Write Only, Self-Clearing
Identifies the decoded Gemstar data type.
When GS_DATA_TYPE is 0, Gemstar 1× mode is detected.
Read two data bytes from 0x84.
Setting GS_PDC_VPS_UTC_CLEAR to 1 reinitializes the
GS/PDC/VPS/UTC data readback registers.
When GS_DATA_TYPE is 1, Gemstar 2× mode is detected.
Read four data bytes from 0x84.
GS_PDC_VPS_UTC_AVL, GS/PDC/VPS/UTC Available,
Address 0x78[4], User Sub Map, Read Only
The Gemstar data that is available in the I2C register can be
from any line of the input video on which Gemstar was decoded.
To read the Gemstar data on a particular video line, the user
should use the manual configuration described in Table 70 and
Table 71 and enable Gemstar decoding only on the required line.
When GS_PDC_VPS_UTC_AVL is 0, no GS, PDC, VPS, or
UTC data was detected.
When GS_PDC_VPS_UTC_AVL is 1, one GS, PDC, VPS, or
UTC data was detected.
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC, Readback Registers,
Address 0x84 to Address 0x90
PDC/UTC
PDC and UTC are data transmitted through Teletext Packet 8/30
Format 2 (Magazine 8, Row 30, Design Code 2 or Design Code 3)
and Packet 8/30 Format 1 (Magazine 8, Row 30, Design Code 0
or Design Code 1). Therefore, if PDC or UTC data is to be read
through I2C, the corresponding teletext standard (WST or PAL
System B) should be decoded by VDP. The whole teletext
decoded packet is output on the ancillary data stream. The user
can look for the magazine number, row number, and design
code and qualify the data as PDC, UTC, or neither of these.
See Table 85 for information on the readback registers.
VPS
The VPS data bits are biphase decoded by the VDP. The decoded
data is available in both the ancillary stream and in the I2C
readback registers. VPS decoded data is available in the
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_0 to VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_12
registers (Address 0x84 to Address 0x90, User Sub Map). The
GS_PDC_VPS_UTC_AVL bit is set if the user programmed
I2C_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC to 01, as explained in Table 84.
If PDC/UTC packets are identified, Byte 0 to Byte 12 are updated
to the VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_0 to VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_12
registers, and the GS_PDC_VPS_UTC_AVL bit is set. The full
packet data is also available in the ancillary data format.
Note that the data available in the I2C register depends on the
status of the WST_PKT_DECODE_DISABLE bit (Bit 3,
Subaddress 0x60, user sub map).
Gemstar
The Gemstar-decoded data is made available in the ancillary
stream, and any one line of Gemstar is also available in the I2C
registers for evaluation purposes. To read Gemstar results
through the I2C registers, the user must program
I2C_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC to 00, as explained in Table 84.
Table 84. I2C_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC[1:0] Function
I2C_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC[1:0]
Description
Gemstar 1×/2×
VPS
PDC
UTC
00 (default)
01
10
11
Rev. G | Page 66 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Table 85. GS/VPS/PDC/UTC Readback Registers1
Signal Name
Register Location
Dec Address (User Sub Map) Hex Address (User Sub Map)
GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_0[7:0]
GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_1[7:0]
GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_2[7:0]
GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_3[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_4[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_5[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_6[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_7[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_8[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_9[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_10[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_11[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_12[7:0]
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_0[7:0] 132
0x84
0x85
0x86
0x87
0x88
0x89
0x8A
0x8B
0x8C
0x8D
0x8E
0x8F
0x90
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_1[7:0] 133
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_2[7:0] 134
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_3[7:0] 135
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_4[7:0]
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_5[7:0]
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_6[7:0]
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_7[7:0]
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_8[7:0]
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_9[7:0]
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_10[7:0]
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_11[7:0]
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_12[7:0]
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
1 The default value does not apply to readback registers.
VBI System 2
GDE_SEL_OLD_ADF, Address 0x4C[3], User Sub Map
The user has an option of using a different VBI data slicer called
VBI System 2. This data slicer is used to decode Gemstar and
closed caption VBI signals only.
The ADV7180 has a new ancillary data output block that
can be used by the VDP data slicer and the VBI System 2
data slicer. The new ancillary data formatter is used by setting
GDE_SEL_OLD_ADF to 0 (default). See Table 74 and Table 75
for information about how the data is packaged in the ancillary
data stream when this bit is set low.
Using this system, the Gemstar data is available only in the
ancillary data stream. A special mode enables one line of data to
be read back through I2C.
To use the old ancillary data formatter (to be backward compatible
with the ADV7183B), set GDE_SEL_OLD_ADF to 1. The ancillary
data format in this section refers to the ADV7183B-compatible
ancillary data formatter.
Gemstar Data Recovery
The Gemstar-compatible data recovery block (GSCD) supports
1× and 2× data transmissions. In addition, it can serve as a closed
caption decoder. Gemstar-compatible data transmissions can
occur only in NTSC. Closed caption data can be decoded in
both PAL and NTSC.
Setting GDE_SEL_OLD_ADF to 0 (default) enables a new
ancillary data system for use with the VDP and VBI System 2.
The block can be configured via I2C as follows:
Setting GDE_SEL_OLD_ADF to 1 enables the old ancillary
data system for use with the VBI System 2 only (ADV7183B
compatible).
•
•
•
GDECEL[15:0] allows data recovery on selected video lines
on even fields to be enabled or disabled.
GDECOL[15:0] enables the data recovery on selected lines
for odd fields.
GDECAD[0] configures the way in which data is
embedded in the video data stream.
The format of the data packet depends on the following criteria:
•
•
Transmission is 1× or 2×.
Data is output in 8-bit or 4-bit format (see the description
of the bit).
•
Data is closed caption (CCAP) or Gemstar compatible.
The recovered data is not available through I2C but is inserted into
the horizontal blanking period of an ITU-R BT.656-compatible
data stream. The data format is intended to comply with the
recommendation by the International Telecommunications
Union, ITU-R BT.1364. For more information, visit the
International Telecommunication Union website. See Figure 50.
Data packets are output if the corresponding enable bit is set
(see the GDECEL[15:0], Gemstar Decoding Even Lines,
Address 0x48[7:0], Address 0x49[7:0] and the GDECOL[15:0],
Gemstar Decoding Odd Lines, Address 0x4A[7:0], Address
0x4B[7:0] sections), and the decoder detects the presence of data.
For video lines where no data is decoded, no data packet is output,
even if the corresponding line enable bit is set.
Rev. G | Page 67 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Each data packet starts immediately after the EAV code of the
preceding line. Figure 50 and Table 86 show the overall structure
of the data packet.
•
Data count byte, giving the number of user data-words that
follow.
User data section.
Optional padding to ensure that the length of the user
data-word section of a packet is a multiple of four bytes
(requirement as set in ITU-R BT.1364).
Checksum byte.
•
•
Entries within the packet are as follows:
•
•
Fixed preamble sequence of 0x00, 0xFF, and 0xFF.
DID. The value for the DID marking a Gemstar or CCAP
data packet is 0x140 (10-bit value).
•
Table 86 lists the values within a generic data packet that is
output by the ADV7180 in 8-bit format.
•
SDID, which contains information about the video line
from which data was retrieved, whether the Gemstar
transmission was in 1× or 2× format, and whether it was
retrieved from an even or odd field.
DATA IDENTIFICATION
SECONDARY DATA IDENTIFICATION
DATA
COUNT
OPTIONAL PADDING CHECK
00
FF
FF
DID
SDID
USER DATA
BYTES
SUM
PREAMBLE FOR ANCILLARY DATA
USER DATA (4 OR 8 WORDS)
Figure 50. Gemstar- and CCAP-Embedded Data Packet (Generic)
Table 86. Generic Data Output Packet
Byte
D[9]
D[8]
D[7]
D[6]
D[5]
D[4]
D[3]
D[2]
D[1]
D[0]
0
Description
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
DID
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
3
0
1
0
1
0
0
4
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
CS[8]
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
CS[8]
EF
0
2X
0
0
SDID
Line[3:0]
DC[1]
5
0
0
DC[0]
0
Data count (DC)
6
0
0
0
Word1[7:4]
Word1[3:0]
Word2[7:4]
Word2[3:0]
Word3[7:4]
Word3[3:0]
Word4[7:4]
Word4[3:0]
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
Checksum
7
0
0
0
8
0
0
0
9
0
0
0
10
11
12
13
14
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CS[7]
CS[6]
CS[5]
CS[4]
CS[3]
CS[2]
0
Table 87. Data Byte Allocation
2× Raw Information Bytes Retrieved from the Video Line
User Data-Words
(Including Padding)
GDECAD
Padding Bytes
DC[1:0]
10
01
01
01
1
1
0
0
4
4
2
2
0
1
0
1
8
4
4
4
0
0
0
2
Rev. G | Page 68 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Gemstar Bit Names
•
•
DC[1:0]—Data count value. The number of UDWs in the
packet divided by 4. The number of UDWs in any packet
must be an integral number of 4. Padding may be required
at the end, as set in ITU-R BT.1364. See Table 87.
CS[8:2]—The checksum is provided to determine the
integrity of the ancillary data packet. It is calculated by
summing up D[8:2] of DID, SDID, the data count byte, and
all UDWs and ignoring any overflow during the summation.
Because all data bytes that are used to calculate the checksum
have their two LSBs set to 0, the CS[1:0] bits are also always 0.
The following are the Gemstar bit names:
•
DID—The data identification value is 0x140 (10-bit value).
Care has been taken so that in 8-bit systems, the two LSBs
do not carry vital information.
EP
•
EP and —The EP bit is set to ensure even parity on the
D[8:0] data-word. Even parity means there is always an
even number of 1s within the D[8:0] bit arrangement. This
includes the EP bit.
and is output on D[9]. The
reserved codes of 00 and FF do not occur.
EP
describes the logic inverse of EP
EP
is output to ensure that the
CS
CS
[8]—describes the logic inversion of CS[8]. The value [8]
is included in the checksum entry of the data packet to ensure
that the reserved values of 0x00 and 0xFF do not occur. Table 88
to Table 91 outline the possible data packages.
•
•
EF—Even field identifier. EF = 1 indicates that the data was
recovered from a video line on an even field.
2×—This bit indicates whether the data sliced was in
Gemstar 1× or 2× format. A high indicates 2× format.
The 2× bit determines whether the raw information
retrieved from the video line was two bytes or four bytes.
The state of the GDECAD bit affects whether the bytes are
transmitted straight (that is, two bytes transmitted as two
bytes) or whether they are split into nibbles (that is, two
bytes transmitted as four half bytes). Padding bytes are
then added where necessary.
Gemstar_2× Format, Half-Byte Output Mode
Half-byte output mode is selected by setting GDECAD to 0;
full-byte output mode is selected by setting GDECAD to 1. See
the GDECAD, Gemstar Decode Ancillary Data Format,
Address 0x4C[0] section.
Gemstar_1× Format
Half-byte output mode is selected by setting CDECAD to 0,
full-byte output mode is selected by setting CDECAD to 1. See
the GDECAD, Gemstar Decode Ancillary Data Format,
Address 0x4C[0] section.
•
Line[3:0]—This entry provides a code that is unique for
each of the possible 16 source lines of video from which
Gemstar data may have been retrieved. Refer to Table 96
and Table 97.
Table 88. Gemstar_2× Data, Half-Byte Mode
Byte
D[9]
D[8]
D[7]
D[6]
D[5]
D[4]
D[3]
D[2]
D[1]
D[0]
Description
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
DID
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
3
0
1
0
1
0
0
4
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
CS[8]
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
CS[8]
EF
0
1
0
0
SDID
Line[3:0]
5
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
Data count
6
0
0
0
0
Gemstar Word1[7:4]
Gemstar Word1[3:0]
Gemstar Word2[7:4]
Gemstar Word2[3:0]
Gemstar Word3[7:4]
Gemstar Word3[3:0]
Gemstar Word4[7:4]
Gemstar Word4[3:0]
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
Checksum
7
0
0
0
0
8
0
0
0
0
9
0
0
0
0
10
11
12
13
14
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CS[7]
CS[6]
CS[5]
CS[4]
CS[3]
CS[2]
CS[1]
CS[0]
Rev. G | Page 69 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Table 89. Gemstar_2× Data, Full-Byte Mode
Byte
D[9]
D[8]
D[7]
D[6]
D[5]
D[4]
D[3]
D[2]
D[1]
D[0]
Description
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
DID
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
3
0
1
0
0
0
4
EP
EP
EP
EP
EF
0
0
0
SDID
Line[3:0]
5
0
0
0
1
0
0
Data count
6
Gemstar Word1[7:0]
Gemstar Word2[7:0]
Gemstar Word3[7:0]
Gemstar Word4[7:0]
0
0
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
Checksum
7
0
0
8
0
0
9
0
0
10
CS[8]
CS[8]
CS[7]
CS[6]
CS[5]
CS[4]
CS[3]
CS[2]
CS[1]
CS[0]
Table 90. Gemstar_1× Data, Half-Byte Mode
Byte
D[9]
D[8]
D[7]
D[6]
D[5]
D[4]
D[3]
D[2]
D[1]
D[0]
0
Description
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
DID
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
3
0
1
0
1
0
Line[3:0]
0
0
0
4
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
CS[8]
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
CS[8]
EF
0
0
0
SDID
5
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
Data count
6
0
0
0
0
Gemstar Word1[7:4]
Gemstar Word1[3:0]
Gemstar Word2[7:4]
Gemstar Word2[3:0]
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
7
0
0
0
0
8
0
0
0
0
9
0
0
0
0
10
CS[7]
CS[6]
CS[5]
CS[4]
CS[3]
CS[2]
CS[1]
CS[0]
Checksum
Table 91. Gemstar_1× Data, Full-Byte Mode
Byte
D[9]
D[8]
D[7]
D[6]
D[5]
D[4]
D[3]
D[2]
D[1]
D[0]
Description
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
DID
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
3
0
1
0
0
Line[3:0]
0
0
4
EP
EP
EP
EP
EF
0
0
SDID
5
0
0
1
0
Data count
6
Gemstar Word1[7:0]
Gemstar Word2[7:0]
0
User data-words
User data-words
UDW padding 0x200
UDW padding 0x200
Checksum
7
0
8
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
9
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
10
CS[8]
CS[8]
CS[7]
CS[6]
CS[5]
CS[4]
CS[3]
CS[2]
CS[1]
CS[0]
Rev. G | Page 70 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Table 92. NTSC CCAP Data, Half-Byte Mode
Byte
D[9]
D[8]
D[7]
D[6]
D[5]
D[4]
D[3]
D[2]
D[1]
D[0]
Description
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
DID
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
3
0
1
0
1
0
0
4
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
CS[8]
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
CS[8]
EF
0
0
0
SDID
5
0
0
0
0
Data count
6
0
0
0
0
CCAP Word1[7:4]
CCAP Word1[3:0]
CCAP Word2[7:4]
CCAP Word2[3:0]
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
Checksum
7
0
0
0
0
8
0
0
0
0
9
0
0
0
0
10
CS[7]
CS[6]
CS[5]
CS[4]
CS[3]
CS[2]
CS[1]
CS[0]
Table 93. NTSC CCAP Data, Full-Byte Mode
Byte
D[9]
D[8]
D[7]
D[6]
D[5]
D[4]
D[3]
D[2]
D[1]
D[0]
Description
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
DID
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
3
0
1
0
0
0
4
EP
EP
EP
EP
EF
0
0
0
SDID
5
0
0
Data count
6
CCAP Word1[7:0]
CCAP Word2[7:0]
0
0
User data-words
User data-words
UDW padding 0x200
UDW padding 0x200
Checksum
7
0
0
8
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
9
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
10
CS[8]
CS[8]
CS[7]
CS[6]
CS[5]
CS[4]
CS[3]
CS[2]
CS[1]
CS[0]
Rev. G | Page 71 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Table 94. PAL CCAP Data, Half-Byte Mode
Byte
D[9]
D[8]
D[7]
D[6]
D[5]
D[4]
D[3]
D[2]
D[1]
D[0]
Description
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
DID
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
3
0
1
0
1
0
0
4
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
CS[8]
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
EP
CS[8]
EF
0
0
0
SDID
5
0
0
0
0
Data count
6
0
0
0
0
CCAP Word1[7:4]
CCAP Word1[3:0]
CCAP Word2[7:4]
CCAP Word2[3:0]
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
User data-words
Checksum
7
0
0
0
0
8
0
0
0
0
9
0
0
0
0
10
CS[7]
CS[6]
CS[5]
CS[4]
CS[3]
CS[2]
CS[1]
CS[0]
Table 95. PAL CCAP Data, Full-Byte Mode
Byte
D[9]
D[8]
D[7]
D[6]
D[5]
D[4]
D[3]
D[2]
D[1]
0
D[0]
Description
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
Fixed preamble
DID
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
3
0
1
0
0
0
4
EP
EP
EP
EP
EF
0
0
0
SDID
5
0
0
Data count
6
CCAP Word1[7:0]
CCAP Word2[7:0]
0
0
User data-words
User data-words
UDW padding 0x200
UDW padding 0x200
Checksum
7
0
0
8
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
9
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
10
CS[8]
CS[8]
CS[7]
CS[6]
CS[5]
CS[4]
CS[3]
CS[2]
CS[1]
CS[0]
See the GDECEL[15:0], Gemstar Decoding Even Lines,
Address 0x48[7:0], Address 0x49[7:0] section and the
GDECOL[15:0], Gemstar Decoding Odd Lines,
Address 0x4A[7:0], Address 0x4B[7:0] section.
NTSC CCAP Data
Half-byte output mode is selected by setting GDECAD to 0, and
the full-byte mode is enabled by setting GDECAD to 1. See the
GDECAD, Gemstar Decode Ancillary Data Format, Address
0x4C[0] section. The data packet formats are shown in Table 92
and Table 93. Only closed caption data can be embedded in the
output data stream.
GDECEL[15:0], Gemstar Decoding Even Lines,
Address 0x48[7:0], Address 0x49[7:0]
The 16 bits of GDECEL[15:0] are interpreted as a collection of
16 individual line decode enable signals. Each bit refers to a line
of video in an even field. Setting the bit enables the decoder block
trying to find Gemstar or closed caption-compatible data on
that particular line. Setting the bit to 0 prevents the decoder
from trying to retrieve data. See Table 96 and Table 97.
NTSC closed caption data is sliced on Line 21 of even and odd
fields. The corresponding enable bit must be set high. See the
GDECAD, Gemstar Decode Ancillary Data Format, Address
0x4C[0] section and the GDECOL[15:0], Gemstar Decoding
Odd Lines, Address 0x4A[7:0], Address 0x4B[7:0] section.
PAL CCAP Data
To retrieve closed caption data services on NTSC (Line 284),
GDECEL[11] must be set.
Half-byte output mode is selected by setting GDECAD to 0, and
full-byte output mode is selected by setting GDECAD to 1. See
the GDECAD, Gemstar Decode Ancillary Data Format,
Address 0x4C[0] section. Table 94 and Table 95 list the bytes of
the data packet.
To retrieve closed caption data services on PAL (Line 335),
GDECEL[14] must be set.
The default value of GDECEL[15:0] is 0x0000. This setting
instructs the decoder not to attempt to decode Gemstar or
CCAP data from any line in the even field. The user should
only enable Gemstar slicing on lines where VBI data is expected.
Only closed caption data can be embedded in the output data
stream. PAL closed caption data is sliced from Line 22 and
Line 335. The corresponding enable bits must be set.
Rev. G | Page 72 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Table 96. NTSC Line Enable Bits and Corresponding Line
Numbering
GDECAD, Gemstar Decode Ancillary Data Format,
Address 0x4C[0]
Line Number
Line[3:0] (ITU-R BT.470)
The decoded data from Gemstar-compatible transmissions or
closed caption-compatible transmissions is inserted into the
horizontal blanking period of the respective line of video. A
potential problem can arise if the retrieved data bytes have a
value of 0x00 or 0xFF. In an ITU-R BT.656-compatible data
stream, these values are reserved and used only to form a fixed
preamble. The GDECAD bit allows the data to be inserted into
the horizontal blanking period in two ways:
Enable Bit
GDECOL[0]
GDECOL[1]
GDECOL[2]
GDECOL[3]
GDECOL[4]
GDECOL[5]
GDECOL[6]
GDECOL[7]
GDECOL[8]
GDECOL[9]
GDECOL[10]
GDECOL[11]
Comment
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar or
closed caption
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar or
closed caption
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
Gemstar
•
Insert all data straight into the data stream, even the
reserved values of 0x00 and 0xFF, if they occur. This may
violate output data format specification ITU-R BT.1364.
Split all data into nibbles and insert the half-bytes over
double the number of cycles in a 4-bit format.
•
12
13
14
15
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
22
23
24
25
GDECOL[12]
GDECOL[13]
GDECOL[14]
GDECOL[15]
GDECEL[0]
GDECEL[1]
GDECEL[2]
GDECEL[3]
GDECEL[4]
GDECEL[5]
GDECEL[6]
GDECEL[7]
GDECEL[8]
GDECEL[9]
GDECEL[10]
GDECEL[11]
When GDECAD is 0 (default), the data is split into half-bytes
and inserted.
When GDECAD is 1, the data is output straight into the data
stream in 8-bit format.
273 (10)
274 (11)
275 (12)
276 (13)
277 (14)
278 (15)
279 (16)
280 (17)
281 (18)
282 (19)
283 (20)
284 (21)
Table 97. PAL Line Enable Bits and Line Numbering
Line Number
Line[3:0] (ITU-R BT.470)
Enable Bit
GDECOL[0]
GDECOL[1]
GDECOL[2]
GDECOL[3]
GDECOL[4]
GDECOL[5]
GDECOL[6]
GDECOL[7]
GDECOL[8]
GDECOL[9]
GDECOL[10]
GDECOL[11]
GDECOL[12]
GDECOL[13]
GDECOL[14]
GDECOL[15]
GDECEL[0]
GDECEL[1]
GDECEL[2]
GDECEL[3]
GDECEL[4]
GDECEL[5]
GDECEL[6]
GDECEL[7]
GDECEL[8]
GDECEL[9]
GDECEL[10]
GDECEL[11]
GDECEL[12]
GDECEL[13]
GDECEL[14]
GDECEL[15]
Comment
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Closed caption
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Not valid
Closed caption
Not valid
12
13
14
15
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
321 (8)
322 (9)
323 (10)
324 (11)
325 (12)
326 (13)
327 (14)
328 (15)
329 (16)
330 (17)
331 (18)
332 (19)
333 (20)
334 (21)
335 (22)
336 (23)
12
13
14
15
285 (22)
286 (23)
287 (24)
288 (25)
GDECEL[12]
GDECEL[13]
GDECEL[14]
GDECEL[15]
GDECOL[15:0], Gemstar Decoding Odd Lines,
Address 0x4A[7:0], Address 0x4B[7:0]
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
The 16 bits of GDECOL[15:0] form a collection of 16 individual
line decode enable signals. See Table 96 and Table 97.
To retrieve closed caption data services on NTSC (Line 21),
GDECOL[11] must be set.
To retrieve closed caption data services on PAL (Line 22),
GDECOL[14] must be set.
The default value of GDECOL[15:0] is 0x0000. This setting
instructs the decoder not to attempt to decode Gemstar or CCAP
data from any line in the odd field. The user should only enable
Gemstar slicing on lines where VBI data is expected.
Rev. G | Page 73 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Letterbox Detection
There is a two-field delay in reporting any line count parameter.
Incoming video signals may conform to different aspect ratios
(16:9 wide screen or 4:3 standard). For certain transmissions in
the wide-screen format, a digital sequence (WSS) is transmitted
with the video signal. If a WSS sequence is provided, the aspect
ratio of the video can be derived from the digitally decoded bits
that WSS contains.
There is no letterbox detected bit. Read the LB_LCT[7:0] and
LB_LCB[7:0] register values to determine whether the letterbox-
type video is present in the software.
LB_LCT[7:0], Letterbox Line Count Top, Address 0x9B[7:0];
LB_LCM[7:0], Letterbox Line Count Mid, Address 0x9C[7:0];
LB_LCB[7:0], Letterbox Line Count Bottom, Address 0x9D[7:0]
In the absence of a WSS sequence, letterbox detection can be
used to find wide-screen signals. The detection algorithm examines
the active video content of lines at the start and end of a field. If
black lines are detected, this may indicate that the currently
shown picture is in wide-screen format.
Table 98. LB_LCx Access Information
Signal Name
LB_LCT[7:0]
LB_LCM[7:0]
LB_LCB[7:0]
Address
0x9B
0x9C
0x9D
The active video content (luminance magnitude) over a line of
video is summed together. At the end of a line, this accumulated
value is compared with a threshold, and a decision is made as to
whether or not a particular line is black. The threshold value
needed may depend on the type of input signal; some control is
provided via LB_TH[4:0].
LB_TH[4:0], Letterbox Threshold Control,
Address 0xDC[4:0]
Table 99. LB_TH Function
LB_TH[4:0]
Description
Detection at the Start of a Field
01100 (default)
01101 to 10000
Default threshold for detection of black lines
Increase threshold (need larger active video
content before identifying nonblack lines)
Decrease threshold (even small noise levels
can cause the detection of nonblack lines)
The ADV7180 expects a section of at least six consecutive black
lines of video at the top of a field. After those lines are detected,
LB_LCT[7:0] reports the number of black lines that were actually
found. By default, the ADV7180 starts looking for those black
lines in sync with the beginning of active video, for example,
immediately after the last VBI video line. LB_SL[3:0] allows the
user to set the start of letterbox detection from the beginning of
a frame on a line-by-line basis. The detection window closes in
the middle of the field.
00000 to 01011
LB_SL[3:0], Letterbox Start Line, Address 0xDD[7:4]
The LB_SL[3:0] bits are set at 0100 by default. For an NTSC
signal, this window is from Line 23 to Line 286.
By changing the bits to 0101, the detection window starts on
Line 24 and ends on Line 287.
Detection at the End of a Field
The ADV7180 expects at least six continuous lines of black video
at the bottom of a field before reporting the number of lines
actually found via the LB_LCB[7:0] value. The activity window
for letterbox detection (end of field) starts in the middle of an
active field. Its end is programmable via LB_EL[3:0].
LB_EL[3:0], Letterbox End Line, Address 0xDD[3:0]
The LB_EL[3:0] bits are set at 1101 by default. This means that the
letterbox detection window ends with the last active video line.
For an NTSC signal, this window is from Line 262 to Line 525.
By changing the bits to 1100, the detection window starts on
Line 261 and ends on Line 254.
Detection at the Midrange
Some transmissions of wide-screen video include subtitles
within the lower black box. If the ADV7180 finds at least two
black lines followed by some more nonblack video, for example, the
subtitle followed by the remainder of the bottom black block, it
reports a midcount via LB_LCM[7:0]. If no subtitles are found,
LB_LCM[7:0] reports the same number as LB_LCB[7:0].
Rev. G | Page 74 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
PIXEL PORT CONFIGURATION
The ADV7180 has a very flexible pixel port that can be configured
in a variety of formats to accommodate downstream ICs.
SWPC, Swap Pixel Cr/Cb, Address 0x27[7]
This bit allows Cr and Cb samples to be swapped.
Table 100, Table 101, and Table 102 summarize the various
functions that the ADV7180 pins can have in different modes of
operation.
When SWPC is 0 (default), no swapping is allowed.
When SWPC is 1, the Cr and Cb values can be swapped.
LLC_PAD_SEL[2:0] LLC Output Selection,
Address 0x8F[6:4]
The following I2C write allows the user to select between LLC
(nominally at 27 MHz) and LLC (nominally at 13.5 MHz).
The ordering of components, for example, Cr vs. Cb for
Channel A, Channel B, and Channel C can be changed. See the
SWPC, Swap Pixel Cr/Cb, Address 0x27[7] section. Table 100
indicates the default positions for the Cr/Cb components.
OF_SEL[3:0], Output Format Selection, Address 0x03[5:2]
The LLC signal is useful for LLC-compatible wide bus (16-bit)
output modes. See the OF_SEL[3:0], Output Format Selection,
Address 0x03[5:2] section for additional information. The LLC
signal and data on the data bus are synchronized. By default, the
rising edge of LLC/LLC is aligned with the Y data; the falling
edge occurs when the data bus holds C data. The polarity of the
clock, and therefore the Y/C assignments to the clock edges, can
be altered by using the polarity LLC pin.
The modes in which the ADV7180 pixel port can be configured
are under the control of OF_SEL[3:0]. See Table 102 for details.
The default LLC frequency output on the LLC pin is approximately
27 MHz. For modes that operate with a nominal data rate of
13.5 MHz (0001, 0010), the clock frequency on the LLC pin
stays at the higher rate of 27 MHz. For information on outputting
the nominal 13.5 MHz clock on the LLC pin, see the
LLC_PAD_SEL[2:0] LLC Output Selection, Address 0x8F[6:4]
section.
When LLC_PAD_SEL is 000, the output is nominally 27 MHz
LLC on the LLC pin (default).
When LLC_PAD_SEL is 101, the output is nominally 13.5 MHz
LLC on the LLC pin.
Table 100. 64-Lead LQFP P15 to P0 Output/Input Pin Mapping
Data Port Pins P[15:0]
Format and Mode
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Video Out, 8-Bit, 4:2:2
Video Out, 16-Bit, 4:2:2
YCrCb[7:0]OUT
Y[7:0]OUT
CrCb[7:0]OUT
Table 101. 48-Lead, 40-Lead, and 32-Lead Devices P7 to P0 Output/Input Pin Mapping
Data Port Pins P[7:0]
Format and Mode
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Video Out, 8-Bit, 4:2:2
YCrCb[7:0]OUT
Table 102. ADV7180 Standard Definition Pixel Port Modes
64-Lead LQFP P[15:0]
P[15:8] P[7:0]
48-Lead LQFP, 40-Lead LFCSP, or 32-Lead LFCSP
OF_SEL[3:0]
0000 to 0001
0010
Format
P[7:0]
Reserved
Reserved, do not use
Not valid
16-bit at LLC 4:2:2
8-bit at LLC 4:2:2 (default)
Reserved
Y[7:0]
YCrCb[7:0]
CrCb[7:0]
Three-state
0011 (default)
0100 to 1111
YCrCb[7:0]
Reserved, do not use
Rev. G | Page 75 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
GPO CONTROL
The 64-lead and 48-lead LQFP has four general-purpose
outputs (GPO). These outputs allow the user to control other
devices in a system via the I2C port of the device.
Table 103. General-Purpose Output Truth Table
GPO_ENABLE GPO[3:0] GPO3 GPO2 GPO1 GPO0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
XXXX1
0000
0001
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110
0111
1000
1001
1010
1011
1100
1101
1110
1111
Z
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Z
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
Z
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
Z
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
The 40-lead and 32-lead LFCSP do not have GPO pins.
GPO_ENABLE, General-Purpose Output Enable,
Address 0x59[4]
When GPO_ENABLE is set to 0, all GPO pins are three-stated.
When GPO_ENABLE is set to 1, all GPO pins are in a driven
state. The polarity output from each GPO is controlled by
GPO[3:0] for the 64-lead and 48-lead LQFP.
GPO[3:0], General-Purpose Outputs, Address 0x59[3:0]
Individual control of the four GPO ports is achieved using
GPO[3:0].
GPO_ENABLE must be set to 1 for the GPO pins to become active.
GPO[0]
When GPO[0] is set to 0, Logic 0 is output from the GPO0 pin.
When GPO[0] is set to 1, Logic 1 is output from the GPO0 pin.
GPO[1]
1 X indicates any value.
When GPO[1] is set to 0, Logic 0 is output from the GPO1 pin.
When GPO[1] is set to 1, Logic 1 is output from the GPO1 pin.
GPO[2]
When GPO[2] is set to 0, Logic is output from the GPO2 pin.
When GPO[2] is set to 1, Logic 1 is output from the GPO2 pin.
GPO[3]
When GPO[3] is set to 0, Logic 0 is output from the GPO3 pin.
When GPO[3] is set to 1, Logic 1 is output from the GPO3 pin.
Rev. G | Page 76 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
MPU PORT DESCRIPTION
The ADV7180 supports a 2-wire (I2C-compatible) serial interface.
Two inputs, serial data (SDATA) and serial clock (SCLK), carry
information between the ADV7180 and the system I2C master
controller. Each slave device is recognized by a unique address.
The ADV7180 I2C port allows the user to set up and configure
the decoder and to read back the captured VBI data. The
ADV7180 has four possible slave addresses for both read and
write operations, depending on the logic level of the ALSB pin.
The four unique addresses are shown in Table 104. The ADV7180
ALSB pin controls Bit 1 of the slave address. By altering the
ALSB, it is possible to control two ADV7180s in an application
without the conflict of using the same slave address. The LSB
(Bit 0) sets either a read or write operation. Logic 1 corresponds to
a read operation, and Logic 0 corresponds to a write operation.
the first byte means that the master writes information to the
peripheral. Logic 1 on the LSB of the first byte means that the
master reads information from the peripheral.
The ADV7180 acts as a standard slave device on the bus. The
data on the SDATA pin is eight bits long, supporting the 7-bit
W
address plus the R/ bit. The device has 249 subaddresses to
enable access to the internal registers. It, therefore, interprets
the first byte as the device address and the second byte as the
starting subaddress. The subaddresses auto-increment, allowing
data to be written to or read from the starting subaddress. A data
transfer is always terminated by a stop condition. The user can
also access any unique subaddress register on a one-by-one
basis without updating all the registers.
Stop and start conditions can be detected at any stage during the
data transfer. If these conditions are asserted out of sequence with
normal read and write operations, they cause an immediate jump
to the idle condition. During a given SCLK high period, the user
should only issue one start condition, one stop condition, or a
single stop condition followed by a single start condition. If an
invalid subaddress is issued by the user, the ADV7180 does not
issue an acknowledge and returns to the idle condition.
Table 104. I2C Address for ADV7180
R/W
ALSB
Slave Address
0x40
0x41
0x42
0x43
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
To control the device on the bus, a specific protocol must be
followed. First, the master initiates a data transfer by establishing a
start condition, which is defined by a high-to-low transition on
SDATA while SCLK remains high. This indicates that an address/
data stream follows. All peripherals respond to the start condition
In auto-increment mode, if the user exceeds the highest
subaddress, the following action is taken:
In read mode, the highest subaddress register contents
continue to be output until the master device issues a
no acknowledge. This indicates the end of a read. A no
acknowledge condition occurs when the SDATA line is
not pulled low on the ninth pulse.
W
and shift the next eight bits (the 7-bit address plus the R/ bit).
The bits are transferred from MSB down to LSB. The peripheral
that recognizes the transmitted address responds by pulling the
data line low during the ninth clock pulse; this is known as an
acknowledge bit. All other devices withdraw from the bus at
this point and maintain an idle condition. The idle condition is
where the device monitors the SDATA and SCLK lines for the
In write mode, the data for the invalid byte is not loaded
into any subaddress register. A no acknowledge is issued by
the ADV7180, and the part returns to the idle condition.
W
start condition and the correct transmitted address. The R/
bit determines the direction of the data. Logic 0 on the LSB of
SDATA
SCLK
S
P
1–7
8
9
1–7
8
9
1–7
DATA
8
9
START ADDR R/W ACK SUBADDRESS ACK
ACK
STOP
Figure 51. Bus Data Transfer
WRITE
S
S
SLAVE ADDR A(S) SUB ADDR
LSB = 0
A(S)
DATA
A(S)
DATA
A(M)
A(S) P
SEQUENCE
LSB = 1
READ
SEQUENCE
SLAVE ADDR A(S) SUB ADDR
A(S)
S
SLAVE ADDR A(S)
DATA
DATA
A(M) P
S = START BIT
P = STOP BIT
A(S) = ACKNOWLEDGE BY SLAVE
A(M) = ACKNOWLEDGE BY MASTER
A(S) = NO ACKNOWLEDGE BY SLAVE
A(M) = NO ACKNOWLEDGE BY MASTER
Figure 52. Read and Write Sequence
Rev. G | Page 77 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Register Select (SR7 to SR0)
REGISTER ACCESS
These bits are set up to point to the required starting address.
I2C SEQUENCER
The MPU can write to or read from all of the ADV7180 registers
except the subaddress register, which is write only. The subaddress
register determines which register the next read or write operation
accesses. All communications with the part through the bus start
with an access to the subaddress register. A read/write operation is
then performed from or to the target address, which increments
to the next address until a stop command on the bus is performed.
An I2C sequencer is used when a parameter exceeds eight bits
and is therefore distributed over two or more I2C registers, for
example, HSB[10:0].
When such a parameter is changed using two or more I2C write
operations, the parameter may hold an invalid value for the
time between the first I2C being completed and the last I2C
being completed. In other words, the top bits of the parameter
may hold the new value while the remaining bits of the parameter
still hold the previous value.
To avoid this problem, the I2C sequencer holds the updated bits
of the parameter in local memory, and all bits of the parameter
are updated together once the last register write operation has
completed.
REGISTER PROGRAMMING
The following sections describe the configuration for each
register. The communication register is an 8-bit, write-only
register. After the part is accessed over the bus and a read/write
operation is selected, the subaddress is set up. The subaddress
register determines to or from which register the operation
takes place. Table 105 lists the various operations under the
control of the subaddress register for the control port.
SUB_USR_EN, Address 0x0E[5]
The correct operation of the I2C sequencer relies on the following:
This bit splits the register map at Register 0x40.
•
All I2C registers for the parameter in question must be
written to in order of ascending addresses. For example, for
HSB[10:0], write to Address 0x34 first, followed by 0x35,
and so on.
USER MAP
USER SUB MAP
2
COMMON I C SPACE
ADDRESS 0x00 ≥ 0x3F
•
No other I2C can take place between the two (or more) I2C
writes for the sequence. For example, for HSB[10:0], write to
Address 0x34 first, immediately followed by 0x35, and so on.
ADDRESS 0x0E BIT 5 = 0b
ADDRESS 0x0E BIT 5 = 1b
2
2
I C SPACE
I C SPACE
ADDRESS 0x40 ≥ 0xFF
ADDRESS 0x40 ≥ 0x9C
NORMAL REGISTER SPACE
INTERRUPT AND VDP REGISTER SPACE
Figure 53. Register Access—User Map and User Sub Map
Rev. E | Page 78 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
I2C REGISTER MAPS
Table 105. Main Register Map Details
Address
Reset
Dec Hex Register Name
RW 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Value
(Hex)
0
1
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
00 Input control
01 Video selection
03 Output control
RW VID_SEL[3]
RW
VID_SEL[2]
ENHSPLL
TOD
VID_SEL[1]
BETACAM
OF_SEL[3]
VID_SEL[0]
INSEL[3]
ENVSPROC
OF_SEL[1]
TIM_OE
INSEL[2]
SQPE
INSEL[1]
INSEL[0]
00000000 00
11001000 C8
00001100 0C
01xx0101 45
RW VBI_EN
OF_SEL[2]
OF_SEL[0]
BL_C_VBI
SD_DUP_AV
Range
04 Extended output control RW BT.656-4
05 Reserved
EN_SFL_PIN
06 Reserved
07 Autodetect enable
08 Contrast
RW AD_SEC525_EN AD_SECAM_EN AD_N443_EN AD_P60_EN
AD_PALN_EN
CON[3]
AD_PALM_EN
CON[2]
AD_NTSC_EN
CON[1]
AD_PAL_EN
CON[0]
01111111 7F
10000000 80
RW CON[7]
CON[6]
CON[5]
CON[4]
09 Reserved
10 0A Brightness
11 0B Hue
RW BRI[7]
BRI[6]
BRI[5]
BRI[4]
BRI[3]
BRI[2]
BRI[1]
BRI[0]
00000000 00
00000000 00
00110110 36
RW HUE[7]
RW DEF_Y[5]
HUE[6]
DEF_Y[4]
HUE[5]
DEF_Y[3]
HUE[4]
DEF_Y[2]
HUE[3]
DEF_Y[1]
HUE[2]
DEF_Y[0]
HUE[1]
HUE[0]
12 0C Default Value Y
DEF_VAL_
AUTO_EN
DEF_VAL_EN
13 0D Default Value C
14 0E ADI Control 1
RW DEF_C[7]
RW
DEF_C[6]
DEF_C[5]
DEF_C[4]
DEF_C[3]
DEF_C[2]
DEF_C[1]
DEF_C[0]
01111100 7C
00000000 00
00000000 00
SUB_USR_EN
PWRDWN
15 0F Power management
16 10 Status 1
RW Reset
PDBP
R
COL_KILL
IDENT[7]
AD_RESULT[2]
IDENT[6]
AD_RESULT[1] AD_RESULT[0] FOLLOW_PW
FSC_LOCK
IDENT[2]
LOST_LOCK
IDENT[1]
MVCS T3
GEMD
IN_LOCK
17 11 IDENT
R
IDENT[5]
IDENT[4]
LL NSTD
IDENT[3]
IDENT[0]
00011100 1C
18 12 Status 2
R
FSC NSTD
MV AGC DET
MV PS DET
SD_OP_50Hz
MVCS DET
INST_HLOCK
19 13 Status 3
R
PAL_SW_LOCK Interlaced
DCT[1]
STD FLD LEN FREE_RUN_ACT Reserved
CCLEN
20 14 Analog clamp control
21 15 Digital Clamp Control 1
22 16 Reserved
RW
RW
00010010 12
0000xxxx 00
DCT[0]
DCFE
23 17 Shaping Filter Control 1
24 18 Shaping Filter Control 2
25 19 Comb filter control
29 1D ADI Control 2
RW CSFM[2]
RW WYSFMOVR
RW
CSFM[1]
CSFM[0]
YSFM[4]
YSFM[3]
YSFM[2]
YSFM[1]
YSFM[0]
00000001 01
10010011 93
11110001 F1
01000xxx 40
01011000 58
11100001 E1
10101110 AE
11110100 F4
WYSFM[4]
WYSFM[3]
NSFSEL[1]
WYSFM[2]
NSFSEL[0]
WYSFM[1]
PSFSEL[1]
WYSFM[0]
PSFSEL[0]
RW TRI_LLC
RW SWPC
RW
EN28XTAL
39 27 Pixel delay control
43 2B Misc gain control
44 2C AGC mode control
45 2D Chroma Gain Control 1
45 2D Chroma Gain 1
46 2E Chroma Gain Control 2
46 2E Chroma Gain 2
47 2F Luma Gain Control 1
47 2F Luma Gain 1
AUTO_PDC_EN CTA[2]
CKE
CTA[1]
CTA[0]
LTA[1]
LTA[0]
PW_UPD
CAGC[0]
CMG[8]
CG[8]
RW
LAGC[2]
CAGT[0]
LAGC[1]
LAGC[0]
CAGC[1]
CMG[9]
CG[9]
W
R
CAGT[1]
CMG[11]
CG[11]
CMG[3]
CG[3]
CMG[10]
CG[10]
CMG[2]
CG[2]
W
R
CMG[7]
CG[7]
CMG[6]
CG[6]
CMG[5]
CG[5]
CMG[4]
CG[4]
CMG[1]
CG[1]
CMG[0]
CG[0]
00000000 00
1111xxxx F0
xxxxxxxx 00
W
R
LAGT[1]
LAGT[0]
LMG[11]
LG[11]
LMG[3]
LG[3]
LMG[10]
LG[10]
LMG[2]
LG[2]
LMG[9]
LG[9]
LMG[8]
LG[8]
48 30 Luma Gain Control 2
48 30 Luma Gain 2
W
R
LMG[7]
LG[7]
LMG[6]
LG[6]
LMG[5]
LG[5]
LMG[4]
LG[4]
LMG[1]
LG[1]
LMG[0]
LG[0]
49 31 VS/FIELD Control 1
50 32 VS/FIELD Control 2
51 33 VS/FIELD Control 3
52 34 HS Position Control 1
53 35 HS Position Control 2
54 36 HS Position Control 3
55 37 Polarity
RW
NEWAVMODE HVSTIM
00010010 12
01000001 41
10000100 84
00000000 00
00000010 02
00000000 00
00000001 01
10000000 80
11000000 C0
RW VSBHO
RW VSEHO
RW
VSBHE
VSEHE
HSB[10]
HSB[6]
HSE[6]
HSB[9]
HSB[5]
HSE[5]
PVS
HSB[8]
HSE[10]
HSB[2]
HSE[2]
HSE[9]
HSB[1]
HSE[1]
HSE[8]
HSB[0]
HSE[0]
PCLK
RW HSB[7]
RW HSE[7]
RW PHS
HSB[4]
HSE[4]
HSB[3]
HSE[3]
PF
56 38 NTSC comb control
57 39 PAL comb control
58 3A ADC control
RW CTAPSN[1]
RW CTAPSP[1]
RW
CTAPSN[0]
CTAPSP[0]
CCMN[2]
CCMP[2]
CCMN[1]
CCMP[1]
CCMN[0]
CCMP[0]
YCMN[2]
YCMP[2]
YCMN[1]
YCMP[1]
YCMN[0]
YCMP[0]
PWRDWN_MUX_0 PWRDWN_MUX_1
PWRDWN_MUX_2 MUX PDN override 00010000 10
61 3D Manual window control RW
CKILLTHR[2]
SFL_INV
CKILLTHR[1]
CKILLTHR[0]
01110010 B2
00000001 01
65 41 Resample control
72 48 Gemstar Control 1
73 49 Gemstar Control 2
74 4A Gemstar Control 3
75 4B Gemstar Control 4
76 4C Gemstar Control 5
77 4D CTI DNR Control 1
78 4E CTI DNR Control 2
80 50 CTI DNR Control 4
81 51 Lock count
RW
RW GDECEL[15]
RW GDECEL[7]
RW GDECOL[15]
RW GDECOL[7]
RW
GDECEL[14]
GDECEL[6]
GDECOL[14]
GDECOL[6]
GDECEL[13]
GDECEL[5]
GDECEL[12]
GDECEL[4]
GDECEL[11]
GDECEL[3]
GDECEL[10]
GDECEL[2]
GDECOL[10]
GDECOL[2]
GDECEL[9]
GDECEL[1]
GDECOL[9]
GDECOL[1]
GDECEL[8]
GDECEL[0]
GDECOL[8]
GDECOL[0]
GDECAD
00000000 00
00000000 00
00000000 00
00000000 00
xxxx0000 00
11101111 EF
00001000 08
00001000 08
00100100 24
00000000 00
GDECOL[13] GDECOL[12]
GDECOL[11]
GDECOL[3]
GDE_SEL_OLD_ADF
CTI_AB[1]
GDECOL[5]
GDECOL[4]
RW
DNR_EN
CTI_AB[0]
CTI_AB_EN
CTI_C_TH[1]
DNR_TH[1]
CIL[1]
CTI_EN
RW CTI_C_TH[7]
RW DNR_TH[7]
RW FSCLE
RW
CTI_C_TH[6]
DNR_TH[6]
SRLS
CTI_C_TH[5]
DNR_TH[5]
COL[2]
CTI_C_TH[4]
DNR_TH[4]
COL[1]
CTI_C_TH[3]
DNR_TH[3]
COL[0]
CTI_C_TH[2]
DNR_TH[2]
CIL[2]
CTI_C_TH[0]
DNR_TH[0]
CIL[0]
88 58 VS/FIELD pin control1
ADC sampling control
VS/FIELD
89 59 General-purpose outputs2 RW
GPO_ENABLE
GPO[3]
GPO[2]
GPO[1]
GPO[0]
00000000 00
00000000 00
143 8F Free-Run Line Length 1
W
LLC_PAD_SEL[2] LLC_PAD_
SEL[1]
LLC_PAD_
SEL[0]
153 99 CCAP 1
154 9A CCAP 2
R
R
CCAP1[7]
CCAP2[7]
CCAP1[6]
CCAP2[6]
CCAP1[5]
CCAP2[5]
CCAP1[4]
CCAP2[4]
CCAP1[3]
CCAP2[3]
CCAP1[2]
CCAP2[2]
CCAP1[1]
CCAP2[1]
CCAP1[0]
CCAP2[0]
Rev. E | Page 79 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Address
Reset
Dec Hex Register Name
155 9B Letterbox 1
RW 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Value
(Hex)
R
LB_LCT[7]
LB_LCT[6]
LB_LCM[6]
LB_LCB[6]
LB_LCT[5]
LB_LCM[5]
LB_LCB[5]
LB_LCT[4]
LB_LCM[4]
LB_LCB[4]
LB_LCT[3]
LB_LCM[3]
LB_LCB[3]
LB_LCT[2]
LB_LCM[2]
LB_LCB[2]
CRC_ENABLE
MUX0[2]
LB_LCT[1]
LB_LCM[1]
LB_LCB[1]
LB_LCT[0]
LB_LCM[0]
LB_LCB[0]
156 9C Letterbox 2
R
LB_LCM[7]
LB_LCB[7]
157 9D Letterbox 3
R
178 B2 CRC enable
W
00011100 1C
xxxxxxxx 00
0xxxxxxx 00
10101100 AC
01001100 4C
195 C3 ADC Switch 1
196 C4 ADC Switch 2
220 DC Letterbox Control 1
221 DD Letterbox Control 2
222 DE ST Noise Readback 1
223 DF ST Noise Readback 2
224 E0 Reserved
RW Reserved
MUX1[2]
MUX1[1]
MUX1[0]
Reserved
MUX0[1]
MUX0[0]
RW MAN_MUX_EN
Reserved
MUX2[2]
MUX2[1]
MUX2[0]
RW
LB_TH[4]
LB_SL[0]
LB_TH[3]
LB_TH[2]
LB_EL[2]
LB_TH[1]
LB_TH[0]
RW LB_SL[3]
R
LB_SL[2]
LB_SL[1]
LB_EL[3]
LB_EL[1]
LB_EL[0]
ST_NOISE_VLD
ST_NOISE[3]
ST_NOISE[10]
ST_NOISE[2]
ST_NOISE[9]
ST_NOISE[1]
ST_NOISE[8]
ST_NOISE[0]
R
ST_NOISE[7]
ST_NOISE[6]
ST_NOISE[5]
ST_NOISE[4]
225 E1 SD Offset Cb
226 E2 SD Offset Cr
RW SD_OFF_Cb[7] SD_OFF_Cb[6] SD_OFF_Cb[5] SD_OFF_Cb[4] SD_OFF_Cb[3]
SD_OFF_Cb[2]
SD_OFF_Cr[2]
SD_SAT_Cb[2]
SD_SAT_Cr[2]
NVBEG[2]
SD_OFF_Cb[1]
SD_OFF_Cr[1]
SD_SAT_Cb[1]
SD_SAT_Cr[1]
NVBEG[1]
SD_OFF_Cb[0]
SD_OFF_Cr[0]
SD_SAT_Cb[0]
SD_SAT_Cr[0]
NVBEG[0]
10000000 80
10000000 80
10000000 80
10000000 80
00100101 25
00000100 04
01100011 63
01100101 65
00010100 14
01100011 63
01010101 55
01010101 55
00000000 00
RW SD_OFF_Cr[7] SD_OFF_Cr[6]
RW SD_SAT_Cb[7] SD_SAT_Cb[6]
RW SD_SAT_Cr[7] SD_SAT_Cr[6]
SD_OFF_Cr[5] SD_OFF_Cr[4] SD_OFF_Cr[3]
SD_SAT_Cb[5] SD_SAT_Cb[4] SD_SAT_Cb[3]
SD_SAT_Cr[5] SD_SAT_Cr[4] SD_SAT_Cr[3]
227 E3 SD Saturation Cb
228 E4 SD Saturation Cr
229 E5 NTSC V bit begin
230 E6 NTSC V bit end
231 E7 NTSC F bit toggle
232 E8 PAL V bit begin
233 E9 PAL V bit end
234 EA PAL F bit toggle
235 EB Vblank Control 1
236 EC Vblank Control 2
243 F3 AFE_CONTROL 1
RW NVBEGDELO
RW NVENDDELO
RW NFTOGDELO
RW PVBEGDELO
RW PVENDDELO
RW PFTOGDELO
RW NVBIOLCM[1]
NVBEGDELE
NVENDDELE
NFTOGDELE
PVBEGDELE
PVENDDELE
PFTOGDELE
NVBIOLCM[0]
NVBEGSIGN
NVENDSIGN
NFTOGSIGN
PVBEGSIGN
PVENDSIGN
PFTOGSIGN
NVBEG[4]
NVEND[4]
NFTOG[4]
PVBEG[4]
PVEND[4]
PFTOG[4]
NVBEG[3]
NVEND[3]
NFTOG[3]
PVBEG[3]
NVEND[2]
NVEND[1]
NVEND[0]
NFTOG[2]
NFTOG[1]
NFTOG[0]
PVBEG[2]
PVBEG[1]
PVBEG[0]
PVEND[3]
PFTOG[3]
PVEND[2]
PVEND[1]
PVEND[0]
PFTOG[2]
PFTOG[1]
PFTOG[0]
NVBIELCM[1] NVBIELCM[0]
NVBIECCM[1] NVBIECCM[0]
PVBIOLCM[1]
PVBIOCCM[1]
PVBIOLCM[0]
PVBIOCCM[0]
AA_FILT_EN[2]
PVBIELCM[1]
PVBIECCM[1]
AA_FILT_EN[1]
PVBIELCM[0]
PVBIECCM[0]
AA_FILT_EN[0]
RW NVBIOCCM[1] NVBIOCCM[0]
RW
AA_FILT_
MAN_OVR
244 F4 Drive strength
248 F8 IF comp control
249 F9 VS mode control
RW
RW
RW
DR_STR[1]
DR_STR[0]
DR_STR_C[1]
DR_STR_C[0]
IFFILTSEL[2]
DR_STR_S[1]
IFFILTSEL[1]
DR_STR_S[0]
IFFILTSEL[0]
xx010101 15
00000000 00
00000011 03
VS_COAST_
MODE[1]
VS_COAST_
MODE[0]
EXTEND_VS_
MIN_FREQ
EXTEND_VS_
MAX_FREQ
251 FB Peaking control
252 FC Coring threshold
RW PEAKING_
GAIN[7]
PEAKING_
GAIN[6]
PEAKING_
GAIN[5]
PEAKING_
GAIN[4]
PEAKING_
GAIN[3]
PEAKING_
GAIN[2]
PEAKING_
GAIN[1]
PEAKING_
GAIN[0]
01000000 40
00000100 04
RW DNR_TH2[7]
DNR_TH2[6]
DNR_TH2[5]
DNR_TH2[4]
DNR_TH2[3]
DNR_TH2[2]
DNR_TH2[1]
DNR_TH2[0]
1 This feature applies to the 48-lead, 40-lead, and 32-lead LFCSP only because VS or FIELD is shared on a single pin.
2 This feature applies to the 64-lead and 48-lead LQFP only.
Rev. E | Page 80 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Table 106. Interrupt System Register Map Details1, 2
Address
Dec
Hex
Register Name
RW
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset Value (Hex)
64
40
Interrupt
Configuration 1
RW
INTRQ_DUR_
SEL[1]
INTRQ_DUR_
SEL[0]
MV_INTRQ_
SEL[1]
MV_INTRQ_
SEL[0]
MPU_STIM_
INTRQ
INTRQ_OP_
SEL[1]
INTRQ_OP_SEL[0] 0001x000
10
66
67
42
43
Interrupt Status 1
Interrupt Clear 1
R
MV_PS_CS_Q
SD_FR_CHNG_Q
SD_UNLOCK_Q SD_LOCK_Q
W
MV_PS_CS_CLR SD_FR_CHNG_
CLR
SD_UNLOCK_
CLR
SD_LOCK_CLR
x0000000
00
00
68
69
70
71
72
44
45
46
47
48
Interrupt Mask 1
Raw Status 1
RW
R
MV_PS_CS_
MSKB
SD_FR_CHNG_
MSKB
SD_UNLOCK_
MSKB
SD_LOCK_MSKB x0000000
CCAPD
MPU_STIM_
INTRQ
EVEN_FIELD
Interrupt Status 2
Interrupt Clear 2
Interrupt Mask 2
R
MPU_STIM_
INTRQ_Q
SD_FIELD_
CHNGD_Q
GEMD_Q
CCAPD_Q
W
RW
MPU_STIM_
INTRQ_CLR
SD_FIELD_
CHNGD_CLR
GEMD_CLR
GEMD_MSKB
SD_V_LOCK
CCAPD_CLR
0xx00000
0xx00000
00
00
MPU_STIM_
INTRQ_MSKB
SD_FIELD_
CHNGD_MSKB
CCAPD_MSKB
73
74
49
4A
Raw Status 2
R
R
SCM_LOCK
SD_H_LOCK
SD_OP_50Hz
Interrupt Status 3
PAL_SW_LK_
CHNG_Q
SCM_LOCK_
CHNG_Q
SD_AD_CHNG_Q SD_H_LOCK_
CHNG_Q
SD_V_LOCK_
CHNG_Q
SD_OP_CHNG_Q
75
76
78
4B
4C
4E
Interrupt Clear 3
Interrupt Mask 3
Interrupt Status 4
W
RW
R
PAL_SW_LK_
CHNG_CLR
SCM_LOCK_
CHNG_CLR
SD_AD_CHNG_ SD_H_LOCK_
SD_V_LOCK_
CHNG_CLR
SD_OP_CHNG_ xx000000
CLR
00
00
CLR
CHNG_CLR
PAL_SW_LK_
CHNG_MSKB
SCM_LOCK_
CHNG_MSKB
SD_AD_CHNG_ SD_H_LOCK_
SD_V_LOCK_
CHNG_MSKB
SD_OP_CHNG_ xx000000
MSKB
MSKB
CHNG_MSKB
VDP_VITC_Q
VDP_GS_VPS_
PDC_UTC_
CHNG_Q
VDP_CGMS_
WSS_CHNGD_Q
VDP_CCAPD_Q
79
80
96
97
4F
50
60
61
Interrupt Clear 4
Interrupt Mask 4
VDP_Config_1
VDP_Config_2
W
VDP_VITC_CLR
VDP_VITC_MSKB
VDP_GS_VPS_
PDC_UTC_
CHNG_CLR
VDP_CGMS_
WSS_CHNGD_
CLR
VDP_CCAPD_CLR 00x0x0x0
00
00
88
10
RW
RW
RW
VDP_GS_VPS_
PDC_UTC_
CHNG_MSKB
VDP_CGMS_
WSS_CHNGD_
MSKB
VDP_CCAPD_
MSKB
00x0x0x0
10001000
0001xx00
WST_PKT_
DECODE_
DISABLE
VDP_TTXT_
TYPE_MAN_
ENABLE
VDP_TTXT_
TYPE_MAN[1]
VDP_TTXT_
TYPE_MAN[0]
AUTO_DETECT_
GS_TYPE
98
62
63
64
VDP_ADF_Config_1 RW
VDP_ADF_Config_2 RW
ADF_ENABLE
ADF_MODE[1]
ADF_MODE[0]
ADF_SDID[5]
ADF_DID[4]
ADF_SDID[4]
ADF_DID[3]
ADF_SDID[3]
ADF_DID[2]
ADF_SDID[2]
ADF_DID[1]
ADF_SDID[1]
ADF_DID[0]
ADF_SDID[0]
00010101
0x101010
0xxx0000
15
2A
00
99
DUPLICATE_ADF
MAN_LINE_PGM
100
VDP_LINE_00E
VDP_LINE_00F
VDP_LINE_010
VDP_LINE_011
VDP_LINE_012
VDP_LINE_013
VDP_LINE_014
VDP_LINE_015
VDP_LINE_016
VDP_LINE_017
VDP_LINE_018
VDP_LINE_019
VDP_LINE_01A
VDP_LINE_01B
VDP_LINE_01C
VDP_LINE_01D
VDP_LINE_01E
VDP_LINE_01F
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
VBI_DATA_
P318[3]
VBI_DATA_
P318[2]
VBI_DATA_
P318[1]
VBI_DATA_
P318[0]
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
65
66
67
68
69
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
70
71
72
73
74
75
VBI_DATA_
P6_N23[3]
VBI_DATA_
P6_N23[2]
VBI_DATA_
P6_N23[1]
VBI_DATA_
P6_N23[0]
VBI_DATA_
P319_N286[3]
VBI_DATA_
P319_N286[2]
VBI_DATA_
P319_N286[1]
VBI_DATA_
P319_N286[0]
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
VBI_DATA_
P7_N24[3]
VBI_DATA_
P7_N24[2]
VBI_DATA_
P7_N24[1]
VBI_DATA_
P7_N24[0]
VBI_DATA_
P320_N287[3]
VBI_DATA_
P320_N287[2]
VBI_DATA_
P320_N287[1]
VBI_DATA_
P320_N287[0]
VBI_DATA_
P8_N25[3]
VBI_DATA_
P8_N25[2]
VBI_DATA_
P8_N25[1]
VBI_DATA_
P8_N25[0]
VBI_DATA_
P321_N288[3]
VBI_DATA_
P321_N288[2]
VBI_DATA_
P321_N288[1]
VBI_DATA_
P321_N288[0]
VBI_DATA_
P9[3]
VBI_DATA_
P9[2]
VBI_DATA_
P9[1]
VBI_DATA_
P9[0]
VBI_DATA_
P322[3]
VBI_DATA_
P322[2]
VBI_DATA_
P322[1]
VBI_DATA_
P322[0]
VBI_DATA_
P10[3]
VBI_DATA_
P10[2]
VBI_DATA_
P10[1]
VBI_DATA_
P10[0]
VBI_DATA_
P323[3]
VBI_DATA_
P323[2]
VBI_DATA_
P323[1]
VBI_DATA_
P323[0]
VBI_DATA_
P11[3]
VBI_DATA_
P11[2]
VBI_DATA_
P11[1]
VBI_DATA_
P11[0]
VBI_DATA_
P324_N272[3]
VBI_DATA_
P324_N272[2]
VBI_DATA_
P324_N272[1]
VBI_DATA_
P324_N272[0]
VBI_DATA_
P12_N10[3]
VBI_DATA_
P12_N10[2]
VBI_DATA_
P12_N10[1]
VBI_DATA_
P12_N10[0]
VBI_DATA_
P325_N273[3]
VBI_DATA_
P325_N273[2]
VBI_DATA_
P325_N273[1]
VBI_DATA_
P325_N273[0]
VBI_DATA_
P13_N11[3]
VBI_DATA_
P13_N11[2]
VBI_DATA_
P13_N11[1]
VBI_DATA_
P13_N11[0]
VBI_DATA_
P326_N274[3]
VBI_DATA_
P326_N274[2]
VBI_DATA_
P326_N274[1]
VBI_DATA_
P326_N274[0]
VBI_DATA_
P14_N12[3]
VBI_DATA_
P14_N12[2]
VBI_DATA_
P14_N12[1]
VBI_DATA_
P14_N12[0]
VBI_DATA_
P327_N275[3]
VBI_DATA_
P327_N275[2]
VBI_DATA_
P327_N275[1]
VBI_DATA_
P327_N275[0]
VBI_DATA_
P15_N13[3]
VBI_DATA_
P15_N13[2]
VBI_DATA_
P15_N13[1]
VBI_DATA_
P15_N13[0]
VBI_DATA_
P328_N276[3]
VBI_DATA_
P328_N276[2]
VBI_DATA_
P328_N276[1]
VBI_DATA_
P328_N276[0]
VBI_DATA_
P16_N14[3]
VBI_DATA_
P16_N14[2]
VBI_DATA_
P16_N14[1]
VBI_DATA_
P16_N14[0]
VBI_DATA_
P329_N277[3]
VBI_DATA_
P329_N277[2]
VBI_DATA_
P329_N277[1]
VBI_DATA_
P329_N277[0]
VBI_DATA_
P17_N15[3]
VBI_DATA_
P17_N15[2]
VBI_DATA_
P17_N15[1]
VBI_DATA_
P17_N15[0]
VBI_DATA_
P330_N278[3]
VBI_DATA_
P330_N278[2]
VBI_DATA_
P330_N278[1]
VBI_DATA_
P330_N278[0]
VBI_DATA_
P18_N16[3]
VBI_DATA_
P18_N16[2]
VBI_DATA_
P18_N16[1]
VBI_DATA_
P18_N16[0]
VBI_DATA_
P331_N279[3]
VBI_DATA_
P331_N279[2]
VBI_DATA_
P331_N279[1]
VBI_DATA_
P331_N279[0]
VBI_DATA_
P19_N17[3]
VBI_DATA_
P19_N17[2]
VBI_DATA_
P19_N17[1]
VBI_DATA_
P19_N17[0]
VBI_DATA_
P332_N280[3]
VBI_DATA_
P332_N280[2]
VBI_DATA_
P332_N280[1]
VBI_DATA_
P332_N280[0]
VBI_DATA_
P20_N18[3]
VBI_DATA_
P20_N18[2]
VBI_DATA_
P20_N18[1]
VBI_DATA_
P20_N18[0]
VBI_DATA_
P333_N281[3]
VBI_DATA_
P333_N281[2]
VBI_DATA_
P333_N281[1]
VBI_DATA_
P333_N281[0]
VBI_DATA_
P21_N19[3]
VBI_DATA_
P21_N19[2]
VBI_DATA_
P21_N19[1]
VBI_DATA_
P21_N19[0]
VBI_DATA_
P334_N282[3]
VBI_DATA_
P334_N282[2]
VBI_DATA_
P334_N282[1]
VBI_DATA_
P334_N282[0]
VBI_DATA_
P22_N20[3]
VBI_DATA_
P22_N20[2]
VBI_DATA_
P22_N20[1]
VBI_DATA_
P22_N20[0]
VBI_DATA_
P335_N283[3]
VBI_DATA_
P335_N283[2]
VBI_DATA_
P335_N283[1]
VBI_DATA_
P335_N283[0]
Rev. G | Page 81 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Address
Dec
Hex
Register Name
RW
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset Value (Hex)
118
76
VDP_LINE_020
RW
VBI_DATA_
P23_N21[3]
VBI_DATA_
P23_N21[2]
VBI_DATA_
P23_N21[1]
VBI_DATA_
P23_N21[0]
VBI_DATA_
P336_N284[3]
VBI_DATA_
P336_N284[2]
VBI_DATA_
P336_N284[1]
VBI_DATA_
P336_N284[0]
00000000
00
119
120
120
121
122
125
126
127
132
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
77
78
78
79
7A
7D
7E
7F
84
85
86
87
88
89
8A
8B
8C
8D
8E
8F
90
VDP_LINE_021
VDP_STATUS
RW
R
W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
VBI_DATA_
P24_N22[3]
VBI_DATA_
P24_N22[2]
VBI_DATA_
P24_N22[1]
VBI_DATA_
P24_N22[0]
VBI_DATA_
P337_N285[3]
VBI_DATA_
P337_N285[2]
VBI_DATA_
P337_N285[1]
VBI_DATA_
P337_N285[0]
00000000
00
TTXT_AVL
VITC_AVL
GS_DATA_
TYPE
GS_PDC_VPS_
UTC_AVL
CGMS_WSS_AVL CC_EVEN_FIELD CC_AVL
VDP_STATUS_
CLEAR
VITC_CLEAR
GS_PDC_VPS_
UTC_CLEAR
CGMS_WSS_
CLEAR
CC_CLEAR
00000000
00
VDP_CCAP_
DATA_0
CCAP_BYTE_1[7] CCAP_BYTE_1[6] CCAP_BYTE_1[5] CCAP_BYTE_1[4] CCAP_BYTE_1[3] CCAP_BYTE_1[2] CCAP_BYTE_1[1] CCAP_BYTE_1[0]
CCAP_BYTE_2[7] CCAP_BYTE_2[6] CCAP_BYTE_2[5] CCAP_BYTE_2[4] CCAP_BYTE_2[3] CCAP_BYTE_2[2] CCAP_BYTE_2[1] CCAP_BYTE_2[0]
VDP_CCAP_
DATA_1
VDP_CGMS_
WSS_DATA_0
CGMS_CRC[5]
CGMS_CRC[4]
CGMS_CRC[3]
CGMS_CRC[2]
CGMS_WSS[8]
CGMS_WSS[0]
GS_VPS_PDC_
VDP_CGMS_
WSS_DATA_1
CGMS_CRC[1]
CGMS_WSS[7]
GS_VPS_PDC_
CGMS_CRC[0]
CGMS_WSS[6]
GS_VPS_PDC_
CGMS_WSS[13] CGMS_WSS[12] CGMS_WSS[11] CGMS_WSS[10] CGMS_WSS[9]
VDP_CGMS_
WSS_DATA_2
CGMS_WSS[5]
GS_VPS_PDC_
CGMS_WSS[4]
GS_VPS_PDC_
CGMS_WSS[3]
GS_VPS_PDC_
CGMS_WSS[2]
GS_VPS_PDC_
CGMS_WSS[1]
GS_VPS_PDC_
VDP_GS_VPS_
PDC_UTC_0
UTC_BYTE_0[7] UTC_BYTE_0[6] UTC_BYTE_0[5] UTC_BYTE_0[4] UTC_BYTE_0[3] UTC_BYTE_0[2] UTC_BYTE_0[1] UTC_BYTE_0[0]
GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_
UTC_BYTE_1[7] UTC_BYTE_1[6] UTC_BYTE_1[5] UTC_BYTE_1[4] UTC_BYTE_1[3] UTC_BYTE_1[2] UTC_BYTE_1[1] UTC_BYTE_1[0]
GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_
UTC_BYTE_2[7] UTC_BYTE_2[6] UTC_BYTE_2[5] UTC_BYTE_2[4] UTC_BYTE_2[3] UTC_BYTE_2[2] UTC_BYTE_2[1] UTC_BYTE_2[0]
GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_ GS_VPS_PDC_
VDP_GS_VPS_
PDC_UTC_1
VDP_GS_VPS_
PDC_UTC_2
VDP_GS_VPS_
PDC_UTC_3
UTC_BYTE_3[7] UTC_BYTE_3[6] UTC_BYTE_3[5] UTC_BYTE_3[4] UTC_BYTE_3[3] UTC_BYTE_3[2] UTC_BYTE_3[1] UTC_BYTE_3[0]
VDP_VPS_
PDC_UTC_4
VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_
BYTE_4[7]
VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_
BYTE_5[7] BYTE_5[6] BYTE_5[5] BYTE_5[4] BYTE_5[3] BYTE_5[2] BYTE_5[1] BYTE_5[0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_
BYTE_6[7] BYTE_6[6] BYTE_6[5] BYTE_6[4] BYTE_6[3] BYTE_6[2] BYTE_6[1] BYTE_6[0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_
BYTE_7[7] BYTE_7[6] BYTE_7[5] BYTE_7[4] BYTE_7[3] BYTE_7[2] BYTE_7[1] BYTE_7[0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_
BYTE_8[7] BYTE_8[6] BYTE_8[5] BYTE_8[4] BYTE_8[3] BYTE_8[2] BYTE_8[1] BYTE_8[0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_
BYTE_9[7] BYTE_9[6] BYTE_9[5] BYTE_9[4] BYTE_9[3] BYTE_9[2] BYTE_9[1] BYTE_9[0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_
BYTE_10[7] BYTE_10[6] BYTE_10[5] BYTE_10[4] BYTE_10[3] BYTE_10[2] BYTE_10[1] BYTE_10[0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_
BYTE_11[7] BYTE_11[6] BYTE_11[5] BYTE_11[4] BYTE_11[3] BYTE_11[2] BYTE_11[1] BYTE_11[0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_ VPS_PDC_UTC_
BYTE_12[7] BYTE_12[6] BYTE_12[5] BYTE_12[4] BYTE_12[3] BYTE_12[2] BYTE_12[1] BYTE_12[0]
BYTE_4[6]
BYTE_4[5]
BYTE_4[4]
BYTE_4[3]
BYTE_4[2]
BYTE_4[1]
BYTE_4[0]
VDP_VPS_
PDC_UTC_5
VDP_VPS_
PDC_UTC_6
VDP_VPS_PDC_
UTC_7
VDP_VPS_PDC_
UTC_8
VDP_VPS_PDC_
UTC_9
VDP_VPS_PDC_
UTC_10
VDP_VPS_PDC_
UTC_11
VDP_VPS_PDC_
UTC_12
146
147
148
149
150
151
152
153
154
155
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
9A
9B
VDP_VITC_DATA_0 R
VDP_VITC_DATA_1 R
VDP_VITC_DATA_2 R
VDP_VITC_DATA_3 R
VDP_VITC_DATA_4 R
VDP_VITC_DATA_5 R
VDP_VITC_DATA_6 R
VDP_VITC_DATA_7 R
VDP_VITC_DATA_8 R
VITC_DATA_0[7] VITC_DATA_0[6] VITC_DATA_0[5] VITC_DATA_0[4] VITC_DATA_0[3] VITC_DATA_0[2] VITC_DATA_0[1] VITC_DATA_0[0]
VITC_DATA_1[7] VITC_DATA_1[6] VITC_DATA_1[5] VITC_DATA_1[4] VITC_DATA_1[3] VITC_DATA_1[2] VITC_DATA_1[1] VITC_DATA_1[0]
VITC_DATA_2[7] VITC_DATA_2[6] VITC_DATA_2[5] VITC_DATA_2[4] VITC_DATA_2[3] VITC_DATA_2[2] VITC_DATA_2[1] VITC_DATA_2[0]
VITC_DATA_3[7] VITC_DATA_3[6] VITC_DATA_3[5] VITC_DATA_3[4] VITC_DATA_3[3] VITC_DATA_3[2] VITC_DATA_3[1] VITC_DATA_3[0]
VITC_DATA_4[7] VITC_DATA_4[6] VITC_DATA_4[5] VITC_DATA_4[4] VITC_DATA_4[3] VITC_DATA_4[2] VITC_DATA_4[1] VITC_DATA_4[0]
VITC_DATA_5[7] VITC_DATA_5[6] VITC_DATA_5[5] VITC_DATA_5[4] VITC_DATA_5[3] VITC_DATA_5[2] VITC_DATA_5[1] VITC_DATA_5[0]
VITC_DATA_6[7] VITC_DATA_6[6] VITC_DATA_6[5] VITC_DATA_6[4] VITC_DATA_6[3] VITC_DATA_6[2] VITC_DATA_6[1] VITC_DATA_6[0]
VITC_DATA_7[7] VITC_DATA_7[6] VITC_DATA_7[5] VITC_DATA_7[4] VITC_DATA_7[3] VITC_DATA_7[2] VITC_DATA_7[1] VITC_DATA_7[0]
VITC_DATA_8[7] VITC_DATA_8[6] VITC_DATA_8[5] VITC_DATA_8[4] VITC_DATA_8[3] VITC_DATA_8[2] VITC_DATA_8[1] VITC_DATA_8[0]
VDP_VITC_CALC_
CRC
R
VITC_CRC[7]
VITC_CRC[6]
VITC_CRC[5]
VITC_CRC[4]
VITC_CRC[3]
VITC_CRC[2]
VITC_CRC[1]
VITC_CRC[0]
156
9C
VDP_OUTPUT_SEL RW
I2C_GS_VPS_
PDC_UTC[1]
I2C_GS_VPS_
PDC_UTC[0]
GS_VPS_
PDC_UTC_
CB_CHANGE
WSS_CGMS_
CB_CHANGE
00110000
30
1 To access the registers listed in Table 106, SUB_USR_EN in Register Address 0x0E must be programmed to 1.
2 x in a reset value indicates do not care.
Rev. G | Page 82 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Table 107. Register Map Descriptions (Normal Operation)1, 2
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Bit Description
7
6
5
4
3
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Comments
Notes
0x00
Input control
INSEL[3:0]; the INSEL bits
allow the user to select
an input channel and
the input format; refer
to Table 13 and Table 14
for full routing details
Composite (LQFP and LFCSP)
Composite (LQFP)/reserved (LFCSP)
Composite (LQFP)/reserved (LFCSP)
Composite (LQFP and LFCSP)
Composite (LQFP and LFCSP)
Composite (LQFP)/reserved (LFCSP)
S-Video (LQFP and LFCSP)
Mandatory write
required for Y/C
(S-Video mode)
Reg 0x58 = 0x04;
see Reg 0x58 for
bit description
S-Video (LQFP)/reserved (LFCSP)
S-Video (LQFP)/reserved (LFCSP)
YPrPb (LQFP and LFCSP)
YPrPb (LQFP)/reserved (LFCSP)
Reserved (LQFP and LFCSP)
Reserved (LQFP and LFCSP)
Reserved (LQFP and LFCSP)
Reserved (LQFP and LFCSP)
Reserved (LQFP and LFCSP)
VID_SEL[3:0]; the VID_SEL
bits allow the user to
select the input video
standard
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Autodetect PAL B/G/H/I/D,NTSC J
(no pedestal), SECAM
Autodetect PAL B/G/H/I/D, NTSC M
(pedestal), SECAM
Autodetect (PAL N) (pedestal), NTSC J
(no pedestal), SECAM
Autodetect (PAL N) (pedestal), NTSC M
(pedestal), SECAM
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
NTSC J
NTSC M
PAL 60
NTSC 4.43
PAL B/G/H/I/D
PAL N = PAL B/G/H/I/D (with pedestal)
PAL M (without pedestal)
PAL M
PAL Combination N
PAL Combination N (with pedestal)
SECAM
SECAM (with pedestal)
Rev. G | Page 83 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Video selection
Bit Description
Reserved
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Comments
Notes
0x01
0
0
Set to default
SQPE
0
1
Disable square pixel mode
Enable square pixel mode
Disable VSYNC processor
Enable VSYNC processor
Set to default
ENVSPROC
0
1
Reserved
BETACAM
0
0
1
Standard video input
Betacam input enable
Disable HSYNC processor
Enable HSYNC processor
Set to default
ENHSPLL
0
1
Reserved
1
0x03
Output control
SD_DUP_AV; duplicates
the AV codes from the
luma into the chroma path
0
1
AV codes to suit 8-bit interleaved data
output
AV codes duplicated (for 16-bit interfaces)
Set as default
Reserved
0
OF_SEL[3:0]; allows the
user to choose from a set
of output formats
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
Reserved
Reserved
16-bit at LLC 4:2:2
Options apply to
64-lead LQFP only
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
8-bit at LLC 4:2:2 ITU-R BT.656
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
TOD; three-state output
drivers; this bit allows the
user to three-state the
output drivers; pixel
outputs, HS, VS, FIELD,
and SFL
0
1
Output pins enabled
See also TIM_OE
and TRI_LLC
Drivers three-stated
VBI_EN; allows VBI data
(Line 1 to Line 21) to be
passed through with
only a minimum amount
of filtering performed
0
1
All lines filtered and scaled
Only active video region filtered
0x04
Extended
output control
Range; allows the user
to select the range of
output values; can be
ITU-R BT.656 compliant or
can fill the whole accessible
number range
0
1
16 ≤ Y ≤ 235, 16 ≤ C/P ≤ 240
1 ≤ Y ≤ 254, 1 ≤ C/P ≤ 254
ITU-R BT.656
Extended range
EN_SFL_PIN
0
1
SFL output is disabled
SFL output
enables encoder
and decoder to be
connected directly
SFL information output on the SFL pin
BL_C_VBI; blank chroma
during VBI; if set, it enables
data in the VBI region
to be passed through the
decoder undistorted
0
1
Decode and output color
Blank Cr and Cb
During VBI
TIM_OE; timing signals
output enable
0
1
HS, VS, FIELD three-stated
HS, VS, FIELD forced active
Controlled by TOD
Rev. G | Page 84 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Bit Description
Reserved
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Comments
Notes
x
x
Reserved
1
BT.656-4; allows the
user to select an output
mode compatible with
ITU-R BT.656-3/-4
0
1
ITU-R BT.656-3 compatible
ITU-R BT.656-4 compatible
0x07
Autodetect
enable
AD_PAL_EN; PAL B/D/I/G/H
autodetect enable
0
1
Disable
Enable
Disable
AD_NTSC_EN; NTSC
autodetect enable
0
1
Enable
Disable
AD_PALM_EN; PAL M
autodetect enable
0
1
Enable
Disable
AD_PALN_EN; PAL N
autodetect enable
0
1
Enable
Disable
AD_P60_EN; PAL 60
autodetect enable
0
1
Enable
Disable
AD_N443_EN; NTSC 4.43
autodetect enable
0
1
Enable
Disable
AD_SECAM_EN; SECAM
autodetect enable
0
1
Enable
Disable
AD_SEC525_EN; SECAM
525 autodetect enable
0
1
1
Enable
0x08
0x0A
0x0B
0x0C
Contrast
CON[7:0]; contrast adjust;
this is the user control for
contrast adjustment
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Luma gain = 1
0x00 gain = 0,
0x80 gain = 1,
0xFF gain = 2
Brightness
Hue
BRI[7:0]; this register
controls the brightness
of the video signal
0
0
0x00 = 0 IRE,
0x7F = +30 IRE,
0x80 = −30 IRE
HUE[7:0]; this register
contains the value for
the color hue adjustment
Hue range =
−90° to +90°
Default Value Y
DEF_VAL_EN;
default value enable
0
1
Free-run mode dependent on
DEF_VAL_AUTO_EN
Force free-run mode on and output
blue screen
DEF_VAL_AUTO_EN;
default value automatic
enable
0
1
Disable free-run mode
When lock is lost,
free-run mode
can be enabled to
output stable
Enable automatic free-run mode
(blue screen)
timing, clock, and
a set color
DEF_Y[5:0]; default value is
Y; this register holds the Y
default value
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
Y[7:0] = {DEF_Y[5:0], 0, 0}
Default Y value
output in free-run
mode
0x0D
Default Value C
DEF_C[7:0]; default value
is C; the Cr and Cb default
values are defined in this
register
0
0
Cr[3:0] = {DEF_C[7:4], 0, 0, 0, 0}
Cb[3:0] = {DEF_C[3:0], 0, 0, 0, 0}
Default Cb/Cr
value output in
free-run mode;
default values give
blue screen output
Rev. G | Page 85 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Bit Description
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Comments
Notes
0x0E
ADI Control 1
Reserved
0
0
0
0
0
Set as default
SUB_USR_EN; enables
user to access the interrupt/
VDP register map
0
1
Access main register space
Access interrupt/VDP register space
See Figure 53
Reserved
Reserved
0
0
Set as default
0x0F
Power
management
0
0
Set to default
PDBP; power-down bit
priority selects between
PWRDWN bit or pin control
0
1
Chip power-down controlled by pin
Not applicable for
32-lead LFCSP
Bit has priority (pin disregarded)
Set to default
Reserved
0
0
PWRDWN; power-down
places the decoder into a
full power-down mode
0
1
System functional
Powered down
See PDBP,
0x0F Bit 2
Reserved
0
Set to default
Reset; chip reset, loads
all I2C bits with default
values
0
1
Normal operation
Start reset sequence
Executing reset
takes approxi-
mately 2 ms; this
bit is self-clearing
0x10
Status 1
(read only)
IN_LOCK
x
1 = in lock (now)
1 = lost lock (since last read)
1 = fSC lock (now)
1 = peak white AGC mode active
NTSC M/J
Provides info
about the internal
status of the
decoder
LOST_LOCK
FSC_LOCK
FOLLOW_PW
x
x
x
AD_RESULT[2:0]; auto-
detection result reports
the standard of the
input video
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Detected
standard
NTSC 4.43
PAL M
PAL 60
PAL B/G/H/I/D
SECAM
PAL Combination N
SECAM 525
COL_KILL
x
1 = color kill is active
Color kill
0x11
0x12
IDENT
(read only)
IDENT[7:0]; provides
identification on the
revision of the part
0
0
0
1
1
x
1
x
0
x
0
x
Power-up
value = 0x1C
Status 2
(read only)
MVCS DET
MVCS T3
MV color striping detected
MV color striping type
1 = detected
0 = Type 2,
1 = Type 3
MV PS DET
MV AGC DET
LL NSTD
MV pseudosync detected
MV AGC pulses detected
Nonstandard line length
fSC frequency nonstandard
1 = detected
1 = detected
1 = detected
1 = detected
x
FSC NSTD
Reserved
x
x
x
0x13
Status 3
(read only)
INST_HLOCK
GEMD
x
1 = horizontal lock achieved
1 = Gemstar data detected
SD 60 Hz detected
Unfiltered
x
SD_OP_50Hz
0
1
SD field rate detect
SD 50 Hz detected
Reserved
x
FREE_RUN_ACT
STD FLD LEN
x
1 = free-run mode active
1 = field length standard
Blue screen output
x
Correct field
length found
Interlaced
x
1 = interlaced video detected
1 = swinging burst detected
Field sequence
found
PAL_SW_LOCK
x
Reliable swinging
burst sequence
Rev. G | Page 86 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Bit Description
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Comments
Notes
0x14
Analog
clamp control
Reserved
0
0
1
0
Set to default
CCLEN; current clamp
enable allows the user
to switch off the current
sources in the analog
front
0
1
Current sources switched off
Current sources enabled
Reserved
Reserved
0
0
0
Set to default
0x15
Digital Clamp
Control 1
x
x
x
x
Set to default
DCFE; digital clamp
freeze enable
0
1
Digital clamp on
Digital clamp off
Slow (TC = 1 sec)
Medium (TC = 0.5 sec)
Fast (TC = 0.1 sec)
TC dependent on video
Set to default
DCT[1:0]; digital clamp
timing determines the
time constant of the
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
digital fine clamp circuitry
Reserved
0
0x17
Shaping Filter
Control 1
YSFM[4:0]; selects Y
shaping filter mode in
CVBS-only mode;
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
Autowide notch for poor quality
sources or wideband filter with
comb for good quality input
Autonarrow notch for poor quality
sources or wideband filter with
comb for good quality input
SVHS 1
SVHS 2
SVHS 3
SVHS 4
SVHS 5
SVHS 6
SVHS 7
SVHS 8
SVHS 9
SVHS 10
SVHS 11
SVHS 12
SVHS 13
SVHS 14
SVHS 15
SVHS 16
SVHS 17
SVHS 18 (CCIR 601)
PAL NN1
PAL NN2
PAL NN3
PAL WN1
PAL WN2
NTSC NN1
NTSC NN2
NTSC NN3
NTSC WN1
NTSC WN2
NTSC WN3
Reserved
Autoselection 1.5 MHz
Autoselection 2.17 MHz
Decoder selects
optimum Y
shaping filter
depending on
CVBS quality
allows the user to select
a wide range of low-pass
and notch filters; if either
auto mode is selected,
the decoder selects
the optimum Y filter
depending on the CVBS
video source quality
(good vs. poor)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
If one of these
modes is selected,
the decoder does
not change filter
modes; depending
on video quality, a
fixed filter response
(the one selected)
is used for good
and bad quality
video
CSFM[2:0]; C shaping filter
mode allows selection
from a range of low-pass
chrominance filters;
if either auto mode is
selected, the decoder
selects the optimum C
filter depending on the
CVBS video source quality
(good vs. bad); nonauto
settings force a C filter for
all standards and quality
of CVBS video
0
0
0
0
0
1
Automatically
selects a C filter
based on video
standard and
quality
Selects a C filter for
all video standards
and for good and
bad video
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
SH1
SH2
SH3
SH4
SH5
Wideband mode
Rev. G | Page 87 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Bit Description
7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
~
1
3
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
~
1
2
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
~
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
~
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
~
1
Comments
Reserved, do not use
Reserved, do not use
SVHS 1
Notes
0x18
Shaping Filter
Control 2
WYSFM[4:0]; wideband Y
shaping filter mode allows
the user to select which Y
shaping filter is used for
the Y component of Y/C,
YPrPb, B/W input signals;
it is also used when a
good quality input CVBS
signal is detected; for all
other inputs, the Y
SVHS 2
SVHS 3
SVHS 4
SVHS 5
SVHS 6
shaping filter chosen is
controlled by YSFM[4:0]
SVHS 7
SVHS 8
SVHS 9
SVHS 10
SVHS 11
SVHS 12
SVHS 13
SVHS 14
SVHS 15
SVHS 16
SVHS 17
SVHS 18 (CCIR 601)
Reserved, do not use
Reserved, do not use
Reserved, do not use
Set to default
Autoselection of best filter
Manual select filter using WYSFM[4:0]
Reserved
0
0
WYSFMOVR; enables
use of the automatic
WYSFM filter
0
1
0x19
Comb filter
control
PSFSEL[1:0]; controls
the signal bandwidth
that is fed to the comb
filters (PAL)
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Narrow
Medium
Wide
Widest
NSFSEL[1:0]; controls
the signal bandwidth
that is fed to the comb
filters (NTSC)
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Narrow
Medium
Medium
Wide
Reserved
Reserved
EN28XTAL
1
1
1
0
1
0
Set as default
Set to default
Reserved, do not use
Use 28 MHz crystal
LLC pin active
LLC pin three-stated
0x1D
ADI Control 2
0
x
x
x
0
1
TRI_LLC
0
1
Rev. G | Page 88 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Bit Description
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
1
Comments
Notes
0x27
Pixel delay
control
LTA[1:0]; luma timing
adjust allows the user to
specify a timing difference
between chroma and
luma samples
No delay
CVBS mode
LTA[1:0] = 00b,
S-Video mode
LTA[1:0] = 01b,
YPrPb mode
LTA[1:0] = 01b
Luma one clock (37 ns) late
1
1
0
1
Luma two clocks (74 ns) early
Luma one clock (37 ns) early
Reserved
0
Set to 0
CTA[2:0]; chroma
timing adjust allows
a specified timing
difference between
the luma and chroma
samples
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Not a valid setting
CVBS mode
CTA[2:0] = 011b,
S-Video mode
CTA[2:0] =101b,
YPrPb mode
Chroma + two pixels (early)
Chroma + one pixel (early)
No delay
CTA[2:0] = 110b
Chroma − one pixel (late)
Chroma − two pixels (late)
Chroma − three pixels (late)
Not a valid setting
AUTO_PDC_EN;
0
1
Use values in LTA[1:0] and CTA[2:0]
for delaying luma/chroma
automatically programs
the LTA/CTA values so
that luma and chroma are
aligned at the output for
all modes of operation
LTA and CTA values determined
automatically
SWPC; allows the Cr and
Cb samples to be swapped
0
1
No swapping
Swap the Cr and Cb output samples
Update once per video line
Update once per field
0x2B
Misc gain
control
PW_UPD; peak white
update determines the
rate of gain
0
1
Peak white must
be enabled; see
LAGC[2:0]
Reserved
1
0
0
0
0
Set to default
CKE; color kill enable
allows the color kill
function to be switched
on and off
0
1
Color kill disabled
Color kill enabled
For SECAM color
kill, the threshold is
set at 8%; see
CKILLTHR[2:0]
Reserved
1
Set to default
0x2C
AGC mode
control
CAGC[1:0]; chroma auto-
matic gain control selects
the basic mode of
operation for the AGC in
the chroma path
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Manual fixed gain
Use luma gain for chroma
Automatic gain
Use CMG[11:0]
Based on color burst
Freeze chroma gain
Set to 1
Reserved
1
1
LAGC[2:0]; luma auto
matic gain control selects
the mode of operation for
the gain control in the
luma path
0
0
0
0
0
1
Manual fixed gain
Peak white algorithm off
Use LMG[11:0]
Blank level to
sync tip
0
1
0
Peak white algorithm on
Blank level to
sync tip
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Freeze gain
Set to 1
Reserved
1
0x2D
Chroma Gain
Control 1,
Chroma Gain1
(CG)
CMG[11:8]/CG[11:8]; in
0
1
0
0
CAGC[1:0] settings
decide in which
mode CMG[11:0]
operates
manual mode, the chroma
gain control can be used to
program a desired manual
chroma gain; in auto mode,
it can be used to read back
the current gain value
Reserved
1
1
Set to 1
CAGT[1:0]; chroma auto
matic gain timing allows
adjustment of the chroma
AGC tracking speed
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Slow (TC = 2 sec)
Medium (TC = 1 sec)
Reserved
Has an effect only
if CAGC[1:0] is set
to autogain (10)
Adaptive
Rev. G | Page 89 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Bit Description
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Comments
Notes
0x2E
Chroma Gain
Control 2,
Chroma Gain2
(CG)
CMG[7:0]/CG[7:0]; chroma
manual gain lower eight
bits; see CMG[11:8]/
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CMG[11:0] = see the CMG section
CMG[11:0] = see the CMG section
Min value = 0d,
Max value = 4095d
CG[11:8] for description
0x2F
Luma Gain
Control 1, Luma
Gain1 (LG)
LMG[11:8]/LG[11:8]; in
manual mode, luma gain
control can be used to
program a desired manual
luma gain; in auto mode,
it can be used to read
back the actual gain value
used
x
x
x
x
LAGC[1:0] settings decide in which
mode LMG[11:0] operates
Reserved
1
x
1
x
Set to 1
LAGT[1:0]; luma auto
matic gain timing allows
adjustment of the luma
AGC tracking speed
0
0
1
1
x
0
1
0
1
x
Slow (TC = 2 sec)
Medium (TC = 1 sec)
Fast (TC = 0.2 sec)
Adaptive
Only has an effect
if LAGC[1:0] is set
to autogain (001,
010, 011, or 100)
LMG[7:0]/LG[7:0]; luma
manual gain lower eight
bits; see LMG[11:8]/
x
x
x
x
LMG[11:0] - see the LMG section
LMG[11:0] =- see the LMG section
Min value = 1024d,
Max value = 4095d
0x30
0x31
Luma Gain
Control 2, Luma
Gain2 (LG)
LG[11:8] for description
Reserved
0
1
0
Set to default
VS/FIELD
Control 1
HVSTIM; selects where
within a line of video the
VS signal is asserted
0
1
Start of line relative to HSE
Start of line relative to HSB
HSE = HSYNC end
HSB = HSYNC begin
NEWAVMODE; sets the
EAV/SAV mode
0
1
EAV/SAV codes generated to suit
Analog Devices encoders
Manual VS/FIELD position controlled by
the 0x32, 0x33, and 0xE5 to 0xEA registers
Reserved
Reserved
VSBHE
0
0
0
0
Set to default
Set to default
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
NEWAVMODE bit
must be set high
0x32
0x33
0x34
VS/FIELD
Control 2
0
1
VS goes high in the middle of the
line (even field)
VS changes state at the start of the
line (even field)
VSBHO
0
1
VS goes high in the middle of the
line (odd field)
VS changes state at the start of the
line (odd field)
Reserved
VSEHE
0
0
0
Set to default
VS/FIELD
Control 3
0
1
VS goes low in the middle of the
line (even field)
NEWAVMODE bit
must be set high
VS changes state at the start of the
line (even field)
VSEHO
0
1
VS goes low in the middle of the line
(odd field)
VS changes state at the start of the
line odd field
HSE[10:8]; HS end allows
positioning of the HS
output within the
video line
HS output ends HSE[10:0] pixels after
the falling edge of HSYNC
Using HSB and
HSE the user can
program the
position and length
of the output
HSYNC
HS Position
Control 1
Reserved
0
Set to 0
HSB[10:8]; HS begin
allows positioning of
the HS output within
the video line
0
0
0
0
0
0
HS output starts HSB[10:0] pixels
after the falling edge of HSYNC
Reserved
0
0
Set to 0
0x35
0x36
HS Position
Control 2
HSB[7:0]; see Address 0x34,
using HSB[10:0] and
HSE[10:0], users can
program the position
and length of the HS
output signal
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
HS Position
Control 3
HSE[7:0]; see Address
0x35 description
0
0
0
0
Rev. G | Page 90 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Bit Description
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
1
Comments
Notes
0x37
Polarity
PCLK; sets polarity of LLC
Invert polarity
Normal polarity as per the timing
diagrams
Reserved
0
0
Set to 0
PF; sets the FIELD polarity
0
1
Active high
Active low
Reserved
0
Set to 0
PVS; sets the VS polarity
0
1
Active high
Active low
Reserved
0
Set to 0
PHS; sets HS polarity
0
1
Active low
Active high
YCMN[2:0]; luma comb
mode, NTSC
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
Adaptive three-line, three-tap luma
Use low-pass notch
Fixed luma comb (two-line)
Fixed luma comb (three-line)
Fixed luma comb (two-line)
0x38
NTSC comb
control
Top lines of memory
All lines of memory
Bottom lines of
memory
CCMN[2:0]; chroma
comb mode, NTSC
0
0
0
Three-line adaptive for CTAPSN = 01,
Four-line adaptive for CTAPSN = 10,
Five-line adaptive for CTAPSN = 11
1
1
0
0
0
1
Disable chroma comb
Fixed two-line for CTAPSN = 01,
Fixed three-line for CTAPSN = 10,
Fixed four-line for CTAPSN = 11
Top lines of memory
All lines of memory
1
1
1
1
0
1
Fixed three-line for CTAPSN = 01,
Fixed four-line for CTAPSN = 10,
Fixed five-line for CTAPSN = 11
Fixed two-line for CTAPSN = 01,
Fixed three-line for CTAPSN = 10,
Fixed four-line for CTAPSN = 11
Bottom lines of
memory
CTAPSN[1:0]; chroma
comb taps, NTSC
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Not used
Adapts three lines to two lines
Adapts five lines to three lines
Adapts five lines to four lines
Adaptive five-line, three-tap luma comb
Use low-pass notch
0x39
PAL comb
control
YCMP[2:0]; luma
comb mode, PAL
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
Fixed luma comb (three-line)
Fixed luma comb (five-line)
Fixed luma comb (three-line)
Top lines of memory
All lines of memory
Bottom lines of
memory
CCMP[2:0]; chroma
comb mode, PAL
0
0
0
Three-line adaptive for CTAPSN = 01,
Four-line adaptive for CTAPSN = 10,
Five-line adaptive for CTAPSN = 11
1
1
0
0
0
1
Disable chroma comb
Fixed two-line for CTAPSN = 01
Fixed three-line for CTAPSN = 10
Fixed four-line for CTAPSN = 11
Fixed three-line for CTAPSN = 01
Fixed four-line for CTAPSN = 10
Fixed five-line for CTAPSN = 11
Fixed two-line for CTAPSN = 01
Top lines of memory
All lines of memory
1
1
1
1
0
1
Bottom lines
of memory
Fixed three-line for CTAPSN = 10
Fixed four-line for CTAPSN = 11
Not used
CTAPSP[1:0]; chroma
comb taps, PAL
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Adapts five lines to three lines (two taps)
Adapts five lines to three lines (three taps)
Adapts five lines to four lines (four taps)
Rev. G | Page 91 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Bit Description
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Comments
Notes
0x3A
ADC control
MUX PDN override; mux
power-down override
0
No control over
power-down for
muxes and associ-
ated channel circuit
1
Allows power-down
of MUX0/MUX1/
MUX2 and
associated channel
circuit. When
INSEL[3:0] is used,
unused channels
are automatically
powered down.
PWRDWN_MUX_2;
0
1
MUX2 and associated channel in
normal operation
enables power-down of
MUX2 and associated
channel clamp and buffer
Power down MUX2 and associated
channel operation
MUX PDN
Override = 1
PWRDWN_MUX_1;
0
1
MUX1 and associated channel in
normal operation
enables power-down of
MUX1 and associated
channel clamp and buffer
Power down MUX1 and associated
channel operation
MUX PDN
Override = 1
PWRDWN_MUX_0;
0
MUX0 and associated channel in
normal operation
enables power-down of
MUX0 and associated
channel clamp and buffer
1
0
Power down MUX0 and associated
channel operation
MUX PDN
Override = 1
Reserved
0
0
0
1
Set as default
Set to default
0x3D
Manual
window
control
Reserved
0
1
0
CKE = 1 enables
the color kill
function and must
be enabled for
CKILLTHR[2:0] to
take effect
CKILLTHR[2:0]
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
NTSC, PAL color kill at <0.5%,
SECAM no color kill
NTSC, PAL color kill at <1.5%,
SECAM color kill at <5%
NTSC, PAL color kill at <2.5%,
SECAM color kill at <7%
NTSC, PAL color kill at <4%,
SECAM color kill at <8%
NTSC, PAL color kill at <8.5%,
SECAM color kill at <9.5%
NTSC, PAL color kill at <16%,
SECAM color kill at <15%
NTSC, PAL color kill at <32%,
SECAM color kill at <32%
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
1
Set to default
Set to default
0x41
Resample
control
0
0
0
0
0
1
SFL_INV; controls the
behavior of the PAL
switch bit
0
1
SFL-compatible with the ADV717x and
ADV73xx video encoders
SFL-compatible with the ADV7194
video encoder
Reserved
0
0
Set to default
GDECEL[15:8]; see the
Comments column
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
GDECEL[15:0]: 16 individual enable bits
that select the lines of video (even field
Line 10 to Line 25) that the decoder
checks for Gemstar-compatible data
LSB = Line 10,
MSB = Line 25,
Default = do not
check for Gemstar-
compatible data
on any lines [10 to
25] in even fields
0x48
0x49
Gemstar
Control 1
GDECEL[7:0]
0
Gemstar
Control 2
Rev. G | Page 92 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Bit Description
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Comments
Notes
GDECOL[15:8]; see the
Comments column
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
GDECOL[15:0]: 16 individual enable bits
that select the lines of video (odd field
Line 10 to Line 25) that the decoder
checks for Gemstar-compatible data
LSB = Line 10,
MSB = Line 25,
0x4A
Gemstar
Control 3
Default = do not
check for Gemstar-
compatible data on
any lines [10 to 25]
in odd fields
GDECOL[7:0]
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0x4B
Gemstar
Control 4
GDECAD; controls the
0
1
Split data into half-byte
To avoid 00/FF code
0x4C
Gemstar
Control 5
manner decoded Gemstar
data is inserted into the
horizontal blanking period
Output in straight 8-bit format
GDE_SEL_OLD_ADF
Reserved
0
Enables a new ancillary data system
Undefined
x
x
x
x
x
x
0x4D
CTI DNR
Control 1
CTI_EN; CTI enable
0
1
Disable CTI
Enable CTI
CTI_AB_EN; enables the
mixing of the transient
improved chroma with
the original signal
0
1
Disable CTI alpha blender
Enable CTI alpha blender
CTI_AB[1:0]; controls the
behavior of the alpha-
blend circuitry
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Sharpest mixing
Sharp mixing
Smooth mixing
Smoothest mixing
Set to default
Reserved
0
DNR_EN; enable or bypass
the DNR block
0
1
Bypass the DNR block
Enable the DNR block
Set to default
Reserved
1
0
1
0
0x4E
0x50
0x51
CTI DNR
Control 2
CTI_C_TH[7:0]; specifies
how big the amplitude
step must be to be steep-
ened by the CTI block
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Set to 0x04 for AV input;
set to 0x0A for tuner input
CTI DNR
Control 4
DNR_TH[7:0]; specifies
the maximum edge that is
interpreted as noise and is
therefore blanked
0
0
0
Lock count
CIL[2:0]; count into lock
determines the number of
lines the system must
remain in lock before
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
One line of video
Two lines of video
Five lines of video
10 lines of video
100 lines of video
500 lines of video
1000 lines of video
100,000 lines of video
1 line of video
2 lines of video
5 lines of video
10 lines of video
100 lines of video
500 lines of video
1000 lines of video
100,000 lines of video
Over field with vertical info
Line-to-line evaluation
showing a locked status
COL[2:0]; count out of
lock determines the
number of lines the
system must remain out-
of-lock before showing a
lost-locked status
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
SRLS; select raw lock signal;
selects the determination
of the lock status
0
1
FSCLE; fSC lock enable
0
1
Lock status set only by horizontal lock
Lock status set by horizontal lock and
subcarrier lock
0x58
VS/FIELD
pin control
VS/FIELD; VSYNC or FIELD
output; 40-lead and
32-lead LFCSP only
0
1
FIELD
VSYNC
Pin 37 on 40-lead
LFCSP, Pin 31 on
32-lead LFCSP
Reserved
0
Set to default
ADC sampling control
0
1
ADC sampling control
Y/C mode only
Set to default
Mandatory write
Reserved
0
0
0
0
0
Rev. G | Page 93 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Bit Description
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
1
Comments
Notes
0x59
General-
purpose
outputs
GPO[3:0]; LQFP only
Outputs 0 to GPO0
Outputs 1 to GPO0
Outputs 0 to GPO1
Outputs 1 to GPO1
Outputs 0 to GPO2
Outputs 1 to GPO2
Outputs 0 to GPO3
Outputs 1 to GPO3
GPO[3:0] three-stated
GPO[3:0] enabled
GPO_ENABLE
must be set to 1
for these bits to
take effect
0
1
0
1
0
1
GPO_ENABLE
0
1
Reserved
Reserved
0
0
0
0x8F
Free-Run Line
Length 1
0
0
0
0
Set to default
LLC_PAD_SEL[2:0]; enables
manual selection of the
clock for the LLC pin
0
1
0
0
0
1
LLC (nominal 27 MHz) selected out
on LLC pin
LLC (nominal 13.5 MHz) selected out
on LLC pin
For 16-bit 4:2:2 out,
OF_SEL[3:0] = 0010
Reserved
0
x
Set to default
0x99
0x9A
0x9B
CCAP1
(read only)
CCAP1[7:0]; closed
caption data register
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
CCAP1[7] contains parity bit for Byte 0
CCAP2
(read only)
CCAP2[7:0]; closed
caption data register
x
x
CCAP2[7] contains parity bit for Byte 0
Letterbox 1
(read only)
LB_LCT[7:0]; letterbox
data register
Reports the number of black lines
detected at the top of active video
This feature
examines the active
video at the start
and end of each
field; it enables
format detection
even if the video is
not accompanied
by a CGMS or WSS
sequence
0x9C
0x9D
Letterbox 2
(read only)
LB_LCM[7:0]; letterbox
data register
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Reports the number of black lines
detected in the bottom half of active
video if subtitles are detected
Letterbox 3
(read only)
LB_LCB[7:0]; letterbox
data register
Reports the number of black lines
detected at the bottom of active video
0xB2
0xC3
CRC enable
(write only)
Reserved
0
0
Set as default
CRC_ENABLE; enable CRC
checksum decoded from
FMS packet to validate
CGMSD
0
1
Turn off CRC check
CGMSD goes high with valid checksum
Reserved
0
0
0
1
1
Set as default
ADC Switch 1
MUX0[2:0]; manual
LQFP
No connect
AIN1
LFCSP
MAN_MUX_EN = 1
muxing control for MUX0;
this setting controls which
input is routed to the ADC
for processing
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
No connect
AIN1
AIN2
No connect
No connect
AIN2
AIN3
AIN4
AIN5
AIN3
AIN6
No connect
No connect
No connect
Reserved
0
MUX1[2:0]; manual
LQFP
LFCSP
MAN_MUX_EN = 1
muxing control for MUX1;
this setting controls which
input is routed to the ADC
for processing
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
No connect
No connect
No connect
AIN3
No connect
No connect
No connect
No connect
AIN2
AIN4
AIN5
AIN3
AIN6
No connect
No connect
No connect
Reserved
0
Rev. G | Page 94 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Bit Description
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Comments
LQFP
Notes
0xC4
ADC Switch 2
MUX2[2:0]; manual
LFCSP
MAN_MUX_EN = 1
muxing control for MUX2;
this setting controls which
input is routed to the ADC
for processing
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
No connect
No connect
AIN2
No connect
No connect
No connect
No connect
No connect
AIN3
No connect
No connect
AIN5
AIN6
No connect
No connect
No connect
Reserved
0
0
0
0
0
1
MAN_MUX_EN; enable
manual setting of the
input signal muxing
0
1
Disable
Enable
This bit must be set
to 1 for manual
muxing
0xDC
0xDD
Letterbox
Control 1
LB_TH[4:0]; sets the
threshold value that
determines if a line is
black
1
1
0
0
0
0
Default threshold for the detection of
black lines
01101 to 10000—increase threshold,
00000 to 01011—decrease threshold
Reserved
1
0
0
1
1
0
Set as default
Letterbox
Control 2
LB_EL[3:0]; programs the
end line of the activity
window for LB detection
(end of field)
1
LB detection ends with the last line of
active video on a field, 1100b: 262/525
LB_SL[3:0]; programs the
start line of the activity
window for LB detection
(start of field)
0
x
Letterbox detection aligned with the
start of active video, 0100b: 23/286 NTSC
0xDE
0xDF
0xE1
ST Noise
Readback 1
(read only)
ST_NOISE[10:8]
ST_NOISE_VLD
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
When = 1, ST_NOISE[10:0] is valid
ST Noise
Readback 2
(read only)
ST_NOISE[7:0]
x
x
x
SD Offset Cb
SD_OFF_Cb[7:0]; adjusts
the hue by selecting the
offset for the Cb channel
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
−312 mV offset applied to the Cb channel
0 mV offset applied to the Cb channel
+312 mV offset applied to the Cb channel
−312 mV offset applied to the Cr channel
0 mV offset applied to the Cr channel
+312 mV offset applied to the Cr channel
Gain on Cb channel = −42 dB
0xE2
0xE3
0xE4
0xE5
SD Offset Cr
SD_OFF_Cr[7:0]; adjusts
the hue by selecting the
offset for the Cr channel
SD Saturation Cb
SD Saturation Cr
SD_SAT_Cb[7:0]; adjusts
the saturation by affecting
gain on the Cb channel
Gain on Cb channel = 0 dB
Gain on Cb channel = +6 dB
SD_SAT_Cr[7:0]; adjusts
the saturation by affecting
gain on the Cr channel
Gain on Cr channel = −42 dB
Gain on Cb channel = 0 dB
Gain on Cb channel = +6 dB
NTSC V bit
begin
NVBEG[4:0]; number of
lines after lCOUNT rollover
to set V high
NTSC default (ITU-R BT.656)
NVBEGSIGN
0
1
Set to low when manual programming
Not suitable for user programming
No delay
NVBEGDELE; delay V bit
going high by one line
relative to NVBEG (even
field)
0
1
Additional delay by one line
NVBEGDELO; delay V bit
going high by one line
relative to NVBEG (odd
field)
0
1
No delay
Additional delay by one line
Rev. G | Page 95 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Bit Description
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Comments
Notes
0xE6
NTSC V bit end
NVEND[4:0]; number of
lines after lCOUNT rollover
to set V low
0
0
1
0
0
NTSC default (ITU-R BT.656)
NVENDSIGN
0
1
Set to low when manual programming
Not suitable for user programming
No delay
NVENDDELE; delay V bit
going low by one line
relative to NVEND (even
field)
0
1
Additional delay by one line
NVENDDELO; delay V bit
going low by one line
relative to NVEND (odd
field)
0
1
No delay
Additional delay by one line
0xE7
0xE8
0xE9
0xEA
NTSC F bit
toggle
NFTOG[4:0]; number of
lines after lCOUNT rollover to
toggle F signal
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
NTSC default
NFTOGSIGN
0
1
Set to low when manual programming
Not suitable for user programming
No delay
NFTOGDELE; delay
F transition by one line
relative to NFTOG (even
field)
0
1
Additional delay by one line
NFTOGDELO; delay
F transition by one line
relative to NFTOG
(odd field)
0
1
No delay
Additional delay by one line
PAL V bit begin
PAL V bit end
PAL F bit toggle
PVBEG[4:0]; number of
lines after lCOUNT rollover
to set V high
PAL default (ITU-R BT.656)
PVBEGSIGN
0
1
Set to low when manual programming
Not suitable for user programming
No delay
PVBEGDELE; delay V bit
going high by one line
relative to PVBEG (even
field)
0
1
Additional delay by one line
PVBEGDELO; delay V bit
going high by one line
relative to PVBEG (odd
field)
0
1
No delay
Additional delay by one line
PVEND[4:0]; number of
lines after lCOUNT rollover
to set V low.
PAL default (ITU-R BT.656)
PVENDSIGN
0
1
Set to low when manual programming
Not suitable for user programming
No delay
PVENDDELE; delay V bit
going low by one line
relative to PVEND (even
field)
0
1
Additional delay by one line
PVENDDELO; delay V bit
going low by one line
relative to PVEND (odd
field)
0
1
No delay
Additional delay by one line
PFTOG[4:0]; number of
lines after lCOUNT rollover
to toggle F signal
PAL default (ITU-R BT.656)
PFTOGSIGN
0
1
Set to low when manual programming
Not suitable for user programming
No delay
PFTOGDELE; delay
F transition by one line
relative to PFTOG
(even field)
0
1
Additional delay by one line
PFTOGDELO; delay
F transition by one line
relative to PFTOG
(odd field)
0
1
No delay
Additional delay by one line
Rev. G | Page 96 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Bit Description
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Comments
Notes
0xEB
Vblank Control 1 PVBIELCM[1:0]; PAL VBI
even field line control
0
0
VBI ends one line earlier (Line 335)
ITU-R BT.470 compliant (Line 336)
VBI ends one line later (Line 337)
VBI ends two lines later (Line 338)
VBI ends one line earlier (Line 22)
ITU-R BT.470 compliant (Line 23)
VBI ends one line later (Line 24)
VBI ends two lines later (Line 25)
VBI ends one line earlier (Line 282)
ITU-R BT.470 compliant (Line 283)
VBI ends one line later (Line 284)
VBI ends two lines later (Line 285)
VBI ends one line earlier (Line 20)
ITU-R BT.470 compliant (Line 21)
VBI ends one line later (Line 22)
VBI ends two lines later (Line 23)
Color output beginning Line 335
Controls position of
first active (comb
filtered) line after VBI
on even field in PAL
0
1
1
1
0
1
PVBIOLCM[1:0]; PAL VBI
odd field line control
0
0
Controls position of
first active (comb
filtered) line after VBI
on odd field in PAL
0
1
1
1
0
1
NVBIELCM[1:0]; NTSC VBI
even field line control
0
0
Controls position of
first active (comb
filtered) line after VBI
on even field in NTSC
0
1
1
1
0
1
NVBIOLCM[1:0]; NTSC VBI
odd field line control
0
0
Controls position of
first active (comb
filtered) line after VBI
on odd field in NTSC
0
1
1
1
0
1
0xEC
Vblank Control 2 PVBIECCM[1:0]; PAL VBI
even field color control
0
0
0
1
Controls the position
of first line that
outputs color after
VBI on even field in
PAL
ITU-R BT.470 compliant color output
beginning Line 336
1
1
0
1
Color output beginning Line 337
Color output beginning Line 338
Color output beginning Line 22
PVBIOCCM[1:0]; PAL VBI
odd field color control
0
0
0
1
Controls the position
of first line that
outputs color after
VBI on odd field in
PAL
ITU-R BT.470-compliant color output
beginning Line 23
1
1
0
1
Color output beginning Line 24
Color output beginning Line 25
Color output beginning Line 282
NVBIECCM[1:0]; NTSC VBI
even field color control
0
0
0
1
Controls the position
of first line that
outputs color after
VBI on even field in
NTSC
ITU-R BT.470-compliant color output
beginning Line 283
1
1
0
1
VBI ends one line later (Line 284)
Color output beginning Line 285
Color output beginning Line 20
NVBIOCCM[1:0]; NTSC VBI
odd field color control
0
0
0
1
Controls the position
of first line that
outputs color after
VBI on odd field in
NTSC
ITU-R BT.470 compliant color output
beginning Line 21
1
1
0
1
Color output beginning Line 22
Color output beginning Line 23
Antialiasing Filter 1 disabled
0xF3
AFE_CONTROL 1 AA_FILT_EN[2:0];
antialiasing filter enable
0
AA_FILT_MAN_OVR
must be enabled
to change settings
defined by
INSEL[3:0]
1
Antialiasing Filter 1 enabled
Antialiasing Filter 2 disabled
Antialiasing Filter 2 enabled
Antialiasing Filter 3 disabled
Antialiasing Filter 3 enabled
Override disabled
0
1
0
1
AA_FILT_MAN_OVR;
0
antialiasing filter override
1
Override enabled
Reserved
0
0
0
0
Rev. G | Page 97 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Bits
(Shading Indicates Default State)
Subaddress
Register
Bit Description
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
Comments
Notes
0xF4
Drive strength
DR_STR_S[1:0]; selects
the drive strength for
the sync output signals
Low drive strength (1×)
Medium low drive strength (2×)
Medium high drive strength (3×)
High drive strength (4×)
DR_STR_C[1:0]; selects
the drive strength for
the clock output signal
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Low drive strength (1×)
Medium low drive strength (2×)
Medium high drive strength (3×)
High drive strength (4×)
DR_STR[1:0]; selects the
drive strength for the data
output signals; can be
increased or decreased for
EMC or crosstalk reasons
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Low drive strength (1×)
Medium low drive strength (2×)
Medium high drive strength (3×)
High drive strength (4×)
Reserved
x
x
0xF8
IF comp
control
IFFILTSEL[2:0]; IF filter
selection for PAL and
NTSC
0
0
0
Bypass mode
0 dB
2 MHz
−3 dB
5 MHz
−2 dB
NTSC filters
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
−6 dB
+3.5 dB
+5 dB
−10 dB
Reserved
3 MHz
−2 dB
6 MHz
+2 dB
+3 dB
+5 dB
PAL filters
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
−5 dB
−7 dB
Reserved
0
0
0
0
0
0xF9
VS mode
control
EXTEND_VS_MAX_FREQ
0
1
Limits maximum VSYNC frequency to
66.25 Hz (475 lines/frame)
Limits maximum VSYNC frequency to
70.09 Hz (449 lines/frame)
EXTEND_VS_MIN_FREQ
VS_COAST_MODE[1:0]
0
1
Limits minimum VSYNC frequency to
42.75 Hz (731 lines/frame)
Limits minimum VSYNC frequency to
39.51 Hz (791 lines/frame)
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Autocoast mode
50 Hz coast mode
60 Hz coast mode
Reserved
This value sets up
the output coast
frequency
Reserved
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0xFB
0xFC
Peaking control
PEAKING_GAIN[7:0]
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
Increases/decreases the gain for high
frequency portions of the video signal
Coring
threshold
DNR_TH2[7:0]
0
0
0
0
Specifies the maximum edge that is
interpreted as noise and therefore
blanked
1 Shading indicates default values.
2 x indicates a bit that keeps the last written value.
Rev. G | Page 98 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Table 108. Register Map Descriptions (Interrupt Operation)1, 2
Bit (Shading Indicates
Default State)
User Sub Map
Bit Description
Address Register
0x40 Interrupt Configuration 1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
Comments
Notes
INTRQ_OP_SEL[1:0]; interrupt
drive level select
Open drain
Drive low when active
Drive high when active
Reserved
MPU_STIM_INTRQ; manual
interrupt set mode
0
1
Manual interrupt mode disabled
Manual interrupt mode enabled
Not used
Reserved
x
MV_INTRQ_SEL[1:0];
Macrovision interrupt select
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Reserved
Pseudo sync only
Color stripe only
Pseudo sync or color stripe
Three XTAL periods
15 XTAL periods
63 XTAL periods
Active until cleared
No change
INTRQ_DUR_SEL[1:0];
interrupt duration select
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0x42
Interrupt Status 1
(read only)
SD_LOCK_Q
0
1
These bits can be cleared
or masked in Register 0x43
and Register 0x44, res-
pectively
SD input has caused the decoder to go
from an unlocked state to a locked state
SD_UNLOCK_Q
0
1
No change
SD input has caused the decoder to go
from a locked state to an unlocked state
Reserved
x
x
x
SD_FR_CHNG_Q
0
1
No change
Denotes a change in the free-run status
No change
MV_PS_CS_Q
0
1
Pseudo sync/color striping detected;
see Register 0x40 MV_INTRQ_SEL[1:0]
for selection
Reserved
x
x
x
0x43
Interrupt Clear 1
(write only)
SD_LOCK_CLR
0
1
Do not clear
Clears SD_LOCK_Q bit
Do not clear
SD_UNLOCK_CLR
0
1
Clears SD_UNLOCK_Q bit
Not used
Reserved
0 0 0
SD_FR_CHNG_CLR
0
1
Do not clear
Clears SD_FR_CHNG_Q bit
Do not clear
MV_PS_CS_CLR
0
1
Clears MV_PS_CS_Q bit
Not used
Reserved
0x44
Interrupt Mask 1
(read/write)
SD_LOCK_MSK
0
1
Masks SD_LOCK_Q bit
Unmasks SD_LOCK_Q bit
Masks SD_UNLOCK_Q bit
Unmasks SD_UNLOCK_Q bit
Not used
SD_UNLOCK_MSK
0
1
Reserved
0 0 0
SD_FR_CHNG_MSK
0
1
Masks SD_FR_CHNG_Q bit
Unmasks SD_FR_CHNG_Q bit
Masks MV_PS_CS_Q bit
Unmasks MV_PS_CS_Q bit
Not used
MV_PS_CS_MSK
Reserved
0
1
Rev. G | Page 99 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Bit (Shading Indicates
Default State)
User Sub Map
Bit Description
Address Register
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Comments
Notes
0x45
Raw Status 2
(read only)
CCAPD
0
No CCAPD data detected—
VBI System 2
These bits are status
bits only; they cannot be
cleared or masked;
Register 0x46 is used for
this purpose
1
CCAPD data detected—VBI System 2
Reserved
x
x
x
EVEN_FIELD
0
1
Current SD field is odd numbered
Current SD field is even numbered
Reserved
x
x
MPU_STIM_INTRQ
0
1
MPU_STIM_INTRQ = 0
MPU_STIM_INTRQ = 1
0x46
Interrupt Status 2
(read only)
CCAPD_Q
GEMD_Q
0
1
Closed captioning not detected in the
input video signal—VBI System 2
These bits can be cleared
or masked by Register 0x47
and Register 0x48, res-
pectively; note that the
interrupt in Register 0x46
for the CCAP, Gemstar,
CGMS, and WSS data uses
the Mode 1 data slicer
Closed captioning data detected in the
video input signal—VBI System 2
0
1
Gemstar data not detected in the input
video signal—VBI System 2
Gemstar data detected in the input
video signal—VBI System 2
Reserved
x
x
SD_FIELD_CHNGD_Q
0
1
SD signal has not changed field from
odd to even or vice versa
SD signal has changed Field from odd to
even or vice versa
Reserved
x
Not used
Reserved
x
x
0
Not used
MPU_STIM_INTRQ_Q
0
1
Manual interrupt not set
Manual interrupt set
Do not clear—VBI System 2
Clears CCAPD_Q bit—VBI System 2
Do not clear
0x47
0x48
0x49
Interrupt Clear 2
(write only)
CCAPD_CLR
GEMD_CLR
0
1
Note that interrupt in
Register 0x46 for the
CCAP, Gemstar, CGMS,
and WSS data uses the
Mode 1 data slicer
0
1
Clears GEMD_Q bit
Reserved
0 0
SD_FIELD_CHNGD_CLR
0
1
Do not clear
Clears SD_FIELD_CHNGD_Q bit
Not used
Reserved
x
MPU_STIM_INTRQ_CLR
0
1
Do not clear
Clears MPU_STIM_INTRQ_Q bit
Masks CCAPD_Q bit—VBI System 2
Unmasks CCAPD_Q bit—VBI System 2
Masks GEMD_Q bit—VBI System 2
Unmasks GEMD_Q bit—VBI System 2
Not used
Interrupt Mask 2
(read/write)
CCAPD_MSK
GEMD_MSK
0
1
Note that interrupt in
Register 0x46 for the
CCAP, Gemstar, CGMS,
and WSS data uses the
Mode 1 data slicer
0
1
Reserved
0 0
SD_FIELD_CHNGD_MSK
0
1
Masks SD_FIELD_CHNGD_Q bit
Unmasks SD_FIELD_CHNGD_Q bit
Not used
Reserved
0
MPU_STIM_INTRQ_MSK
0
1
Masks MPU_STIM_INTRQ_Q bit
Unmasks MPU_STIM_INTRQ_Q bit
SD 60 Hz signal output
Raw Status 3
(read only)
SD_OP_50Hz; SD 60 Hz/50 Hz
frame rate at output
0
1
These bits are status
bits only; they cannot be
cleared or masked;
Register 0x4A is used for
this purpose
SD 50 Hz signal output
SD_V_LOCK
0
1
SD vertical sync lock not established
SD vertical sync lock established
SD horizontal sync lock not established
SD horizontal sync lock established
Not used
SD_H_LOCK
0
1
Reserved
x
SCM_LOCK
0
1
SECAM lock not established
SECAM lock established
Not used
Reserved
x
x
x
Rev. G | Page 100 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Bit (Shading Indicates
Default State)
User Sub Map
Bit Description
Address Register
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Comments
Notes
0x4A
Interrupt Status 3
(read only)
SD_OP_CHNG_Q; SD 60 Hz/50 Hz
frame rate at output
0
No change in SD signal standard
detected at the output
These bits can be cleared
and masked by
Register 0x4B and
Register 0x4C, respectively
1
A change in SD signal standard is
detected at the output
SD_V_LOCK_CHNG_Q
SD_H_LOCK_CHNG_Q
0
1
No change in SD VSYNC lock status
SD VSYNC lock status has changed
No change in HSYNC lock status
SD HSYNC lock status has changed
0
1
SD_AD_CHNG_Q; SD autodetect
changed
0
1
No change in AD_RESULT[2:0] bits in
Status 1 register
AD_RESULT[2:0] bits in Status 1 register
have changed
SCM_LOCK_CHNG_Q; SECAM lock
PAL_SW_LK_CHNG_Q
0
1
No change in SECAM lock status
SECAM lock status has changed
0
1
No change in PAL swinging burst
lock status
PAL swinging burst lock status has
changed
Reserved
x
x
x
x
x
x
Not used
0x4B
0x4C
0x4E
Interrupt Clear 3
(write only)
SD_OP_CHNG_CLR
0
1
Do not clear
Clears SD_OP_CHNG_Q bit
Do not clear
SD_V_LOCK_CHNG_CLR
SD_H_LOCK_CHNG_CLR
SD_AD_CHNG_CLR
0
1
Clears SD_V_LOCK_CHNG_Q bit
Do not clear
0
1
Clears SD_H_LOCK_CHNG_Q bit
Do not clear
0
1
Clears SD_AD_CHNG_Q bit
Do not clear
SCM_LOCK_CHNG_CLR
PAL_SW_LK_CHNG_CLR
0
1
Clears SCM_LOCK_CHNG_Q bit
Do not clear
0
1
Clears PAL_SW_LK_CHNG_Q bit
Not used
Reserved
Interrupt Mask 3
(read/write)
SD_OP_CHNG_MSK
0
1
Masks SD_OP_CHNG_Q bit
Unmasks SD_OP_CHNG_Q bit
Masks SD_V_LOCK_CHNG_Q bit
Unmasks SD_V_LOCK_CHNG_Q bit
Masks SD_H_LOCK_CHNG_Q bit
Unmasks SD_H_LOCK_CHNG_Q bit
Masks SD_AD_CHNG_Q bit
Unmasks SD_AD_CHNG_Q bit
Masks SCM_LOCK_CHNG_Q bit
Unmasks SCM_LOCK_CHNG_Q bit
Masks PAL_SW_LK_CHNG_Q bit
Unmasks PAL_SW_LK_CHNG_Q bit
Not used
SD_V_LOCK_CHNG_MSK
SD_H_LOCK_CHNG_MSK
SD_AD_CHNG_MSK
SCM_LOCK_CHNG_MSK
PAL_SW_LK_CHNG_MSK
Reserved
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Interrupt Status 4 (read only) VDP_CCAPD_Q
0
1
Closed captioning not detected
Closed captioning detected
These bits can be cleared
and masked by Register
0x4F and Register 0x50,
respectively; note that an
interrupt in Register 0x4E
for the CCAP, Gemstar,
CGMS, WSS, VPS, PDC,
UTC, and VITC data uses
the VDP data slicer
Reserved
x
VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_Q; see
0x9C Bit 4 of user sub map to determine
whether interrupt is issued for a
change in detected data or for when
data is detected regardless of content
0
1
CGMS/WSS data is not changed/
not available
CGMS/WSS data is changed/available
Reserved
x
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_Q;
see 0x9C Bit 5 of User Sub Map to deter-
mine whether interrupt is issued for a
change in detected data or for when
data is detected regardless of content
0
1
Gemstar/PDC/VPS/UTC data is not
changed/not available
Gemstar/PDC/VPS/UTC data is
changed/available
Reserved
x
VDP_VITC_Q
0
1
VITC data is not available in the VDP
VITC data is available in the VDP
Reserved
x
Rev. G | Page 101 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Bit (Shading Indicates
Default State)
User Sub Map
Bit Description
Address Register
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
1
Comments
Notes
0x4F
Interrupt Clear 4
(write only)
VDP_CCAPD_CLR
Do not clear
Note that an interrupt
in Register 0x4E for the
CCAP, Gemstar, CGMS,
WSS, VPS, PDC, UTC, and
VITC data uses the VDP
data slicer
Clears VDP_CCAPD_Q
Reserved
0
VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_CLR
0
1
Do not clear
Clears VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_Q
Reserved
0
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_CLR
0
1
Do not clear
Clears VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_Q
Reserved
0
VDP_VITC_CLR
0
1
Do not clear
Clears VDP_VITC_Q
Reserved
0
0x50
Interrupt Mask 4
VDP_CCAPD_MSK
0
1
Masks VDP_CCAPD_Q
Note that an interrupt
in Register 0x4E for the
CCAP, Gemstar, CGMS,
WSS, VPS, PDC, UTC, and
VITC data uses the VDP
data slicer
Unmasks VDP_CCAPD_Q
Reserved
0
VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_MSK
0
1
Masks VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_Q
Unmasks VDP_CGMS_WSS_CHNGD_Q
Reserved
0
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_MSK
0
1
Masks VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CHNG_Q
Unmasks VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_
CHNG_Q
Reserved
0
VDP_VITC_MSK
0
1
Masks VDP_VITC_Q
Unmasks VDP_VITC_Q
Reserved
0
0x60
VDP_Config_1
VDP_TTXT_TYPE_MAN[1:0]
0
0
1
0
1
0
PAL: Teletext-ITU-BT.653-625/50-A,
NTSC: reserved
PAL: Teletext-ITU-BT.653-625/50-B (WST),
NTSC: Teletext-ITU-BT.653-525/60-B
PAL: Teletext-ITU-BT.653-625/50-C,
NTSC: Teletext-ITU-BT.653-525/60-C, or
EIA516 (NABTS)
1
1
PAL: Teletext-ITU-BT.653-625/50-D,
NTSC: Teletext-ITU-BT.653-525/60-D
VDP_TTXT_TYPE_MAN_ENABLE
WST_PKT_DECODE_DISABLE
0
1
User programming of teletext type
disabled
User programming of teletext type
enabled
0
1
Enable hamming decoding of WST
packets
Disable hamming decoding of WST
packets
Reserved
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0x61
0x62
VDP_Config_2
Reserved
x
x
0
0
0
1
AUTO_DETECT_GS_TYPE
0
1
Disable autodetection of Gemstar type
Enable autodetection of Gemstar type
Reserved
VDP_ADF_Config_1
ADF_DID[4:0]
1
0
1
User-specified DID sent in the ancillary
data stream with VDP decoded data
ADF_MODE[1:0]
0
0
1
0
1
0
Nibble mode
Byte mode, no code restrictions
Byte mode with 0x00 and 0xFF
prevented
1
1
Reserved
ADF_ENABLE
0
1
Disable insertion of VBI decoded data
into ancillary 656 stream
Enable insertion of VBI decoded data
into ancillary 656 stream
0x63
VDP_ADF_Config_2
ADF_SDID[5:0]
1
0
1
0
1
0
User-specified SDID sent in the ancillary
data stream with VDP decoded data
Reserved
x
DUPLICATE_ADF
0
1
Ancillary data packet is spread across
the Y and C data streams
Ancillary data packet is duplicated on
the Y and C data streams
Rev. G | Page 102 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Bit (Shading Indicates
Default State)
User Sub Map
Bit Description
Address Register
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Comments
Notes
0x64
VDP_LINE_00E
VBI_DATA_P318[3:0]
0
0
0
0
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 318 (PAL), NTSC—N/A
Reserved
0
0
0
MAN_LINE_PGM
0
1
Decode default standards on the lines
indicated in Table 69
Manually program the VBI standard
If set to 1, all VBI_DATA_
to be decoded on each line; see Table 70 Px_Ny bits can be set as
desired
0x65
0x66
0x67
0x68
0x69
0x6A
0x6B
0x6C
0x6D
0x6E
0x6F
0x70
0x71
0x72
0x73
VDP_LINE_00F
VDP_LINE_010
VDP_LINE_011
VDP_LINE_012
VDP_LINE_013
VDP_LINE_014
VDP_LINE_015
VDP_LINE_016
VDP_LINE_017
VDP_LINE_018
VDP_LINE_019
VDP_LINE_01A
VDP_LINE_01B
VDP_LINE_01C
VDP_LINE_01D
VBI_DATA_P319_N286[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P6_N23[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P320_N287[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P7_N24[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P321_N288[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P8_N25[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P322[3:0]
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 319 (PAL), Line 286 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 6 (PAL), Line 23 (NTSC)
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 320 (PAL), Line 287 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 7 (PAL), Line 24 (NTSC)
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 321 (PAL), Line 288 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 8 (PAL), Line 25 (NTSC)
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 322 (PAL), NTSC—N/A
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
VBI_DATA_P9[3:0]
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 9 (PAL), NTSC—N/A
VBI_DATA_P323[3:0]
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 323 (PAL), NTSC—N/A
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
VBI_DATA_P10[3:0]
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 10 (PAL), NTSC—N/A
VBI_DATA_P324_N272[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P11[3:0]
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 324 (PAL), Line 272 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 11 (PAL); NTSC—N/A
VBI_DATA_P325_N273[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P12_N10[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P326_N274[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P13_N11[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P327_N275[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P14_N12[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P328_N276[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P15_N13[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P329_N277[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P16_N14[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P330_N278[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P17_N15[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P331_N279[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P18_N16[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P332_N280[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P19_N17[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P333_N281[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P20_N18[3:0]
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 325 (PAL), Line 273 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 12 (PAL), Line 10 (NTSC)
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 326 (PAL), Line 274 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 13 (PAL), Line 11 (NTSC)
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 327 (PAL), Line 275 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 14 (PAL), Line 12 (NTSC)
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 328 (PAL), Line 276 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 15 (PAL), Line 13 (NTSC)
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 329 (PAL), Line 277 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 16 (PAL), Line 14 (NTSC)
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 330 (PAL), Line 278 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 17 (PAL), Line 15 (NTSC)
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 331 (PAL), Line 279 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 18 (PAL), Line 16 (NTSC)
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 332 (PAL), Line 280 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 19 (PAL), Line 17 (NTSC)
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 333 (PAL), Line 281 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 20 (PAL), Line 18 (NTSC)
Rev. G | Page 103 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
Bit (Shading Indicates
Default State)
User Sub Map
Bit Description
Address Register
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Comments
Notes
0x74
0x75
0x76
0x77
0x78
VDP_LINE_01E
VBI_DATA_P334_N282[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P21_N19[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P335_N283[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P22_N20[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P336_N284[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P23_N21[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P337_N285[3:0]
VBI_DATA_P24_N22[3:0]
CC_AVL
0
0
0
0
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 334 (PAL), Line 282 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
0
0
0
0
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 21 (PAL), Line 19 (NTSC)
VDP_LINE_01F
VDP_LINE_020
VDP_LINE_021
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 335 (PAL), Line 283 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must be
set to 1 for these bits to
be effective
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 22 (PAL), Line 20 (NTSC)
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 336 (PAL), Line 284 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 23 (PAL), Line 21 (NTSC)
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 337 (PAL), Line 285 (NTSC)
MAN_LINE_PGM must
be set to 1 for these bits
to be effective
Sets VBI standard to be decoded from
Line 24 (PAL), Line 22 (NTSC)
VDP_STATUS
(read only)
0
1
Closed captioning not detected
Closed captioning detected
CC_CLEAR resets the
CC_AVL bit
CC_EVEN_FIELD
0
1
Closed captioning decoded from
odd field
Closed captioning decoded from
even field
CGMS_WSS_AVL
0
1
CGMS/WSS not detected
CGMS/WSS detected
CGMS_WSS_CLEAR resets
the CGMS_WSS_AVL bit
Reserved
0
GS_PDC_VPS_UTC_AVL
0
1
GS/PDC/VPS/UTC not detected
GS/PDC/VPS/UTC detected
GS_PDC_VPS_UTC_CLEAR
resets the
GS_PDC_VPS_UTC_AVL
bit
GS_DATA_TYPE
VITC_AVL
0
1
Gemstar_1× detected
Gemstar_2× detected
VITC not detected
VITC detected
0
1
VITC_CLEAR resets the
VITC_AVL bit
TTXT_AVL
0
1
Teletext not detected
Teletext detected
VDP_STATUS_CLEAR
(write only)
CC_CLEAR
0
1
Does not reinitialize the CCAP readback
registers
This is a self-clearing bit
This is a self-clearing bit
Reinitializes the CCAP readback registers
Reserved
0
CGMS_WSS_CLEAR
0
1
Does not reinitialize the CGMS/WSS
readback registers
Reinitializes the CGMS/WSS readback
registers
Reserved
0
GS_PDC_VPS_UTC_CLEAR
0
1
Does not reinitialize the GS/PDC/VPS/
UTC readback registers
This is a self-clearing bit
This is a self-clearing bit
Refreshes the GS/PDC/VPS/UTC
readback registers
Reserved
0
VITC_CLEAR
0
1
Does not reinitialize the VITC readback
registers
Reinitializes the VITC readback registers
Reserved
0
x
0x79
0x7A
0x7D
VDP_CCAP_DATA_0
(read only)
VDP_CCAP_DATA_1
(read only)
VDP_CGMS_WSS_DATA_0
(read only)
CCAP_BYTE_1[7:0]
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Decoded Byte 1 of CCAP
CCAP_BYTE_2[7:0]
x
Decoded Byte 2 of CCAP
CGMS_CRC[5:2]
Reserved
CGMS_WSS[13:8]
CGMS_CRC[1:0]
CGMS_WSS[7:0]
Decoded CRC sequence for CGMS
0
0
0
x
0
x
0x7E
VDP_CGMS_WSS_DATA_1
(read only)
x
x
x
x
Decoded CGMS/WSS data
Decoded CRC sequence for CGMS
Decoded CGMS/WSS data
x
x
x
x
0x7F
0x84
0x85
VDP_CGMS_WSS_DATA_2
(read only)
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_0
(read only)
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_1
(read only)
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_0[7:0]
GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_1[7:0]
x
x
x
x
Decoded Gemstar/VPS/PDC/UTC data
Decoded Gemstar/VPS/PDC/UTC data
Rev. G | Page 104 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
Bit (Shading Indicates
Default State)
User Sub Map
Bit Description
Address Register
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Comments
Notes
0x86
0x87
0x88
0x89
0x8A
0x8B
0x8C
0x8D
0x8E
0x8F
0x90
0x92
0x93
0x94
0x95
0x96
0x97
0x98
0x99
0x9A
0x9B
0x9C
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_2
(read only)
VDP_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_3
(read only)
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_4
(read only)
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_5
(read only)
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_6
(read only)
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_7
(read only)
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_8
(read only)
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_9
(read only)
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_10
(read only)
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_11
(read only)
VDP_VPS_PDC_UTC_12
(read only)
VDP_VITC_DATA_0
(read only)
VDP_VITC_DATA_1
(read only)
VDP_VITC_DATA_2
(read only)
VDP_VITC_DATA_3
(read only)
GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_2[7:0]
GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_3[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_4[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_5[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_6[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_7[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_8[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_9[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_10[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_11[7:0]
VPS_PDC_UTC_BYTE_12[7:0]
VITC_DATA_0[7:0]
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Decoded Gemstar/VPS/PDC/UTC data
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
0
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
0
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
0
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
0
Decoded Gemstar/VPS/PDC/UTC data
Decoded VPS/PDC/UTC data
Decoded VPS/PDC/UTC data
Decoded VPS/PDC/UTC data
Decoded VPS/PDC/UTC data
Decoded VPS/PDC/UTC data
Decoded VPS/PDC/UTC data
Decoded VPS/PDC/UTC data
Decoded VPS/PDC/UTC data
Decoded VPS/PDC/UTC data
Decoded VITC data
VITC_DATA_1[7:0]
Decoded VITC data
VITC_DATA_2[7:0]
Decoded VITC data
VITC_DATA_3[7:0]
Decoded VITC data
VDP_VITC_DATA_4
(read only)
VDP_VITC_DATA_5
(read only)
VDP_VITC_DATA_6
(read only)
VDP_VITC_DATA_7
(read only)
VDP_VITC_DATA_8
(read only)
VDP_VITC_CALC_CRC
(read only)
VITC_DATA_4[7:0]
Decoded VITC data
VITC_DATA_5[7:0]
Decoded VITC data
VITC_DATA_6[7:0]
Decoded VITC data
VITC_DATA_7[7:0]
Decoded VITC data
VITC_DATA_8[7:0]
Decoded VITC data
VITC_CRC[7:0]
Decoded VITC CRC data
VDP_OUTPUT_SEL
Reserved
WSS_CGMS_CB_CHANGE
0
1
Disable content-based updating of
CGMS and WSS data
Enable content-based updating of
CGMS and WSS data
The available bit shows
the availability of data
only when its content
has changed
GS_VPS_PDC_UTC_CB_CHANGE
I2C_GS_VPS_PDC_UTC[1:0]
0
1
Disable content-based updating of
Gemstar, VPS, PDC, and UTC data
Enable content-based updating of
Gemstar, VPS, PDC, and UTC data
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Gemstar_1×/Gemstar_2×
Standard expected to
be decoded
VPS
PDC
UTC
1 x indicates a bit that keeps the last written value.
2 Shading indicates default values.
Rev. G | Page 105 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
I2C PROGRAMMING EXAMPLES
64-LEAD LQFP
Mode 1 CVBS Input (Composite Video on AIN2)
All standards are supported through autodetect, 8-bit, 4:2:2 ITU-R BT.656 output on P15 to P8 for the 64-lead LQFP.
Table 109. Mode 1 CVBS Input
Register Address (Hex)
Register Value (Hex) Notes
00
04
17
31
3D
3E
3F
0E
55
0E
01
57
41
02
A2
6A
A0
80
81
00
INSEL = CVBS in on AIN2
Enable SFL
Select SH1
Clear NEWAV_MODE, SAV/EAV to suit ADV video encoders
MWE enable manual window, color kill threshold to 2
BLM optimization
BGB optimization
Hidden space
ADC configuration
User space
Mode 2 S-Video Input (Y on AIN3 and C on AIN6)
All standards are supported through autodetect, 8-bit, ITU-R BT.656 output on P15 to P8 for the 64-lead LQFP.
Table 110. Mode 2 S-Video Input
Register Address (Hex)
Register Value (Hex) Notes
00
04
31
3D
3E
3F
58
0E
55
0E
08
57
02
A2
6A
A0
04
80
81
00
INSEL = Y/C, Y = AIN3, C = AIN6
Enable SFL
Clear NEWAVMODE, SAV/EAV to suit ADV video encoders
MWE enable manual window, color kill threshold to 2
BLM optimization
BGB optimization
Mandatory write; this must be performed for correct operation
Hidden space
ADC configuration
User space
Mode 3 525i/625i YPrPb Input (Y on AIN1, Pr on AIN4, and Pb on AIN5)
All standards are supported through autodetect, 8-bit, ITU-R BT.656 output on P15 to P8 for the 64-lead LQFP.
Table 111. Mode 3 YPrPb Input
Register Address (Hex)
Register Value (Hex) Notes
00
31
3D
3E
3F
0E
55
0E
09
02
A2
6A
A0
80
81
00
INSEL = YPrPb, Y = AIN1, Pr = AIN4, Pb = AIN5
Clear NEWAV_MODE, SAV/EAV to suit ADV video encoders
MWE enable manual window
BLM optimization
ADI recommended
Hidden space
ADC configuration
User space
Rev. G | Page 106 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
48-LEAD LQFP
Mode 1 CVBS Input (Composite Video on AIN2)
All standards are supported through autodetect, 8-bit, 4:2:2 ITU-R BT.656 output on P0 to P7 for the 32-lead LQFP.
Table 112. Mode 1 CVBS Input
Register Address (Hex)
Register Value (Hex) Notes
00
04
17
31
3D
3E
3F
0E
55
0E
01
57
41
02
A2
6A
A0
80
81
00
INSEL = CVBS in on AIN2
Enable SFL
Select SH1
Clear NEWAV_MODE, SAV/EAV to suit ADV video encoders
MWE enable manual window, color kill threshold to 2
BLM optimization
BGB optimization
Hidden space
ADC configuration
User space
Mode 2 S-Video Input (Y on AIN3 and C on AIN6)
All standards are supported through autodetect, 8-bit, ITU-R BT.656 output on P0 to P7 for the 32-lead LQF P.
Table 113. Mode 2 S-Video Input
Register Address (Hex)
Register Value (Hex) Notes
00
04
31
3D
3E
3F
58
0E
55
0E
08
57
02
A2
6A
A0
04
80
81
00
INSEL = Y/C, Y = AIN3, C = AIN6
Enable SFL
Clear NEWAVMODE, SAV/EAV to suit ADV video encoders
MWE enable manual window, color kill threshold to 2
BLM optimization
BGB optimization
Mandatory write; this must be performed for correct operation
Hidden space
ADC configuration
User space
Mode 3 525i/625i YPrPb Input (Y on AIN1, Pr on AIN4, and Pb on AIN5)
All standards are supported through autodetect, 8-bit, ITU-R BT.656 output on P0 to P7 for the 32-lead LQFP.
Table 114. Mode 3 YPrPb Input
Register Address (Hex)
Register Value (Hex) Notes
00
31
3D
3E
3F
54
0E
55
0E
09
02
A2
6A
A0
4E
80
81
00
INSEL = YPrPb, Y = AIN1, Pr = AIN4, Pb = AIN5
Clear NEWAV_MODE, SAV/EAV to suit ADV video encoders
MWE enable manual window
BLM optimization
ADI recommended
ADI recommended
Hidden space
ADC configuration
User space
Rev. G | Page 107 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
40-LEAD LFCSP
Mode 1 CVBS Input (Composite Video on AIN1)
All standards are supported through autodetect, 8-bit, 4:2:2, ITU-R BT.656 output on P0 to P7.
Table 115. Mode 1 CVBS Input
Register Address (Hex)
Register Value (Hex)
Notes
00
04
17
31
3D
3E
3F
0E
55
0E
00
57
41
02
A2
6A
A0
80
81
00
INSEL = CVBS in on AIN1
Enable SFL
Select SH1
Clear NEWAVMODE, SAV/EAV to suit ADV video encoders
MWE enable manual window, color kill threshold to 2
BLM optimization
BGB optimization
Hidden space
ADC configuration
User space
Mode 2 S-Video Input (Y on AIN1 and C on AIN2)
All standards are supported through autodetect, 8-bit, ITU-R BT.656 output on P0 to P7.
Table 116. Mode 2 S-Video Input
Register Address (Hex)
Register Value (Hex)
Notes
00
04
31
3D
3E
3F
58
0E
55
0E
06
57
02
A2
6A
A0
04
80
81
00
INSEL = Y/C, Y = AIN1, C = AIN2
Enable SFL
Clear NEWAVMODE, SAV/EAV to suit ADV video encoders
MWE enable manual window, color kill threshold to 2
BLM optimization
BGB optimization
Mandatory write; this must be performed for correct operation
Hidden space
ADC configuration
User space
Mode 3 525i/625i YPrPb Input (Y on AIN1, Pb on AIN2, and Pr on AIN3)
All standards are supported through autodetect, 8-bit, ITU-R BT.656 output on P0 to P7.
Table 117. Mode 3 YPrPb Input
Register Address (Hex)
Register Value (Hex)
Notes
00
31
3D
3E
3F
0E
55
0E
09
02
A2
6A
A0
80
81
00
INSEL = YPrPb, Y = AIN1, Pb = AIN2, Pr = AIN3
Clear NEWAVMODE, SAV/EAV to suit ADV video encoders
MWE enable manual window
BLM optimization
ADI recommended
Hidden space
ADC configuration
User space
Rev. G | Page 108 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
32-LEAD LFCSP
Mode 1 CVBS Input (Composite Video on AIN1)
All standards are supported through autodetect, 8-bit, 4:2:2, ITU-R BT.656 output on P0 to P7.
Table 118. Mode 1 CVBS Input
Register Address (Hex)
Register Value (Hex)
Notes
00
04
17
31
3D
3E
3F
0E
55
0E
00
57
41
02
A2
6A
A0
80
81
00
INSEL = CVBS in on AIN1
Enable SFL
Select SH1
Clear NEWAVMODE, SAV/EAV to suit ADV video encoders
MWE enable manual window, color kill threshold to 2
BLM optimization
BGB optimization
Hidden space
ADC configuration
User space
Mode 2 S-Video Input (Y on AIN1 and C on AIN2)
All standards are supported through autodetect, 8-bit, ITU-R BT.656 output on P0 to P7.
Table 119. Mode 2 S-Video Input
Register Address (Hex)
Register Value (Hex)
Notes
00
04
31
3D
3E
3F
58
0E
55
0E
06
57
02
A2
6A
A0
04
80
81
00
INSEL = Y/C, Y = AIN1, C = AIN2
Enable SFL
Clear NEWAVMODE, SAV/EAV to suit ADV video encoders
MWE enable manual window, color kill threshold to 2
BLM optimization
BGB optimization
Mandatory write; this must be performed for correct operation
Hidden space
ADC configuration
User space
Mode 3 525i/625i YPrPb Input (Y on AIN1, Pb on AIN2, and Pr on AIN3)
All standards are supported through autodetect, 8-bit, ITU-R BT.656 output on P0 to P7.
Table 120. Mode 3 YPrPb Input
Register Address (Hex)
Register Value (Hex)
Notes
00
31
3D
3E
3F
54
0E
55
0E
09
02
A2
6A
A0
4E
80
81
00
INSEL = YPrPb, Y = AIN1, Pb = AIN2, Pr = AIN3
Clear NEWAVMODE, SAV/EAV to suit ADV video encoders
MWE enable manual window
BLM optimization
ADI recommended
ADI recommended
Hidden space
ADC configuration
User space
Rev. G | Page 109 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
PCB LAYOUT RECOMMENDATIONS
Using a single ground plane for the entire board is also recom-
mended.
The ADV7180 is a high precision, high speed, mixed-signal
device. To achieve the maximum performance from the part, it
is important to have a well laid out PCB. The following is a
guide for designing a board using the ADV7180.
Experience has repeatedly shown that the noise performance is
the same or better with a single ground plane. Using multiple
ground planes can be detrimental because each separate ground
plane is smaller, and long ground loops can result.
ANALOG INTERFACE INPUTS
Care should be taken when routing the inputs on the PCB.
Track lengths should be kept to a minimum, and 75 Ω trace
impedances should be used when possible. In addition, trace
impedances other than 75 Ω increase the chance of reflections.
PLL
Place the PLL loop filter components as close as possible to the
ELPF pin. It should also be placed on the same side of the PCB
as the ADV7180. Do not place any digital or other high frequency
traces near these components. Use the values suggested in this
data sheet with tolerances of 10% or less.
POWER SUPPLY DECOUPLING
It is recommended to decouple each power supply pin with
0.1 μF and 10 nF capacitors. The fundamental idea is to have a
decoupling capacitor within about 0.5 cm of each power pin. In
addition, avoid placing the capacitor on the opposite side of the
PCB from the ADV7180 because doing so interposes inductive
vias in the path. The decoupling capacitors should be located
between the power plane and the power pin. Current should
flow from the power plane to the capacitor and then to the
power pin. Do not apply the power connection between the
capacitor and the power pin. Placing a via underneath the
100 nF capacitor pads, down to the power plane, is the best
approach (see Figure 54).
VREFN AND VREFP
The circuit associated with these pins should be placed as close
as possible and on the same side of the PCB as the ADV7180.
DIGITAL OUTPUTS (BOTH DATA AND CLOCKS)
Try to minimize the trace length that the digital outputs have to
drive. Longer traces have higher capacitance, requiring more
current and, in turn, causing more internal digital noise.
Shorter traces reduce the possibility of reflections.
Adding a 30 Ω to 50 Ω series resistor can suppress reflections,
reduce EMI, and reduce the current spikes inside the ADV7180.
If series resistors are used, place them as close as possible to the
ADV7180 pins. However, try not to add vias or extra length to
the output trace to place the resistors closer.
SUPPLY
VIA TO SUPPLY
10nF
100nF
GROUND
VIA TO GND
If possible, limit the capacitance that each of the digital outputs
drives to less than 15 pF. This can easily be accomplished by
keeping traces short and by connecting the outputs to only one
device. Loading the outputs with excessive capacitance increases
the current transients inside the ADV7180, creating more digital
noise on its power supplies.
Figure 54. Recommended Power Supply Decoupling
It is particularly important to maintain low noise and good
stability of PVDD. Careful attention must be paid to regulation,
filtering, and decoupling. It is highly desirable to provide separate
regulated supplies for each of the analog circuitry groups (AVDD
,
DVDD, DVDDIO, and PVDD).
The 40-lead and 32-lead LFCSP have an exposed metal paddle
on the bottom of the package. This paddle must be soldered to
PCB ground for proper heat dissipation and for noise and
mechanical strength benefits.
Some graphic controllers use substantially different levels of
power when active (during active picture time) and when idle
(during horizontal and vertical sync periods). This can result in
a measurable change in the voltage supplied to the analog supply
regulator, which can in turn produce changes in the regulated
analog supply voltage. This can be mitigated by regulating the
analog supply, or at least PVDD, from a different, cleaner power
source, for example, from a 12 V supply.
DIGITAL INPUTS
The digital inputs on the ADV7180 are designed to work with
1.8 V to 3.3 V signals and are not tolerant of 5 V signals. Extra
components are needed if 5 V logic signals are required to be
applied to the decoder.
Rev. G | Page 110 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
TYPICAL CIRCUIT CONNECTION
Examples of how to connect the 40-lead LFCSP, 64-lead LQFP, 48-lead LQFP, and 32-lead LFCSP video decoders are shown in Figure 55,
Figure 56, Figure 57, and Figure 58. For a detailed schematic of the ADV7180 evaluation boards, contact a local Analog Devices field
applications engineer or Analog Devices distributor.
D
_1.8V
D
A
_1.8V
ANALOG_INPUT_1
VDD
VDDIO
VDD
0.1µF
A
A
A
1
2
3
IN
IN
IN
36Ω
0.1µF
0.1µF
0.1µF
0.1µF
39Ω
10nF
10nF
10nF
10nF
ANALOG_INPUT_2
0.1µF
P
_1.8V
VDD
36Ω
D
_3.3V
VDDIO
39Ω
D
_1.8V
VDD
0.1µF
A
_1.8V
10nF
VDD
ANALOG_INPUT_3
0.1µF
P[0:7]
36Ω
39Ω
23
29
30
A
1
2
3
A
A
A
1
2
3
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
A
A
17
16
10
9
8
7
P0
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
P0
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
YCrCb
8-BIT
656 DATA
31
RESET
RESET
6
5
ADV7180BCPZ
LFCSP–40
KEEP VREFN AND VREFP CAPACITOR AS CLOSE AS
POSSIBLE TO THE ADV7180 AND ON THE SAME SIDE
OF THE PCB AS THE ADV7180.
26
25
VREFN
VREFP
0.1µF
11
38
2
LLC
LLC
INTRQ
SFL
INTRQ
SFL
LOCATE CLOSE TO, AND ON THE
SAME SIDE AS, THE ADV7180.
13
12
XTAL
37
39
47pF
VS/FIELD
HS
VS/FIELD
HS
28.63636MHz
1MΩ
XTAL1
47pF
D
VDDIO
4kΩ
32
ALSB
P
_1.8V
VDD
2
2
ALSB TIED HI ≥ I C ADDRESS = 42h
EXTERNAL
LOOP FILTER
ALSB TIED LOW ≥ I C ADDRESS = 40h
10nF
19
ELPF
18
PWRDWN
POWER_DOWN
82nF
34
33
SCLK
SCLK
SDA
1.69kΩ
SDATA
KEEP CLOSE TO THE ADV7180 AND ON
THE SAME SIDE OF PCB AS THE ADV7180.
Figure 55. 40-Lead LFCSP Typical Connection Diagram
Rev. G | Page 111 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
ANALOG_INPUT_1
Y
THE SUGGESTED INPUT ARRANGEMENT
IS AS SEEN ON THE EVAL BOARD AND IS
DIRECTLY SUPPORTED BY INSEL.
0.1µF
A
A
A
A
A
A
1
2
3
4
5
6
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
36Ω
39Ω
D
_1.8V
D
_1.8V
VDD
VDD
ANALOG_INPUT_2
CVBS
0.1µF
0.1µF
10nF
0.1µF
10nF
36Ω
39Ω
D
_3.3V
0.1µF
ANALOG_INPUT_3
YC_Y
A
_1.8V
VDDIO
VDD
0.1µF
0.1µF
36Ω
10nF
D
_3.3V
P
_1.8V
39Ω
VDDIO
VDD
10nF
ANALOG_INPUT_4
Cr
10nF
0.1µF
0.1µF
0.1µF
10nF
36Ω
39Ω
P[0:7]
ANALOG_INPUT_5
Cb
0.1µF
8-BIT
16-BIT
35
36
46
47
48
49
A
A
A
A
A
A
1
2
3
4
5
6
A
1
2
3
4
5
6
DATA BUS OUTPUT MODE OUTPUT MODE
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
26
25
19
18
17
16
15
14
P0
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
P0
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
36Ω
P[0:7]
N/A
CbCr
Y
39Ω
A
A
A
A
A
P[8:15]
656/601 YCbCr
ANALOG_INPUT_6
YC_C
0.1µF
P[8:15]
36Ω
39Ω
ADV7180BSTZ
8
7
6
5
62
61
60
59
P8
P9
LQFP–64
P8
P9
P10
P11
P12
P13
P14
P15
P10
P11
P12
P13
P14
P15
KEEP VREFN AND VREFP CAPACITOR AS CLOSE AS
POSSIBLE TO THE ADV7180 AND ON THE SAME
SIDE OF THE PCB AS THE ADV7180.
39
38
VREFN
VREFP
0.1µF
1
INTRQ
INT
55
56
12
13
GPO3
GPO2
GPO1
GPO0
GPO3
GPO2
GPO1
GPO0
22
21
XTAL
63
64
2
47pF
FIELD
VS
FIELD
28.63636MHz
1MΩ
VSYNC
HS
HS
XTAL1
47pF
9
SFL
SFL
P
_1.8V
VDD
27, 28, 33,
41, 42, 44,
45, 50
51
29
EXTERNAL
RESET
RESET
NC
LOOP FILTER
PWRDWN
POWER_DOWN
10nF
30
ELPF
D
_3.3V
VDDIO
82nF
4kΩ
52
1.69kΩ
ALSB
2
TIE HI: I C ADDRESS = 42
KEEP CLOSE TO THE ADV7180 AND ON
THE SAME SIDE OF PCB AS THE ADV7180.
2
TIE LOW: I C ADDRESS = 40
20
LLC
LLC
33Ω
54
53
SCLK
SCLK
SDA
SDATA
33Ω
NC = NO CONNECT
Figure 56. 64-Lead LQFP Typical Connection Diagram
Rev. G | Page 112 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
ANALOG_INPUT_1
Y
THE SUGGESTED INPUT ARRANGEMENT
IS AS SEEN ON THE EVAL BOARD AND IS
DIRECTLY SUPPORTED BY INSEL.
0.1µF
A
A
A
A
A
A
1
2
3
4
5
6
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
36Ω
39Ω
D
_1.8V
D
_1.8V
VDD
VDD
ANALOG_INPUT_2
CVBS
0.1µF
0.1µF
10nF
0.1µF
10nF
36Ω
39Ω
D
_3.3V
0.1µF
A
_1.8V
VDDIO
VDD
ANALOG_INPUT_3
YC_Y
0.1µF
0.1µF
10nF
D
_3.3V
36Ω
P
_1.8V
VDD
VDDIO
39Ω
10nF
ANALOG_INPUT_4
Cr
10nF
0.1µF
0.1µF
10nF
0.1µF
36Ω
P[0:7]
39Ω
ANALOG_INPUT_5
Cb
0.1µF
26
27
33
34
35
36
A
A
A
A
A
A
1
2
3
4
5
6
A
1
2
3
4
5
6
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
22
20
12
11
10
9
P0
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
P0
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
36Ω
A
A
A
A
A
39Ω
ANALOG_INPUT_6
YC_C
0.1µF
8
7
36Ω
39Ω
ADV7180WBST48Z
LQFP–48
KEEP VREFN AND VREFP CAPACITOR AS CLOSE AS
POSSIBLE TO THE ADV7180 AND ON THE SAME
SIDE OF THE PCB AS THE ADV7180.
30
29
VREFN
VREFP
0.1µF
46
INTRQ
INT
41
42
6
GPO3
GPO2
GPO1
GPO0
GPO3
GPO2
GPO1
GPO0
5
17
16
XTAL
45
47pF
VS/FIELD
VS/FIELD
*
28.63636MHz
1MΩ
47
3
HS
HS
XTAL1
47pF
SFL
SFL
P
_1.8V
VDD
37
21
EXTERNAL
RESET
RESET
NC
15, 48
24
LOOP FILTER
PWRDWN
POWER_DOWN
10nF
ELPF
D
_3.3V
VDDIO
82nF
4kΩ
38
1.69kΩ
ALSB
2
TIE HI: I C ADDRESS = 42
KEEP CLOSE TO THE ADV7180 AND ON
THE SAME SIDE OF PCB AS THE ADV7180.
2
TIE LOW: I C ADDRESS = 40
14
LLC
LLC
33Ω
40
39
SCLK
SCLK
SDA
SDATA
33Ω
NOTES
1. NC = NO CONNECT.
*REFER TO ANALOG DEVICES CRYSTAL APPLICATION NOTE FOR PROPER CAPACITOR LOADING
Figure 57. 48-Lead LQFP Typical Connection Diagram
Rev. G | Page 113 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
D
_1.8V
0.1µF
D
A
VDD
_1.8V
10nF
ANALOG_INPUT_1
VDD
VDDIO
0.1µF
A
A
A
1
2
3
IN
IN
IN
36Ω
0.1µF
0.1µF
39Ω
10nF
10nF
ANALOG_INPUT_2
0.1µF
P
_1.8V
10nF
VDD
36Ω
D
_3.3V
VDDIO
39Ω
D
_1.8V
VDD
0.1µF
A
_1.8V
VDD
ANALOG_INPUT_3
0.1µF
P[0:7]
36Ω
39Ω
19
23
24
A
1
2
3
A
A
A
1
2
3
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
IN
A
A
16
15
10
9
8
7
P0
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
P0
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
YCrCb
8-BIT
656 DATA
25
RESET
RESET
6
5
ADV7180KCP32Z
LFCSP–32
KEEP VREFN AND VREFP CAPACITOR AS CLOSE AS
POSSIBLE TO THE ADV7180 AND ON THE SAME SIDE
OF THE PCB AS THE ADV7180.
21
20
VREFN
0.1µF
VREFP
11
32
4
LLC
LLC
INTRQ
SFL
INTRQ
SFL
LOCATE CLOSE TO, AND ON THE
SAME SIDE AS, THE ADV7180.
13
12
XTAL
31
1
47pF
VS/FIELD
HS
VS/FIELD
HS
28.63636MHz
1MΩ
XTAL1
47pF
D
VDDIO
4kΩ
26
ALSB
P
_1.8V
VDD
2
2
ALSB TIED HI ≥ I C ADDRESS = 42h
EXTERNAL
LOOP FILTER
ALSB TIED LOW ≥ I C ADDRESS = 40h
10nF
17
ELPF
82nF
28
27
SCLK
SCLK
SDA
1.69kΩ
SDATA
KEEP CLOSE TO THE ADV7180 AND ON
THE SAME SIDE OF PCB AS THE ADV7180.
Figure 58. 32-Lead LFCSP Typical Connection Diagram
Rev. G | Page 114 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
OUTLINE DIMENSIONS
5.10
5.00 SQ
4.90
0.30
0.25
0.18
PIN 1
INDICATOR
PIN 1
INDICATOR
25
32
24
1
0.50
BSC
*
3.75
EXPOSED
PAD
3.60 SQ
3.55
17
8
16
9
0.50
0.40
0.30
0.25 MIN
TOP VIEW
BOTTOM VIEW
FOR PROPER CONNECTION OF
THE EXPOSED PAD, REFER TO
THE PIN CONFIGURATION AND
FUNCTION DESCRIPTIONS
0.80
0.75
0.70
0.05 MAX
0.02 NOM
SECTION OF THIS DATA SHEET.
COPLANARITY
0.08
0.20 REF
SEATING
PLANE
*
COMPLIANT TO JEDEC STANDARDS MO-220-WHHD-5
WITH EXCEPTION TO EXPOSED PAD DIMENSION.
Figure 59. 32-Lead Lead Frame Chip Scale Package [LFCSP_WQ]
5 mm × 5 mm Body, Very Very Thin Quad
(CP-32-12)
Dimensions shown in millimeters
6.00
BSC SQ
0.60 MAX
0.60 MAX
PIN 1
INDICATOR
31
40
1
30
PIN 1
INDICATOR
0.50
BSC
TOP
VIEW
4.25
4.10 SQ
3.95
5.75
BSC SQ
EXPOSED
PAD
(BOT TOM VIEW)
0.50
0.40
0.30
21
10
20
11
0.25 MIN
4.50
REF
12° MAX
0.80 MAX
0.65 TYP
FOR PROPER CONNECTION OF
THE EXPOSED PAD, REFER TO
THE PIN CONFIGURATION AND
FUNCTION DESCRIPTIONS
0.05 MAX
0.02 NOM
1.00
0.85
0.80
0.30
0.23
0.18
COPLANARITY
0.08
0.20 REF
SECTION OF THIS DATA SHEET.
SEATING
PLANE
COMPLIANT TO JEDEC STANDARDS MO-220-VJJD-2
Figure 60. 40-Lead Lead Frame Chip Scale Package [LFCSP_VQ]
6 mm × 6 mm Body, Very Thin Quad
(CP-40-1)
Dimensions shown in millimeters
Rev. G | Page 115 of 120
ADV7180
Data Sheet
12.20
12.00 SQ
11.80
0.75
0.60
0.45
1.60
MAX
64
49
1
48
PIN 1
10.20
10.00 SQ
9.80
TOP VIEW
(PINS DOWN)
1.45
1.40
1.35
0.20
0.09
7°
3.5°
0°
0.08
COPLANARITY
16
33
0.15
0.05
SEATING
PLANE
17
32
VIEW A
0.27
0.22
0.17
0.50
BSC
LEAD PITCH
VIEW A
ROTATED 90° CCW
COMPLIANT TO JEDEC STANDARDS MS-026-BCD
Figure 61. 64-Lead Low Profile Quad Flat Package [LQFP]
10 mm × 10 mm Body
(ST-64-2)
Dimensions shown in millimeters
9.20
9.00 SQ
8.80
0.75
0.60
0.45
1.60
MAX
37
48
36
1
PIN 1
7.20
TOP VIEW
(PINS DOWN)
7.00 SQ
6.80
1.45
1.40
1.35
0.20
0.09
7°
3.5°
0°
25
12
0.15
0.05
13
24
SEATING
0.08
0.27
0.22
0.17
PLANE
VIEW A
0.50
BSC
LEAD PITCH
COPLANARITY
VIEW A
ROTATED 90° CCW
COMPLIANT TO JEDEC STANDARDS MS-026-BBC
Figure 62. 48-Lead Low Profile Quad Flat Package [LQFP]
7 mm × 7 mm Body
(ST-48)
Dimensions shown in millimeters
Rev. G | Page 116 of 120
Data Sheet
ADV7180
ORDERING GUIDE
Model1, 2
Temperature Range
−10°C to +70°C
−10°C to +70°C
−40°C to +85°C
−40°C to +85°C
−40°C to +85°C
−40°C to +85°C
−40°C to +85°C
−40°C to +85°C
−40°C to +125°C
−40°C to +125°C
−40°C to +125°C
−40°C to +125°C
−40°C to +85°C
−40°C to +85°C
−10°C to +70°C
−10°C to +70°C
−40°C to +85°C
−40°C to +85°C
−40°C to +85°C
−40°C to +85°C
Package Description
Package Option
CP-32-12
CP-32-12
CP-40-1
CP-40-1
ST-64-2
ST-64-2
CP-32-12
CP-32-12
CP-40-1
CP-40-1
ST-64-2
ST-64-2
ST-48
ST-48
ST-48
ST-48
ST-48
ST-48
CP-32-12
CP-32-12
ADV7180KCP32Z
ADV7180KCP32Z-RL
ADV7180BCPZ
ADV7180BCPZ-REEL
ADV7180BSTZ
ADV7180BSTZ-REEL
ADV7180WBCP32Z
ADV7180WBCP32Z-RL
ADV7180WBCPZ
ADV7180WBCPZ-REEL
ADV7180WBSTZ
ADV7180WBSTZ-REEL
ADV7180WBST48Z
ADV7180WBST48Z-RL
ADV7180KST48Z
ADV7180KST48Z-RL
ADV7180BST48Z
ADV7180BST48Z-RL
ADV7180BCP32Z
32-Lead Lead Frame Chip Scale Package [LFCSP_WQ]
32-Lead Lead Frame Chip Scale Package [LFCSP_WQ]
40-Lead Lead Frame Chip Scale Package [LFCSP_VQ]
40-Lead Lead Frame Chip Scale Package [LFCSP_VQ]
64-Lead Low Profile Quad Flat Package [LQFP]
64-Lead Low Profile Quad Flat Package [LQFP]
32-Lead Lead Frame Chip Scale Package [LFCSP_WQ]
32-Lead Lead Frame Chip Scale Package [LFCSP_WQ]
40-Lead Lead Frame Chip Scale Package [LFCSP_VQ]
40-Lead Lead Frame Chip Scale Package [LFCSP_VQ]
64-Lead Low Profile Quad Flat Package [LQFP]
64-Lead Low Profile Quad Flat Package [LQFP]
48-Lead Low Profile Quad Flat Package [LQFP]
48-Lead Low Profile Quad Flat Package [LQFP]
48-Lead Low Profile Quad Flat Package [LQFP]
48-Lead Low Profile Quad Flat Package [LQFP]
48-Lead Low Profile Quad Flat Package [LQFP]
48-Lead Low Profile Quad Flat Package [LQFP]
32-Lead Lead Frame Chip Scale Package [LFCSP_WQ]
32-Lead Lead Frame Chip Scale Package [LFCSP_WQ]
Evaluation Board for the 64-Lead LQFP
ADV7180BCP32Z-RL
EVAL-ADV7180LQEBZ
EVAL-ADV7180LFEBZ
EVAL-ADV7180-32EBZ
EVAL-ADV7180-48EBZ
Evaluation Board for the 40-Lead LFCSP
Evaluation Board for the 32-Lead LFCSP
Evaluation Board for the 48-Lead LQFP
1 Z = RoHS Compliant Part.
2 W = Qualified for Automotive Applications.
AUTOMOTIVE PRODUCTS
The ADV7180W models are available with controlled manufacturing to support the quality and reliability requirements of automotive
applications. Note that these automotive models may have specifications that differ from the commercial models, and designers should
review the product Specifications section of this data sheet carefully. Only the automotive grade products shown are available for use in
automotive applications. Contact your local Analog Devices account representative for specific product ordering information and to
obtain the specific automotive reliability reports for these models.
Note that the ADV7180 is a Pb-free, environmentally friendly product. It is manufactured using the most up-to-date materials and
processes. The coating on the leads of each device is 100% pure Sn electroplate. The device is suitable for Pb-free applications and can
withstand surface-mount soldering at up to 255°C ( 5°C).
In addition, it is backward-compatible with conventional SnPb soldering processes. This means that the electroplated Sn coating can be
soldered with Sn/Pb solder pastes at conventional reflow temperatures of 220°C to 235°C.
Rev. G | Page 117 of 120
ADV7180
NOTES
Data Sheet
Rev. G | Page 118 of 120
Data Sheet
NOTES
ADV7180
Rev. G | Page 119 of 120
ADV7180
NOTES
Data Sheet
I2C refers to a communications protocol originally developed by Philips Semiconductors (now NXP Semiconductors).
©2006-2012 Analog Devices, Inc. All rights reserved. Trademarks and
registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners.
D05700-0-3/12(G)
Rev. G | Page 120 of 120
相关型号:
©2020 ICPDF网 联系我们和版权申明